pngvalid.c 301.2 KB
Newer Older
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1 2 3

/* pngvalid.c - validate libpng by constructing then reading png files.
 *
4
 * Last changed in libpng 1.5.7 [(PENDING RELEASE)]
5
 * Copyright (c) 2011 Glenn Randers-Pehrson
6
 * Written by John Cunningham Bowler
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21
 *
 * This code is released under the libpng license.
 * For conditions of distribution and use, see the disclaimer
 * and license in png.h
 *
 * NOTES:
 *   This is a C program that is intended to be linked against libpng.  It
 *   generates bitmaps internally, stores them as PNG files (using the
 *   sequential write code) then reads them back (using the sequential
 *   read code) and validates that the result has the correct data.
 *
 *   The program can be modified and extended to test the correctness of
 *   transformations performed by libpng.
 */

22
#define _POSIX_SOURCE 1
23 24 25 26 27
#define _ISOC99_SOURCE 1 /* For floating point */
#define _GNU_SOURCE 1 /* For the floating point exception extension */

#include <signal.h>

28
#include "../../pngconfig.h"
29 30 31 32

#ifdef HAVE_FEENABLEEXCEPT
#  include <fenv.h>
#endif
33

34
#include "../../png.h"
35

36
#if PNG_LIBPNG_VER < 10500
37
/* This deliberately lacks the PNG_CONST. */
38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61
typedef png_byte *png_const_bytep;

/* This is copied from 1.5.1 png.h: */
#define PNG_INTERLACE_ADAM7_PASSES 7
#define PNG_PASS_START_ROW(pass) (((1U&~(pass))<<(3-((pass)>>1)))&7)
#define PNG_PASS_START_COL(pass) (((1U& (pass))<<(3-(((pass)+1)>>1)))&7)
#define PNG_PASS_ROW_SHIFT(pass) ((pass)>2?(8-(pass))>>1:3)
#define PNG_PASS_COL_SHIFT(pass) ((pass)>1?(7-(pass))>>1:3)
#define PNG_PASS_ROWS(height, pass) (((height)+(((1<<PNG_PASS_ROW_SHIFT(pass))\
   -1)-PNG_PASS_START_ROW(pass)))>>PNG_PASS_ROW_SHIFT(pass))
#define PNG_PASS_COLS(width, pass) (((width)+(((1<<PNG_PASS_COL_SHIFT(pass))\
   -1)-PNG_PASS_START_COL(pass)))>>PNG_PASS_COL_SHIFT(pass))
#define PNG_ROW_FROM_PASS_ROW(yIn, pass) \
   (((yIn)<<PNG_PASS_ROW_SHIFT(pass))+PNG_PASS_START_ROW(pass))
#define PNG_COL_FROM_PASS_COL(xIn, pass) \
   (((xIn)<<PNG_PASS_COL_SHIFT(pass))+PNG_PASS_START_COL(pass))
#define PNG_PASS_MASK(pass,off) ( \
   ((0x110145AFU>>(((7-(off))-(pass))<<2)) & 0xFU) | \
   ((0x01145AF0U>>(((7-(off))-(pass))<<2)) & 0xF0U))
#define PNG_ROW_IN_INTERLACE_PASS(y, pass) \
   ((PNG_PASS_MASK(pass,0) >> ((y)&7)) & 1)
#define PNG_COL_IN_INTERLACE_PASS(x, pass) \
   ((PNG_PASS_MASK(pass,1) >> ((x)&7)) & 1)

62
/* These are needed too for the default build: */
63 64
#define PNG_WRITE_16BIT_SUPPORTED
#define PNG_READ_16BIT_SUPPORTED
65 66

/* This comes from pnglibconf.h afer 1.5: */
67
#define PNG_FP_1 100000
68
#define PNG_GAMMA_THRESHOLD_FIXED\
69
   ((png_fixed_point)(PNG_GAMMA_THRESHOLD * PNG_FP_1))
70 71
#endif

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
72 73
#include "zlib.h"   /* For crc32 */

74
#include <float.h>  /* For floating point constants */
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
75 76 77 78
#include <stdlib.h> /* For malloc */
#include <string.h> /* For memcpy, memset */
#include <math.h>   /* For floor */

79 80 81 82
/* Unused formal parameter errors are removed using the following macro which is
 * expected to have no bad effects on performance.
 */
#ifndef UNUSED
83 84 85 86 87
#  if defined(__GNUC__) || defined(_MSC_VER)
#     define UNUSED(param) (void)param;
#  else
#     define UNUSED(param)
#  endif
88 89
#endif

90
/***************************** EXCEPTION HANDLING *****************************/
91
#include "../visupng/cexcept.h"
92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100

#ifdef __cplusplus
#  define this not_the_cpp_this
#  define new not_the_cpp_new
#  define voidcast(type, value) static_cast<type>(value)
#else
#  define voidcast(type, value) (value)
#endif /* __cplusplus */

101
struct png_store;
102 103
define_exception_type(struct png_store*);

104
/* The following are macros to reduce typing everywhere where the well known
105 106
 * name 'the_exception_context' must be defined.
 */
107 108 109
#define anon_context(ps) struct exception_context *the_exception_context = \
   &(ps)->exception_context
#define context(ps,fault) anon_context(ps); png_store *fault
110

111 112 113 114 115 116 117
/******************************* UTILITIES ************************************/
/* Error handling is particularly problematic in production code - error
 * handlers often themselves have bugs which lead to programs that detect
 * minor errors crashing.  The following functions deal with one very
 * common class of errors in error handlers - attempting to format error or
 * warning messages into buffers that are too small.
 */
118 119
static size_t safecat(char *buffer, size_t bufsize, size_t pos,
   PNG_CONST char *cat)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
120
{
121 122 123 124 125 126
   while (pos < bufsize && cat != NULL && *cat != 0)
      buffer[pos++] = *cat++;

   if (pos >= bufsize)
      pos = bufsize-1;

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
127 128 129 130 131 132 133 134 135 136 137
   buffer[pos] = 0;
   return pos;
}

static size_t safecatn(char *buffer, size_t bufsize, size_t pos, int n)
{
   char number[64];
   sprintf(number, "%d", n);
   return safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, number);
}

138
#ifdef PNG_READ_TRANSFORMS_SUPPORTED
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
139
static size_t safecatd(char *buffer, size_t bufsize, size_t pos, double d,
140
    int precision)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
141 142 143 144 145
{
   char number[64];
   sprintf(number, "%.*f", precision, d);
   return safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, number);
}
146
#endif
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
147

148 149
static PNG_CONST char invalid[] = "invalid";
static PNG_CONST char sep[] = ": ";
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
150

151
static PNG_CONST char *colour_types[8] =
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
152
{
153 154
   "grayscale", invalid, "truecolour", "indexed-colour",
   "grayscale with alpha", invalid, "truecolour with alpha", invalid
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
155 156
};

157 158 159 160 161 162 163 164
/* Convert a double precision value to fixed point. */
static png_fixed_point
fix(double d)
{
   d = floor(d * PNG_FP_1 + .5);
   return (png_fixed_point)d;
}

165 166 167 168 169 170 171 172
/* Generate random bytes.  This uses a boring repeatable algorithm and it
 * is implemented here so that it gives the same set of numbers on every
 * architecture.  It's a linear congruential generator (Knuth or Sedgewick
 * "Algorithms") but it comes from the 'feedback taps' table in Horowitz and
 * Hill, "The Art of Electronics".
 */
static void
make_random_bytes(png_uint_32* seed, void* pv, size_t size)
173
{
174
   png_uint_32 u0 = seed[0], u1 = seed[1];
175
   png_bytep bytes = voidcast(png_bytep, pv);
176

177 178 179 180 181 182 183 184 185 186 187 188 189 190
   /* There are thirty three bits, the next bit in the sequence is bit-33 XOR
    * bit-20.  The top 1 bit is in u1, the bottom 32 are in u0.
    */
   size_t i;
   for (i=0; i<size; ++i)
   {
      /* First generate 8 new bits then shift them in at the end. */
      png_uint_32 u = ((u0 >> (20-8)) ^ ((u1 << 7) | (u0 >> (32-7)))) & 0xff;
      u1 <<= 8;
      u1 |= u0 >> 24;
      u0 <<= 8;
      u0 |= u;
      *bytes++ = (png_byte)u;
   }
191

192 193 194
   seed[0] = u0;
   seed[1] = u1;
}
195

196 197 198 199 200
static void
make_four_random_bytes(png_uint_32* seed, png_bytep bytes)
{
   make_random_bytes(seed, bytes, 4);
}
201

202 203 204 205 206
static void
randomize(void *pv, size_t size)
{
   static png_uint_32 random_seed[2] = {0x56789abc, 0xd};
   make_random_bytes(random_seed, pv, size);
207 208
}

209 210
#define RANDOMIZE(this) randomize(&(this), sizeof (this))

211 212 213 214 215 216 217 218 219 220 221 222 223 224 225 226 227 228 229 230
static unsigned int
random_mod(unsigned int max)
{
   unsigned int x;

   RANDOMIZE(x);

   return x % max; /* 0 .. max-1 */
}

static int
random_choice(void)
{
   unsigned char x;

   RANDOMIZE(x);

   return x & 1;
}

231 232
/* A numeric ID based on PNG file characteristics.  The 'do_interlace' field
 * simply records whether pngvalid did the interlace itself or whether it
233 234
 * was done by libpng.  Width and height must be less than 256.  'palette' is an
 * index of the palette to use for formats with a palette (0 otherwise.)
235
 */
236 237
#define FILEID(col, depth, palette, interlace, width, height, do_interlace) \
   ((png_uint_32)((col) + ((depth)<<3) + ((palette)<<8) + ((interlace)<<13) + \
238 239
    (((do_interlace)!=0)<<15) + ((width)<<16) + ((height)<<24)))

240 241
#define COL_FROM_ID(id) ((png_byte)((id)& 0x7U))
#define DEPTH_FROM_ID(id) ((png_byte)(((id) >> 3) & 0x1fU))
242 243
#define PALETTE_FROM_ID(id) ((int)(((id) >> 8) & 0x1f))
#define INTERLACE_FROM_ID(id) ((int)(((id) >> 13) & 0x3))
244 245 246
#define DO_INTERLACE_FROM_ID(id) ((int)(((id)>>15) & 1))
#define WIDTH_FROM_ID(id) (((id)>>16) & 0xff)
#define HEIGHT_FROM_ID(id) (((id)>>24) & 0xff)
247 248 249 250

/* Utility to construct a standard name for a standard image. */
static size_t
standard_name(char *buffer, size_t bufsize, size_t pos, png_byte colour_type,
251 252
    int bit_depth, int npalette, int interlace_type,
    png_uint_32 w, png_uint_32 h, int do_interlace)
253 254
{
   pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, colour_types[colour_type]);
255 256 257 258 259 260
   if (npalette > 0)
   {
      pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, "[");
      pos = safecatn(buffer, bufsize, pos, npalette);
      pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, "]");
   }
261
   pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, " ");
262
   pos = safecatn(buffer, bufsize, pos, bit_depth);
263
   pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, " bit");
264 265

   if (interlace_type != PNG_INTERLACE_NONE)
266
   {
267
      pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, " interlaced");
268 269 270 271 272 273
      if (do_interlace)
         pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, "(pngvalid)");
      else
         pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, "(libpng)");
   }

274 275 276 277 278 279 280
   if (w > 0 || h > 0)
   {
      pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, " ");
      pos = safecatn(buffer, bufsize, pos, w);
      pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, "x");
      pos = safecatn(buffer, bufsize, pos, h);
   }
281 282 283 284 285 286 287 288

   return pos;
}

static size_t
standard_name_from_id(char *buffer, size_t bufsize, size_t pos, png_uint_32 id)
{
   return standard_name(buffer, bufsize, pos, COL_FROM_ID(id),
289
      DEPTH_FROM_ID(id), PALETTE_FROM_ID(id), INTERLACE_FROM_ID(id),
290
      WIDTH_FROM_ID(id), HEIGHT_FROM_ID(id), DO_INTERLACE_FROM_ID(id));
291 292
}

293 294 295 296 297 298 299 300 301 302 303 304 305 306 307 308 309
/* Convenience API and defines to list valid formats.  Note that 16 bit read and
 * write support is required to do 16 bit read tests (we must be able to make a
 * 16 bit image to test!)
 */
#ifdef PNG_WRITE_16BIT_SUPPORTED
#  define WRITE_BDHI 4
#  ifdef PNG_READ_16BIT_SUPPORTED
#     define READ_BDHI 4
#     define DO_16BIT
#  endif
#else
#  define WRITE_BDHI 3
#endif
#ifndef DO_16BIT
#  define READ_BDHI 3
#endif

310 311 312 313 314
/* The following defines the number of different palettes to generate for
 * each log bit depth of a colour type 3 standard image.
 */
#define PALETTE_COUNT(bit_depth) ((bit_depth) > 4 ? 1 : 16)

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
315
static int
316
next_format(png_bytep colour_type, png_bytep bit_depth, int* palette_number)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
317 318 319
{
   if (*bit_depth == 0)
   {
320
      *colour_type = 0, *bit_depth = 1, *palette_number = 0;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
321 322
      return 1;
   }
323

324 325 326 327 328 329 330 331 332
   if (*colour_type == 3)
   {
      /* Add multiple palettes for colour type 3. */
      if (++*palette_number < PALETTE_COUNT(*bit_depth))
         return 1;

      *palette_number = 0;
   }

333 334 335
   *bit_depth = (png_byte)(*bit_depth << 1);

   /* Palette images are restricted to 8 bit depth */
336 337 338 339 340
   if (*bit_depth <= 8
#     ifdef DO_16BIT
         || (*colour_type != 3 && *bit_depth <= 16)
#     endif
      )
341 342 343 344
      return 1;

   /* Move to the next color type, or return 0 at the end. */
   switch (*colour_type)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
345
   {
346 347 348 349 350 351 352 353 354 355 356 357 358 359 360 361 362 363 364 365 366 367
      case 0:
         *colour_type = 2;
         *bit_depth = 8;
         return 1;

      case 2:
         *colour_type = 3;
         *bit_depth = 1;
         return 1;

      case 3:
         *colour_type = 4;
         *bit_depth = 8;
         return 1;

      case 4:
         *colour_type = 6;
         *bit_depth = 8;
         return 1;

      default:
         return 0;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
368 369 370
   }
}

371
#ifdef PNG_READ_TRANSFORMS_SUPPORTED
372
static unsigned int
373
sample(png_const_bytep row, png_byte colour_type, png_byte bit_depth,
374
    png_uint_32 x, unsigned int sample_index)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
375
{
376
   png_uint_32 bit_index, result;
377

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
378 379
   /* Find a sample index for the desired sample: */
   x *= bit_depth;
380
   bit_index = x;
381

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
382 383 384
   if ((colour_type & 1) == 0) /* !palette */
   {
      if (colour_type & 2)
385
         bit_index *= 3;
386 387

      if (colour_type & 4)
388
         bit_index += x; /* Alpha channel */
389

390
      /* Multiple channels; select one: */
391
      if (colour_type & (2+4))
392
         bit_index += sample_index * bit_depth;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
393 394 395
   }

   /* Return the sample from the row as an integer. */
396
   row += bit_index >> 3;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
397
   result = *row;
398

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
399 400
   if (bit_depth == 8)
      return result;
401

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
402 403
   else if (bit_depth > 8)
      return (result << 8) + *++row;
404

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
405
   /* Less than 8 bits per sample. */
406 407
   bit_index &= 7;
   return (result >> (8-bit_index-bit_depth)) & ((1U<<bit_depth)-1);
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
408
}
409
#endif /* PNG_READ_TRANSFORMS_SUPPORTED */
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
410

411 412 413 414 415 416 417 418 419 420 421 422 423 424 425 426 427 428 429 430 431 432 433 434 435 436 437 438 439 440 441 442 443 444 445 446
/* Copy a single pixel, of a given size, from one buffer to another -
 * while this is basically bit addressed there is an implicit assumption
 * that pixels 8 or more bits in size are byte aligned and that pixels
 * do not otherwise cross byte boundaries.  (This is, so far as I know,
 * universally true in bitmap computer graphics.  [JCB 20101212])
 *
 * NOTE: The to and from buffers may be the same.
 */
static void
pixel_copy(png_bytep toBuffer, png_uint_32 toIndex,
   png_const_bytep fromBuffer, png_uint_32 fromIndex, unsigned int pixelSize)
{
   /* Assume we can multiply by 'size' without overflow because we are
    * just working in a single buffer.
    */
   toIndex *= pixelSize;
   fromIndex *= pixelSize;
   if (pixelSize < 8) /* Sub-byte */
   {
      /* Mask to select the location of the copied pixel: */
      unsigned int destMask = ((1U<<pixelSize)-1) << (8-pixelSize-(toIndex&7));
      /* The following read the entire pixels and clears the extra: */
      unsigned int destByte = toBuffer[toIndex >> 3] & ~destMask;
      unsigned int sourceByte = fromBuffer[fromIndex >> 3];

      /* Don't rely on << or >> supporting '0' here, just in case: */
      fromIndex &= 7;
      if (fromIndex > 0) sourceByte <<= fromIndex;
      if ((toIndex & 7) > 0) sourceByte >>= toIndex & 7;

      toBuffer[toIndex >> 3] = (png_byte)(destByte | (sourceByte & destMask));
   }
   else /* One or more bytes */
      memmove(toBuffer+(toIndex>>3), fromBuffer+(fromIndex>>3), pixelSize>>3);
}

447 448 449 450 451 452 453 454 455 456 457 458 459 460 461 462 463 464 465 466 467 468
/* Copy a complete row of pixels, taking into account potential partial
 * bytes at the end.
 */
static void
row_copy(png_bytep toBuffer, png_const_bytep fromBuffer, unsigned int bitWidth)
{
   memcpy(toBuffer, fromBuffer, bitWidth >> 3);

   if ((bitWidth & 7) != 0)
   {
      unsigned int mask;

      toBuffer += bitWidth >> 3;
      fromBuffer += bitWidth >> 3;
      /* The remaining bits are in the top of the byte, the mask is the bits to
       * retain.
       */
      mask = 0xff >> (bitWidth & 7);
      *toBuffer = (png_byte)((*toBuffer & mask) | (*fromBuffer & ~mask));
   }
}

469 470 471 472 473 474
/* Compare pixels - they are assumed to start at the first byte in the
 * given buffers.
 */
static int
pixel_cmp(png_const_bytep pa, png_const_bytep pb, png_uint_32 bit_width)
{
475
#if PNG_LIBPNG_VER < 10506
476 477 478 479 480 481 482 483 484 485 486 487 488 489 490 491 492 493 494 495
   if (memcmp(pa, pb, bit_width>>3) == 0)
   {
      png_uint_32 p;

      if ((bit_width & 7) == 0) return 0;

      /* Ok, any differences? */
      p = pa[bit_width >> 3];
      p ^= pb[bit_width >> 3];

      if (p == 0) return 0;

      /* There are, but they may not be significant, remove the bits
       * after the end (the low order bits in PNG.)
       */
      bit_width &= 7;
      p >>= 8-bit_width;

      if (p == 0) return 0;
   }
496 497 498 499 500 501 502
#else
   /* From libpng-1.5.6 the overwrite should be fixed, so compare the trailing
    * bits too:
    */
   if (memcmp(pa, pb, (bit_width+7)>>3) == 0)
      return 0;
#endif
503

504 505 506 507 508 509 510
   /* Return the index of the changed byte. */
   {
      png_uint_32 where = 0;

      while (pa[where] == pb[where]) ++where;
      return 1+where;
   }
511 512
}

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
513
/*************************** BASIC PNG FILE WRITING ***************************/
514
/* A png_store takes data from the sequential writer or provides data
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
515 516 517
 * to the sequential reader.  It can also store the result of a PNG
 * write for later retrieval.
 */
518 519
#define STORE_BUFFER_SIZE 500 /* arbitrary */
typedef struct png_store_buffer
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
520
{
521 522 523
   struct png_store_buffer*  prev;    /* NOTE: stored in reverse order */
   png_byte                  buffer[STORE_BUFFER_SIZE];
} png_store_buffer;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
524

525 526
#define FILE_NAME_SIZE 64

527 528 529 530 531 532 533 534
typedef struct store_palette_entry /* record of a single palette entry */
{
   png_byte red;
   png_byte green;
   png_byte blue;
   png_byte alpha;
} store_palette_entry, store_palette[256];

535
typedef struct png_store_file
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
536
{
537
   struct png_store_file*  next;      /* as many as you like... */
538
   char                    name[FILE_NAME_SIZE];
539
   png_uint_32             id;        /* must be correct (see FILEID) */
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
540
   png_size_t              datacount; /* In this (the last) buffer */
541
   png_store_buffer        data;      /* Last buffer in file */
542 543
   int                     npalette;  /* Number of entries in palette */
   store_palette_entry*    palette;   /* May be NULL */
544
} png_store_file;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
545

546 547 548 549 550 551 552 553 554 555 556 557 558 559 560 561 562 563 564 565 566
/* The following is a pool of memory allocated by a single libpng read or write
 * operation.
 */
typedef struct store_pool
{
   struct png_store    *store;   /* Back pointer */
   struct store_memory *list;    /* List of allocated memory */
   png_byte             mark[4]; /* Before and after data */

   /* Statistics for this run. */
   png_alloc_size_t     max;     /* Maximum single allocation */
   png_alloc_size_t     current; /* Current allocation */
   png_alloc_size_t     limit;   /* Highest current allocation */
   png_alloc_size_t     total;   /* Total allocation */

   /* Overall statistics (retained across successive runs). */
   png_alloc_size_t     max_max;
   png_alloc_size_t     max_limit;
   png_alloc_size_t     max_total;
} store_pool;

567
typedef struct png_store
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
568
{
569 570 571 572 573 574 575
   /* For cexcept.h exception handling - simply store one of these;
    * the context is a self pointer but it may point to a different
    * png_store (in fact it never does in this program.)
    */
   struct exception_context
                      exception_context;

576 577
   unsigned int       verbose :1;
   unsigned int       treat_warnings_as_errors :1;
578 579 580
   unsigned int       expect_error :1;
   unsigned int       expect_warning :1;
   unsigned int       saw_warning :1;
581
   unsigned int       speed :1;
582 583
   unsigned int       progressive :1; /* use progressive read */
   unsigned int       validated :1;   /* used as a temporary flag */
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
584 585
   int                nerrors;
   int                nwarnings;
586 587
   char               test[128]; /* Name of test */
   char               error[256];
588

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
589 590 591
   /* Read fields */
   png_structp        pread;    /* Used to read a saved file */
   png_infop          piread;
592 593
   png_store_file*    current;  /* Set when reading */
   png_store_buffer*  next;     /* Set when reading */
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
594
   png_size_t         readpos;  /* Position in *next */
595
   png_byte*          image;    /* Buffer for reading interlaced images */
596 597 598
   png_size_t         cb_image; /* Size of this buffer */
   png_size_t         cb_row;   /* Row size of the image(s) */
   png_uint_32        image_h;  /* Number of rows in a single image */
599
   store_pool         read_memory_pool;
600

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
601
   /* Write fields */
602
   png_store_file*    saved;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
603 604 605
   png_structp        pwrite;   /* Used when writing a new file */
   png_infop          piwrite;
   png_size_t         writepos; /* Position in .new */
606
   char               wname[FILE_NAME_SIZE];
607
   png_store_buffer   new;      /* The end of the new PNG file being written. */
608
   store_pool         write_memory_pool;
609 610
   store_palette_entry* palette;
   int                  npalette;
611
} png_store;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
612 613

/* Initialization and cleanup */
614
static void
615
store_pool_mark(png_bytep mark)
616
{
617
   static png_uint_32 store_seed[2] = { 0x12345678, 1};
618

619
   make_four_random_bytes(store_seed, mark);
620 621
}

622
/* Use this for random 32 bit values; this function makes sure the result is
623 624 625 626 627 628 629 630 631 632 633 634 635 636 637 638 639 640 641
 * non-zero.
 */
static png_uint_32
random_32(void)
{

   for(;;)
   {
      png_byte mark[4];
      png_uint_32 result;

      store_pool_mark(mark);
      result = png_get_uint_32(mark);

      if (result != 0)
         return result;
   }
}

642 643 644 645 646 647 648 649 650 651 652 653
static void
store_pool_init(png_store *ps, store_pool *pool)
{
   memset(pool, 0, sizeof *pool);

   pool->store = ps;
   pool->list = NULL;
   pool->max = pool->current = pool->limit = pool->total = 0;
   pool->max_max = pool->max_limit = pool->max_total = 0;
   store_pool_mark(pool->mark);
}

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
654
static void
655
store_init(png_store* ps)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
656 657
{
   memset(ps, 0, sizeof *ps);
658 659 660
   init_exception_context(&ps->exception_context);
   store_pool_init(ps, &ps->read_memory_pool);
   store_pool_init(ps, &ps->write_memory_pool);
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
661 662
   ps->verbose = 0;
   ps->treat_warnings_as_errors = 0;
663 664 665
   ps->expect_error = 0;
   ps->expect_warning = 0;
   ps->saw_warning = 0;
666
   ps->speed = 0;
667
   ps->progressive = 0;
668
   ps->validated = 0;
669
   ps->nerrors = ps->nwarnings = 0;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
670 671 672 673 674
   ps->pread = NULL;
   ps->piread = NULL;
   ps->saved = ps->current = NULL;
   ps->next = NULL;
   ps->readpos = 0;
675 676
   ps->image = NULL;
   ps->cb_image = 0;
677 678
   ps->cb_row = 0;
   ps->image_h = 0;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
679 680 681 682
   ps->pwrite = NULL;
   ps->piwrite = NULL;
   ps->writepos = 0;
   ps->new.prev = NULL;
683 684
   ps->palette = NULL;
   ps->npalette = 0;
685 686
}

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
687
static void
688
store_freebuffer(png_store_buffer* psb)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
689 690 691
{
   if (psb->prev)
   {
692
      store_freebuffer(psb->prev);
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
693 694 695 696 697 698
      free(psb->prev);
      psb->prev = NULL;
   }
}

static void
699
store_freenew(png_store *ps)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
700
{
701
   store_freebuffer(&ps->new);
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
702
   ps->writepos = 0;
703 704 705 706 707 708
   if (ps->palette != NULL)
   {
      free(ps->palette);
      ps->palette = NULL;
      ps->npalette = 0;
   }
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
709 710 711
}

static void
712
store_storenew(png_store *ps)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
713
{
714
   png_store_buffer *pb;
715

716
   if (ps->writepos != STORE_BUFFER_SIZE)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
717
      png_error(ps->pwrite, "invalid store call");
718

719
   pb = voidcast(png_store_buffer*, malloc(sizeof *pb));
720

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
721 722
   if (pb == NULL)
      png_error(ps->pwrite, "store new: OOM");
723

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
724 725 726 727 728 729
   *pb = ps->new;
   ps->new.prev = pb;
   ps->writepos = 0;
}

static void
730
store_freefile(png_store_file **ppf)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
731
{
732 733 734
   if (*ppf != NULL)
   {
      store_freefile(&(*ppf)->next);
735

736 737
      store_freebuffer(&(*ppf)->data);
      (*ppf)->datacount = 0;
738 739 740 741 742 743
      if ((*ppf)->palette != NULL)
      {
         free((*ppf)->palette);
         (*ppf)->palette = NULL;
         (*ppf)->npalette = 0;
      }
744 745 746
      free(*ppf);
      *ppf = NULL;
   }
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
747 748 749
}

/* Main interface to file storeage, after writing a new PNG file (see the API
750
 * below) call store_storefile to store the result with the given name and id.
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
751 752
 */
static void
753
store_storefile(png_store *ps, png_uint_32 id)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
754
{
755
   png_store_file *pf = voidcast(png_store_file*, malloc(sizeof *pf));
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
756 757 758 759 760 761 762 763
   if (pf == NULL)
      png_error(ps->pwrite, "storefile: OOM");
   safecat(pf->name, sizeof pf->name, 0, ps->wname);
   pf->id = id;
   pf->data = ps->new;
   pf->datacount = ps->writepos;
   ps->new.prev = NULL;
   ps->writepos = 0;
764 765 766 767
   pf->palette = ps->palette;
   pf->npalette = ps->npalette;
   ps->palette = 0;
   ps->npalette = 0;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
768 769 770 771 772 773 774 775

   /* And save it. */
   pf->next = ps->saved;
   ps->saved = pf;
}

/* Generate an error message (in the given buffer) */
static size_t
776 777
store_message(png_store *ps, png_structp pp, char *buffer, size_t bufsize,
   size_t pos, PNG_CONST char *msg)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
778
{
779
   if (pp != NULL && pp == ps->pread)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
780 781 782
   {
      /* Reading a file */
      pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, "read: ");
783

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
784 785 786
      if (ps->current != NULL)
      {
         pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, ps->current->name);
787
         pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, sep);
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
788 789
      }
   }
790

791
   else if (pp != NULL && pp == ps->pwrite)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
792 793 794 795
   {
      /* Writing a file */
      pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, "write: ");
      pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, ps->wname);
796
      pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, sep);
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
797
   }
798

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
799 800
   else
   {
801
      /* Neither reading nor writing (or a memory error in struct delete) */
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
802 803 804
      pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, "pngvalid: ");
   }

805 806 807 808 809
   if (ps->test[0] != 0)
   {
      pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, ps->test);
      pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, sep);
   }
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
810 811 812 813
   pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, msg);
   return pos;
}

814 815 816 817 818 819 820 821 822 823 824 825 826 827 828
/* Verbose output to the error stream: */
static void
store_verbose(png_store *ps, png_structp pp, png_const_charp prefix,
   png_const_charp message)
{
   char buffer[512];

   if (prefix)
      fputs(prefix, stderr);

   (void)store_message(ps, pp, buffer, sizeof buffer, 0, message);
   fputs(buffer, stderr);
   fputc('\n', stderr);
}

829
/* Log an error or warning - the relevant count is always incremented. */
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
830
static void
831
store_log(png_store* ps, png_structp pp, png_const_charp message, int is_error)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
832
{
833 834 835 836 837 838 839
   /* The warning is copied to the error buffer if there are no errors and it is
    * the first warning.  The error is copied to the error buffer if it is the
    * first error (overwriting any prior warnings).
    */
   if (is_error ? (ps->nerrors)++ == 0 :
       (ps->nwarnings)++ == 0 && ps->nerrors == 0)
      store_message(ps, pp, ps->error, sizeof ps->error, 0, message);
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
840

841
   if (ps->verbose)
842
      store_verbose(ps, pp, is_error ? "error: " : "warning: ", message);
843
}
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
844

845 846 847 848 849 850 851 852 853 854 855 856 857
/* Internal error function, called with a png_store but no libpng stuff. */
static void
internal_error(png_store *ps, png_const_charp message)
{
   store_log(ps, NULL, message, 1 /* error */);

   /* And finally throw an exception. */
   {
      struct exception_context *the_exception_context = &ps->exception_context;
      Throw ps;
   }
}

858 859 860 861
/* Functions to use as PNG callbacks. */
static void
store_error(png_structp pp, png_const_charp message) /* PNG_NORETURN */
{
862
   png_store *ps = voidcast(png_store*, png_get_error_ptr(pp));
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
863

864
   if (!ps->expect_error)
865
      store_log(ps, pp, message, 1 /* error */);
866 867 868 869 870 871

   /* And finally throw an exception. */
   {
      struct exception_context *the_exception_context = &ps->exception_context;
      Throw ps;
   }
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
872 873 874
}

static void
875
store_warning(png_structp pp, png_const_charp message)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
876
{
877
   png_store *ps = voidcast(png_store*, png_get_error_ptr(pp));
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
878

879
   if (!ps->expect_warning)
880
      store_log(ps, pp, message, 0 /* warning */);
881 882
   else
      ps->saw_warning = 1;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
883 884
}

885 886 887 888 889 890 891 892 893 894 895 896 897 898 899 900 901 902 903 904 905 906 907 908 909 910 911 912 913 914 915 916 917 918 919 920 921 922 923 924 925 926 927 928 929 930 931 932 933 934 935 936 937 938
/* These somewhat odd functions are used when reading an image to ensure that
 * the buffer is big enough, the png_structp is for errors.
 */
/* Return a single row from the correct image. */
static png_bytep
store_image_row(PNG_CONST png_store* ps, png_structp pp, int nImage,
   png_uint_32 y)
{
   png_size_t coffset = (nImage * ps->image_h + y) * (ps->cb_row + 5) + 2;

   if (ps->image == NULL)
      png_error(pp, "no allocated image");

   if (coffset + ps->cb_row + 3 > ps->cb_image)
      png_error(pp, "image too small");

   return ps->image + coffset;
}

static void
store_image_free(png_store *ps, png_structp pp)
{
   if (ps->image != NULL)
   {
      png_bytep image = ps->image;

      if (image[-1] != 0xed || image[ps->cb_image] != 0xfe)
      {
         if (pp != NULL)
            png_error(pp, "png_store image overwrite (1)");
         else
            store_log(ps, NULL, "png_store image overwrite (2)", 1);
      }

      ps->image = NULL;
      ps->cb_image = 0;
      --image;
      free(image);
   }
}

static void
store_ensure_image(png_store *ps, png_structp pp, int nImages, png_size_t cbRow,
   png_uint_32 cRows)
{
   png_size_t cb = nImages * cRows * (cbRow + 5);

   if (ps->cb_image < cb)
   {
      png_bytep image;

      store_image_free(ps, pp);

      /* The buffer is deliberately mis-aligned. */
939
      image = voidcast(png_bytep, malloc(cb+2));
940 941 942 943 944 945 946 947 948 949 950 951 952 953 954 955 956 957
      if (image == NULL)
      {
         /* Called from the startup - ignore the error for the moment. */
         if (pp == NULL)
            return;

         png_error(pp, "OOM allocating image buffer");
      }

      /* These magic tags are used to detect overwrites above. */
      ++image;
      image[-1] = 0xed;
      image[cb] = 0xfe;

      ps->image = image;
      ps->cb_image = cb;
   }

958
   /* We have an adequate sized image; lay out the rows.  There are 2 bytes at
959 960
    * the start and three at the end of each (this ensures that the row
    * alignment starts out odd - 2+1 and changes for larger images on each row.)
961 962 963 964
    */
   ps->cb_row = cbRow;
   ps->image_h = cRows;

965 966 967 968 969
   /* For error checking, the whole buffer is set to 10110010 (0xb2 - 178).
    * This deliberately doesn't match the bits in the size test image which are
    * outside the image; these are set to 0xff (all 1).  To make the row
    * comparison work in the 'size' test case the size rows are pre-initialized
    * to the same value prior to calling 'standard_row'.
970
    */
971
   memset(ps->image, 178, cb);
972

973
   /* Then put in the marks. */
974 975 976 977 978 979 980 981 982 983 984 985 986 987 988 989 990 991 992 993 994 995 996 997 998 999 1000 1001 1002 1003 1004 1005 1006 1007 1008 1009 1010 1011 1012 1013 1014 1015 1016 1017 1018 1019 1020 1021
   while (--nImages >= 0)
   {
      png_uint_32 y;

      for (y=0; y<cRows; ++y)
      {
         png_bytep row = store_image_row(ps, pp, nImages, y);

         /* The markers: */
         row[-2] = 190;
         row[-1] = 239;
         row[cbRow] = 222;
         row[cbRow+1] = 173;
         row[cbRow+2] = 17;
      }
   }
}

static void
store_image_check(PNG_CONST png_store* ps, png_structp pp, int iImage)
{
   png_const_bytep image = ps->image;

   if (image[-1] != 0xed || image[ps->cb_image] != 0xfe)
      png_error(pp, "image overwrite");
   else
   {
      png_size_t cbRow = ps->cb_row;
      png_uint_32 rows = ps->image_h;

      image += iImage * (cbRow+5) * ps->image_h;

      image += 2; /* skip image first row markers */

      while (rows-- > 0)
      {
         if (image[-2] != 190 || image[-1] != 239)
            png_error(pp, "row start overwritten");

         if (image[cbRow] != 222 || image[cbRow+1] != 173 ||
            image[cbRow+2] != 17)
            png_error(pp, "row end overwritten");

         image += cbRow+5;
      }
   }
}

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1022
static void
1023
store_write(png_structp pp, png_bytep pb, png_size_t st)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1024
{
1025
   png_store *ps = voidcast(png_store*, png_get_io_ptr(pp));
1026

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1027
   if (ps->pwrite != pp)
1028
      png_error(pp, "store state damaged");
1029

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1030 1031 1032 1033
   while (st > 0)
   {
      size_t cb;

1034 1035
      if (ps->writepos >= STORE_BUFFER_SIZE)
         store_storenew(ps);
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1036 1037

      cb = st;
1038

1039 1040
      if (cb > STORE_BUFFER_SIZE - ps->writepos)
         cb = STORE_BUFFER_SIZE - ps->writepos;
1041

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1042 1043 1044 1045 1046 1047 1048 1049
      memcpy(ps->new.buffer + ps->writepos, pb, cb);
      pb += cb;
      st -= cb;
      ps->writepos += cb;
   }
}

static void
1050
store_flush(png_structp pp)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1051
{
1052
   UNUSED(pp) /*DOES NOTHING*/
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1053 1054 1055
}

static size_t
1056
store_read_buffer_size(png_store *ps)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1057 1058 1059
{
   /* Return the bytes available for read in the current buffer. */
   if (ps->next != &ps->current->data)
1060
      return STORE_BUFFER_SIZE;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1061 1062 1063 1064

   return ps->current->datacount;
}

1065
#ifdef PNG_READ_TRANSFORMS_SUPPORTED
1066 1067 1068 1069 1070 1071 1072 1073 1074 1075 1076 1077 1078 1079 1080 1081 1082 1083 1084 1085 1086 1087 1088 1089
/* Return total bytes available for read. */
static size_t
store_read_buffer_avail(png_store *ps)
{
   if (ps->current != NULL && ps->next != NULL)
   {
      png_store_buffer *next = &ps->current->data;
      size_t cbAvail = ps->current->datacount;

      while (next != ps->next && next != NULL)
      {
         next = next->prev;
         cbAvail += STORE_BUFFER_SIZE;
      }

      if (next != ps->next)
         png_error(ps->pread, "buffer read error");

      if (cbAvail > ps->readpos)
         return cbAvail - ps->readpos;
   }

   return 0;
}
1090
#endif
1091

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1092
static int
1093
store_read_buffer_next(png_store *ps)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1094
{
1095 1096
   png_store_buffer *pbOld = ps->next;
   png_store_buffer *pbNew = &ps->current->data;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1097 1098 1099 1100
   if (pbOld != pbNew)
   {
      while (pbNew != NULL && pbNew->prev != pbOld)
         pbNew = pbNew->prev;
1101

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1102 1103 1104
      if (pbNew != NULL)
      {
         ps->next = pbNew;
1105 1106
         ps->readpos = 0;
         return 1;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1107 1108 1109 1110 1111 1112 1113 1114
      }

      png_error(ps->pread, "buffer lost");
   }

   return 0; /* EOF or error */
}

1115 1116 1117
/* Need separate implementation and callback to allow use of the same code
 * during progressive read, where the io_ptr is set internally by libpng.
 */
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1118
static void
1119
store_read_imp(png_store *ps, png_bytep pb, png_size_t st)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1120
{
1121 1122
   if (ps->current == NULL || ps->next == NULL)
      png_error(ps->pread, "store state damaged");
1123

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1124 1125
   while (st > 0)
   {
1126
      size_t cbAvail = store_read_buffer_size(ps) - ps->readpos;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1127 1128 1129 1130

      if (cbAvail > 0)
      {
         if (cbAvail > st) cbAvail = st;
1131 1132 1133 1134
         memcpy(pb, ps->next->buffer + ps->readpos, cbAvail);
         st -= cbAvail;
         pb += cbAvail;
         ps->readpos += cbAvail;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1135
      }
1136

1137
      else if (!store_read_buffer_next(ps))
1138
         png_error(ps->pread, "read beyond end of file");
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1139 1140 1141
   }
}

1142
static void
1143
store_read(png_structp pp, png_bytep pb, png_size_t st)
1144
{
1145
   png_store *ps = voidcast(png_store*, png_get_io_ptr(pp));
1146

1147 1148 1149 1150 1151 1152 1153 1154 1155
   if (ps == NULL || ps->pread != pp)
      png_error(pp, "bad store read call");

   store_read_imp(ps, pb, st);
}

static void
store_progressive_read(png_store *ps, png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
{
1156 1157 1158 1159
   /* Notice that a call to store_read will cause this function to fail because
    * readpos will be set.
    */
   if (ps->pread != pp || ps->current == NULL || ps->next == NULL)
1160
      png_error(pp, "store state damaged (progressive)");
1161 1162 1163 1164 1165 1166 1167 1168 1169 1170 1171

   do
   {
      if (ps->readpos != 0)
         png_error(pp, "store_read called during progressive read");

      png_process_data(pp, pi, ps->next->buffer, store_read_buffer_size(ps));
   }
   while (store_read_buffer_next(ps));
}

1172 1173 1174 1175 1176 1177 1178 1179 1180 1181 1182 1183 1184
/* The caller must fill this in: */
static store_palette_entry *
store_write_palette(png_store *ps, int npalette)
{
   if (ps->pwrite == NULL)
      store_log(ps, NULL, "attempt to write palette without write stream", 1);

   if (ps->palette != NULL)
      png_error(ps->pwrite, "multiple store_write_palette calls");

   /* This function can only return NULL if called with '0'! */
   if (npalette > 0)
   {
1185 1186
      ps->palette = voidcast(store_palette_entry*, malloc(npalette *
         sizeof *ps->palette));
1187 1188 1189 1190 1191 1192 1193 1194 1195 1196 1197 1198 1199 1200 1201 1202 1203 1204 1205 1206 1207 1208 1209 1210

      if (ps->palette == NULL)
         png_error(ps->pwrite, "store new palette: OOM");

      ps->npalette = npalette;
   }

   return ps->palette;
}

static store_palette_entry *
store_current_palette(png_store *ps, int *npalette)
{
   /* This is an internal error (the call has been made outside a read
    * operation.)
    */
   if (ps->current == NULL)
      store_log(ps, ps->pread, "no current stream for palette", 1);

   /* The result may be null if there is no palette. */
   *npalette = ps->current->npalette;
   return ps->current->palette;
}

1211 1212 1213 1214 1215 1216 1217 1218 1219 1220 1221 1222 1223 1224 1225 1226 1227 1228 1229 1230 1231
/***************************** MEMORY MANAGEMENT*** ***************************/
/* A store_memory is simply the header for an allocated block of memory.  The
 * pointer returned to libpng is just after the end of the header block, the
 * allocated memory is followed by a second copy of the 'mark'.
 */
typedef struct store_memory
{
   store_pool          *pool;    /* Originating pool */
   struct store_memory *next;    /* Singly linked list */
   png_alloc_size_t     size;    /* Size of memory allocated */
   png_byte             mark[4]; /* ID marker */
} store_memory;

/* Handle a fatal error in memory allocation.  This calls png_error if the
 * libpng struct is non-NULL, else it outputs a message and returns.  This means
 * that a memory problem while libpng is running will abort (png_error) the
 * handling of particular file while one in cleanup (after the destroy of the
 * struct has returned) will simply keep going and free (or attempt to free)
 * all the memory.
 */
static void
1232
store_pool_error(png_store *ps, png_structp pp, PNG_CONST char *msg)
1233 1234 1235 1236
{
   if (pp != NULL)
      png_error(pp, msg);

1237 1238 1239 1240
   /* Else we have to do it ourselves.  png_error eventually calls store_log,
    * above.  store_log accepts a NULL png_structp - it just changes what gets
    * output by store_message.
    */
1241
   store_log(ps, pp, msg, 1 /* error */);
1242 1243 1244 1245 1246 1247 1248 1249 1250 1251
}

static void
store_memory_free(png_structp pp, store_pool *pool, store_memory *memory)
{
   /* Note that pp may be NULL (see store_pool_delete below), the caller has
    * found 'memory' in pool->list *and* unlinked this entry, so this is a valid
    * pointer (for sure), but the contents may have been trashed.
    */
   if (memory->pool != pool)
1252
      store_pool_error(pool->store, pp, "memory corrupted (pool)");
1253 1254

   else if (memcmp(memory->mark, pool->mark, sizeof memory->mark) != 0)
1255
      store_pool_error(pool->store, pp, "memory corrupted (start)");
1256 1257 1258 1259 1260 1261 1262

   /* It should be safe to read the size field now. */
   else
   {
      png_alloc_size_t cb = memory->size;

      if (cb > pool->max)
1263
         store_pool_error(pool->store, pp, "memory corrupted (size)");
1264 1265 1266

      else if (memcmp((png_bytep)(memory+1)+cb, pool->mark, sizeof pool->mark)
         != 0)
1267
         store_pool_error(pool->store, pp, "memory corrupted (end)");
1268 1269 1270 1271 1272 1273 1274 1275 1276 1277 1278 1279 1280 1281 1282 1283 1284 1285 1286 1287 1288 1289 1290 1291 1292 1293 1294

      /* Finally give the library a chance to find problems too: */
      else
         {
         pool->current -= cb;
         free(memory);
         }
   }
}

static void
store_pool_delete(png_store *ps, store_pool *pool)
{
   if (pool->list != NULL)
   {
      fprintf(stderr, "%s: %s %s: memory lost (list follows):\n", ps->test,
         pool == &ps->read_memory_pool ? "read" : "write",
         pool == &ps->read_memory_pool ? (ps->current != NULL ?
            ps->current->name : "unknown file") : ps->wname);
      ++ps->nerrors;

      do
      {
         store_memory *next = pool->list;
         pool->list = next->next;
         next->next = NULL;

1295
         fprintf(stderr, "\t%lu bytes @ %p\n",
1296
             (unsigned long)next->size, (PNG_CONST void*)(next+1));
1297 1298 1299 1300 1301 1302 1303 1304 1305 1306 1307 1308 1309 1310 1311 1312 1313
         /* The NULL means this will always return, even if the memory is
          * corrupted.
          */
         store_memory_free(NULL, pool, next);
      }
      while (pool->list != NULL);
   }

   /* And reset the other fields too for the next time. */
   if (pool->max > pool->max_max) pool->max_max = pool->max;
   pool->max = 0;
   if (pool->current != 0) /* unexpected internal error */
      fprintf(stderr, "%s: %s %s: memory counter mismatch (internal error)\n",
         ps->test, pool == &ps->read_memory_pool ? "read" : "write",
         pool == &ps->read_memory_pool ? (ps->current != NULL ?
            ps->current->name : "unknown file") : ps->wname);
   pool->current = 0;
1314 1315 1316 1317

   if (pool->limit > pool->max_limit)
      pool->max_limit = pool->limit;

1318
   pool->limit = 0;
1319 1320 1321 1322

   if (pool->total > pool->max_total)
      pool->max_total = pool->total;

1323 1324 1325 1326 1327 1328 1329 1330 1331 1332
   pool->total = 0;

   /* Get a new mark too. */
   store_pool_mark(pool->mark);
}

/* The memory callbacks: */
static png_voidp
store_malloc(png_structp pp, png_alloc_size_t cb)
{
1333 1334 1335
   store_pool *pool = voidcast(store_pool*, png_get_mem_ptr(pp));
   store_memory *new = voidcast(store_memory*, malloc(cb + (sizeof *new) +
      (sizeof pool->mark)));
1336 1337 1338

   if (new != NULL)
   {
1339 1340 1341
      if (cb > pool->max)
         pool->max = cb;

1342
      pool->current += cb;
1343 1344 1345 1346

      if (pool->current > pool->limit)
         pool->limit = pool->current;

1347 1348 1349 1350 1351 1352 1353 1354 1355 1356
      pool->total += cb;

      new->size = cb;
      memcpy(new->mark, pool->mark, sizeof new->mark);
      memcpy((png_byte*)(new+1) + cb, pool->mark, sizeof pool->mark);
      new->pool = pool;
      new->next = pool->list;
      pool->list = new;
      ++new;
   }
1357

1358
   else
1359 1360 1361 1362 1363 1364 1365 1366 1367 1368 1369 1370 1371 1372 1373
   {
      /* NOTE: the PNG user malloc function cannot use the png_ptr it is passed
       * other than to retrieve the allocation pointer!  libpng calls the
       * store_malloc callback in two basic cases:
       *
       * 1) From png_malloc; png_malloc will do a png_error itself if NULL is
       *    returned.
       * 2) From png_struct or png_info structure creation; png_malloc is
       *    to return so cleanup can be performed.
       *
       * To handle this store_malloc can log a message, but can't do anything
       * else.
       */
      store_log(pool->store, pp, "out of memory", 1 /* is_error */);
   }
1374 1375 1376 1377 1378 1379 1380

   return new;
}

static void
store_free(png_structp pp, png_voidp memory)
{
1381 1382
   store_pool *pool = voidcast(store_pool*, png_get_mem_ptr(pp));
   store_memory *this = voidcast(store_memory*, memory), **test;
1383

1384 1385 1386 1387 1388 1389 1390 1391
   /* Because libpng calls store_free with a dummy png_struct when deleting
    * png_struct or png_info via png_destroy_struct_2 it is necessary to check
    * the passed in png_structp to ensure it is valid, and not pass it to
    * png_error if it is not.
    */
   if (pp != pool->store->pread && pp != pool->store->pwrite)
      pp = NULL;

1392
   /* First check that this 'memory' really is valid memory - it must be in the
1393
    * pool list.  If it is, use the shared memory_free function to free it.
1394 1395 1396 1397 1398 1399
    */
   --this;
   for (test = &pool->list; *test != this; test = &(*test)->next)
   {
      if (*test == NULL)
      {
1400
         store_pool_error(pool->store, pp, "bad pointer to free");
1401 1402 1403 1404 1405 1406 1407 1408 1409 1410
         return;
      }
   }

   /* Unlink this entry, *test == this. */
   *test = this->next;
   this->next = NULL;
   store_memory_free(pp, pool, this);
}

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1411 1412 1413
/* Setup functions. */
/* Cleanup when aborting a write or after storing the new file. */
static void
1414
store_write_reset(png_store *ps)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1415 1416 1417
{
   if (ps->pwrite != NULL)
   {
1418 1419 1420 1421 1422 1423 1424 1425 1426 1427
      anon_context(ps);

      Try
         png_destroy_write_struct(&ps->pwrite, &ps->piwrite);

      Catch_anonymous
      {
         /* memory corruption: continue. */
      }

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1428 1429 1430
      ps->pwrite = NULL;
      ps->piwrite = NULL;
   }
1431 1432 1433 1434 1435

   /* And make sure that all the memory has been freed - this will output
    * spurious errors in the case of memory corruption above, but this is safe.
    */
   store_pool_delete(ps, &ps->write_memory_pool);
1436

1437
   store_freenew(ps);
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1438 1439 1440
}

/* The following is the main write function, it returns a png_struct and,
1441
 * optionally, a png_info suitable for writiing a new PNG file.  Use
1442 1443
 * store_storefile above to record this file after it has been written.  The
 * returned libpng structures as destroyed by store_write_reset above.
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1444 1445
 */
static png_structp
1446 1447
set_store_for_write(png_store *ps, png_infopp ppi,
   PNG_CONST char * volatile name)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1448
{
1449
   anon_context(ps);
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1450

1451 1452 1453
   Try
   {
      if (ps->pwrite != NULL)
1454
         png_error(ps->pwrite, "write store already in use");
1455 1456 1457

      store_write_reset(ps);
      safecat(ps->wname, sizeof ps->wname, 0, name);
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1458

1459 1460 1461 1462
      /* Don't do the slow memory checks if doing a speed test. */
      if (ps->speed)
         ps->pwrite = png_create_write_struct(PNG_LIBPNG_VER_STRING,
            ps, store_error, store_warning);
1463

1464 1465 1466 1467
      else
         ps->pwrite = png_create_write_struct_2(PNG_LIBPNG_VER_STRING,
            ps, store_error, store_warning, &ps->write_memory_pool,
            store_malloc, store_free);
1468

1469
      png_set_write_fn(ps->pwrite, ps, store_write, store_flush);
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1470

1471 1472 1473 1474
      if (ppi != NULL)
         *ppi = ps->piwrite = png_create_info_struct(ps->pwrite);
   }

1475 1476
   Catch_anonymous
      return NULL;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1477

1478
   return ps->pwrite;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1479 1480
}

1481
/* Cleanup when finished reading (either due to error or in the success case).
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1482 1483
 */
static void
1484
store_read_reset(png_store *ps)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1485 1486 1487
{
   if (ps->pread != NULL)
   {
1488
      anon_context(ps);
1489

1490 1491 1492 1493 1494
      Try
         png_destroy_read_struct(&ps->pread, &ps->piread, NULL);

      Catch_anonymous
      {
1495
         /* error already output: continue */
1496 1497
      }

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1498 1499 1500 1501
      ps->pread = NULL;
      ps->piread = NULL;
   }

1502 1503 1504
   /* Always do this to be safe. */
   store_pool_delete(ps, &ps->read_memory_pool);

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1505 1506 1507
   ps->current = NULL;
   ps->next = NULL;
   ps->readpos = 0;
1508
   ps->validated = 0;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1509 1510 1511
}

static void
1512
store_read_set(png_store *ps, png_uint_32 id)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1513
{
1514
   png_store_file *pf = ps->saved;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1515 1516 1517 1518 1519 1520

   while (pf != NULL)
   {
      if (pf->id == id)
      {
         ps->current = pf;
1521
         ps->next = NULL;
1522
         store_read_buffer_next(ps);
1523
         return;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1524 1525 1526 1527 1528
      }

      pf = pf->next;
   }

1529 1530 1531 1532 1533 1534 1535 1536
      {
      size_t pos;
      char msg[FILE_NAME_SIZE+64];

      pos = standard_name_from_id(msg, sizeof msg, 0, id);
      pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, ": file not found");
      png_error(ps->pread, msg);
      }
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1537 1538 1539 1540 1541
}

/* The main interface for reading a saved file - pass the id number of the file
 * to retrieve.  Ids must be unique or the earlier file will be hidden.  The API
 * returns a png_struct and, optionally, a png_info.  Both of these will be
1542
 * destroyed by store_read_reset above.
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1543 1544
 */
static png_structp
1545
set_store_for_read(png_store *ps, png_infopp ppi, png_uint_32 id,
1546
   PNG_CONST char *name)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1547
{
1548
   /* Set the name for png_error */
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1549 1550
   safecat(ps->test, sizeof ps->test, 0, name);

1551
   if (ps->pread != NULL)
1552
      png_error(ps->pread, "read store already in use");
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1553

1554
   store_read_reset(ps);
1555

1556
   /* Both the create APIs can return NULL if used in their default mode
1557 1558 1559 1560
    * (because there is no other way of handling an error because the jmp_buf
    * by default is stored in png_struct and that has not been allocated!)
    * However, given that store_error works correctly in these circumstances
    * we don't ever expect NULL in this program.
1561 1562 1563 1564
    */
   if (ps->speed)
      ps->pread = png_create_read_struct(PNG_LIBPNG_VER_STRING, ps,
          store_error, store_warning);
1565

1566 1567 1568 1569
   else
      ps->pread = png_create_read_struct_2(PNG_LIBPNG_VER_STRING, ps,
          store_error, store_warning, &ps->read_memory_pool, store_malloc,
          store_free);
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1570

1571 1572 1573
   if (ps->pread == NULL)
   {
      struct exception_context *the_exception_context = &ps->exception_context;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1574

1575
      store_log(ps, NULL, "png_create_read_struct returned NULL (unexpected)",
1576
         1 /*error*/);
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1577

1578
      Throw ps;
1579
   }
1580

1581
   store_read_set(ps, id);
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1582

1583 1584 1585 1586
   if (ppi != NULL)
      *ppi = ps->piread = png_create_info_struct(ps->pread);

   return ps->pread;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1587 1588
}

1589 1590 1591 1592 1593 1594 1595 1596 1597
/* The overall cleanup of a store simply calls the above then removes all the
 * saved files.  This does not delete the store itself.
 */
static void
store_delete(png_store *ps)
{
   store_write_reset(ps);
   store_read_reset(ps);
   store_freefile(&ps->saved);
1598
   store_image_free(ps, NULL);
1599 1600
}

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1601 1602
/*********************** PNG FILE MODIFICATION ON READ ************************/
/* Files may be modified on read.  The following structure contains a complete
1603
 * png_store together with extra members to handle modification and a special
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1604 1605 1606
 * read callback for libpng.  To use this the 'modifications' field must be set
 * to a list of png_modification structures that actually perform the
 * modification, otherwise a png_modifier is functionally equivalent to a
1607 1608
 * png_store.  There is a special read function, set_modifier_for_read, which
 * replaces set_store_for_read.
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1609
 */
1610 1611 1612 1613 1614 1615 1616
typedef enum modifier_state
{
   modifier_start,                        /* Initial value */
   modifier_signature,                    /* Have a signature */
   modifier_IHDR                          /* Have an IHDR */
} modifier_state;

1617 1618 1619 1620 1621 1622 1623 1624 1625 1626 1627 1628 1629 1630 1631 1632 1633 1634 1635 1636 1637 1638 1639 1640 1641 1642 1643 1644 1645 1646 1647 1648 1649 1650 1651 1652 1653 1654 1655 1656 1657 1658 1659 1660 1661 1662 1663 1664 1665 1666 1667 1668 1669 1670 1671 1672 1673 1674 1675 1676 1677 1678 1679 1680 1681 1682 1683 1684 1685 1686 1687 1688 1689 1690 1691 1692 1693 1694 1695 1696 1697 1698 1699 1700 1701 1702 1703 1704 1705 1706 1707 1708 1709 1710 1711 1712 1713 1714 1715 1716 1717 1718 1719 1720 1721 1722
typedef struct CIE_color
{
   /* A single CIE tristimulus value, representing the unique response of a
    * standard observer to a variety of light spectra.  The observer recognizes
    * all spectra that produce this response as the same color, therefore this
    * is effectively a description of a color.
    */
   double X, Y, Z;
} CIE_color;

static double
chromaticity_x(CIE_color c)
{
   return c.X / (c.X + c.Y + c.Z);
}

static double
chromaticity_y(CIE_color c)
{
   return c.Y / (c.X + c.Y + c.Z);
}

typedef struct color_encoding
{
   /* A description of an (R,G,B) encoding of color (as defined above); this
    * includes the actual colors of the (R,G,B) triples (1,0,0), (0,1,0) and
    * (0,0,1) plus an encoding value that is used to encode the linear
    * components R, G and B to give the actual values R^gamma, G^gamma and
    * B^gamma that are stored.
    */
   double    gamma;            /* Encoding (file) gamma of space */
   CIE_color red, green, blue; /* End points */
} color_encoding;

static CIE_color
white_point(PNG_CONST color_encoding *encoding)
{
   CIE_color white;
   
   white.X = encoding->red.X + encoding->green.X + encoding->blue.X;
   white.Y = encoding->red.Y + encoding->green.Y + encoding->blue.Y;
   white.Z = encoding->red.Z + encoding->green.Z + encoding->blue.Z;

   return white;
}

static void
normalize_color_encoding(color_encoding *encoding)
{
   PNG_CONST double whiteY = encoding->red.Y + encoding->green.Y +
      encoding->blue.Y;

   if (whiteY != 1)
   {
      encoding->red.X /= whiteY;
      encoding->red.Y /= whiteY;
      encoding->red.Z /= whiteY;
      encoding->green.X /= whiteY;
      encoding->green.Y /= whiteY;
      encoding->green.Z /= whiteY;
      encoding->blue.X /= whiteY;
      encoding->blue.Y /= whiteY;
      encoding->blue.Z /= whiteY;
   }
}

static size_t
safecat_color_encoding(char *buffer, size_t bufsize, size_t pos,
   PNG_CONST color_encoding *e, double encoding_gamma)
{
   if (e != 0)
   {
      if (encoding_gamma != 0)
         pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, "(");
      pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, "R(");
      pos = safecatd(buffer, bufsize, pos, e->red.X, 4);
      pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, ",");
      pos = safecatd(buffer, bufsize, pos, e->red.Y, 4);
      pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, ",");
      pos = safecatd(buffer, bufsize, pos, e->red.Z, 4);
      pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, "),G(");
      pos = safecatd(buffer, bufsize, pos, e->green.X, 4);
      pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, ",");
      pos = safecatd(buffer, bufsize, pos, e->green.Y, 4);
      pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, ",");
      pos = safecatd(buffer, bufsize, pos, e->green.Z, 4);
      pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, "),B(");
      pos = safecatd(buffer, bufsize, pos, e->blue.X, 4);
      pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, ",");
      pos = safecatd(buffer, bufsize, pos, e->blue.Y, 4);
      pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, ",");
      pos = safecatd(buffer, bufsize, pos, e->blue.Z, 4);
      pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, ")");
      if (encoding_gamma != 0)
         pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, ")");
   }

   if (encoding_gamma != 0)
   {
      pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, "^");
      pos = safecatd(buffer, bufsize, pos, encoding_gamma, 5);
   }

   return pos;
}

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1723 1724
typedef struct png_modifier
{
1725
   png_store               this;             /* I am a png_store */
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1726
   struct png_modification *modifications;   /* Changes to make */
1727

1728
   modifier_state           state;           /* My state */
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1729 1730 1731 1732 1733 1734 1735 1736 1737 1738 1739 1740

   /* Information from IHDR: */
   png_byte                 bit_depth;       /* From IHDR */
   png_byte                 colour_type;     /* From IHDR */

   /* While handling PLTE, IDAT and IEND these chunks may be pended to allow
    * other chunks to be inserted.
    */
   png_uint_32              pending_len;
   png_uint_32              pending_chunk;

   /* Test values */
1741 1742 1743 1744 1745 1746 1747 1748 1749 1750 1751 1752 1753 1754 1755 1756
   double                   *gammas;
   unsigned int              ngammas;
   unsigned int              ngamma_tests;     /* Number of gamma tests to run*/
   double                    current_gamma;    /* 0 if not set */
   PNG_CONST color_encoding *encodings;
   unsigned int              nencodings;
   PNG_CONST color_encoding *current_encoding; /* If an encoding has been set */
   unsigned int              encoding_counter; /* For iteration */
   int                       encoding_ignored; /* Something overwrote it */

   /* Control variables used to iterate through possible encodings, the
    * following must be set to 0 and tested by the function that uses the
    * png_modifier because the modifier only sets it to 1 (true.)
    */
   unsigned int              repeat :1;   /* Repeat this transform test. */
   unsigned int              test_uses_encoding :1;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1757 1758

   /* Lowest sbit to test (libpng fails for sbit < 8) */
1759
   png_byte                 sbitlow;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1760 1761 1762 1763 1764

   /* Error control - these are the limits on errors accepted by the gamma tests
    * below.
    */
   double                   maxout8;  /* Maximum output value error */
G
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1765
   double                   maxabs8;  /* Absolute sample error 0..1 */
1766
   double                   maxcalc8; /* Absolute sample error 0..1 */
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1767 1768 1769
   double                   maxpc8;   /* Percentage sample error 0..100% */
   double                   maxout16; /* Maximum output value error */
   double                   maxabs16; /* Absolute sample error 0..1 */
1770
   double                   maxcalc16;/* Absolute sample error 0..1 */
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1771 1772
   double                   maxpc16;  /* Percentage sample error 0..100% */

1773 1774 1775 1776 1777 1778 1779
   /* This is set by transforms that need to allow a higher limit, it is an
    * internal check on pngvalid to ensure that the calculated error limits are
    * not ridiculous; without this it is too easy to make a mistake in pngvalid
    * that allows any value through.
    */
   double                   limit;    /* limit on error values, normally 4E-3 */

1780 1781 1782 1783 1784 1785
   /* Log limits - values above this are logged, but not necessarily
    * warned.
    */
   double                   log8;     /* Absolute error in 8 bits to log */
   double                   log16;    /* Absolute error in 16 bits to log */

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1786 1787 1788 1789 1790 1791 1792
   /* Logged 8 and 16 bit errors ('output' values): */
   double                   error_gray_2;
   double                   error_gray_4;
   double                   error_gray_8;
   double                   error_gray_16;
   double                   error_color_8;
   double                   error_color_16;
1793
   double                   error_indexed;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1794 1795

   /* Flags: */
1796 1797 1798 1799 1800
   /* Whether to call png_read_update_info, not png_read_start_image, and how
    * many times to call it.
    */
   int                      use_update_info;

1801 1802 1803
   /* Whether or not to interlace. */
   int                      interlace_type :9; /* int, but must store '1' */

1804 1805 1806
   /* Run the standard tests? */
   unsigned int             test_standard :1;

1807 1808 1809
   /* Run the odd-sized image and interlace read/write tests? */
   unsigned int             test_size :1;

1810 1811 1812
   /* Run tests on reading with a combiniation of transforms, */
   unsigned int             test_transform :1;

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1813
   /* When to use the use_input_precision option: */
1814 1815 1816
   unsigned int             use_input_precision :1;
   unsigned int             use_input_precision_sbit :1;
   unsigned int             use_input_precision_16to8 :1;
1817

1818 1819 1820 1821 1822 1823 1824 1825 1826
   /* If set assume that the calculation bit depth is set by the input
    * precision, not the output precision.
    */
   unsigned int             calculations_use_input_precision :1;

   /* If set assume that the calculations are done in 16 bits even if both input
    * and output are 8 bit or less.
    */
   unsigned int             assume_16_bit_calculations :1;
1827

1828
   /* Which gamma tests to run: */
1829 1830 1831
   unsigned int             test_gamma_threshold :1;
   unsigned int             test_gamma_transform :1; /* main tests */
   unsigned int             test_gamma_sbit :1;
1832
   unsigned int             test_gamma_scale16 :1;
1833 1834 1835
   unsigned int             test_gamma_background :1;
   unsigned int             test_gamma_alpha_mode :1;
   unsigned int             test_gamma_expand16 :1;
1836
   unsigned int             test_exhaustive :1;
1837

1838
   unsigned int             log :1;   /* Log max error */
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1839 1840 1841 1842 1843 1844 1845 1846 1847 1848 1849 1850 1851 1852 1853 1854

   /* Buffer information, the buffer size limits the size of the chunks that can
    * be modified - they must fit (including header and CRC) into the buffer!
    */
   size_t                   flush;           /* Count of bytes to flush */
   size_t                   buffer_count;    /* Bytes in buffer */
   size_t                   buffer_position; /* Position in buffer */
   png_byte                 buffer[1024];
} png_modifier;

/* This returns true if the test should be stopped now because it has already
 * failed and it is running silently.
 */
static int fail(png_modifier *pm)
{
   return !pm->log && !pm->this.verbose && (pm->this.nerrors > 0 ||
1855
       (pm->this.treat_warnings_as_errors && pm->this.nwarnings > 0));
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1856 1857 1858 1859 1860 1861
}

static void
modifier_init(png_modifier *pm)
{
   memset(pm, 0, sizeof *pm);
1862
   store_init(&pm->this);
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1863 1864
   pm->modifications = NULL;
   pm->state = modifier_start;
1865
   pm->sbitlow = 1U;
1866
   pm->ngammas = 0;
1867
   pm->ngamma_tests = 0;
1868
   pm->gammas = 0;
1869 1870 1871 1872 1873 1874 1875 1876
   pm->current_gamma = 0;
   pm->encodings = 0;
   pm->nencodings = 0;
   pm->current_encoding = 0;
   pm->encoding_counter = 0;
   pm->encoding_ignored = 0;
   pm->repeat = 0;
   pm->test_uses_encoding = 0;
1877 1878
   pm->maxout8 = pm->maxpc8 = pm->maxabs8 = pm->maxcalc8 = 0;
   pm->maxout16 = pm->maxpc16 = pm->maxabs16 = pm->maxcalc16 = 0;
1879
   pm->limit = 4E-3;
1880
   pm->log8 = pm->log16 = 0; /* Means 'off' */
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1881 1882
   pm->error_gray_2 = pm->error_gray_4 = pm->error_gray_8 = 0;
   pm->error_gray_16 = pm->error_color_8 = pm->error_color_16 = 0;
1883
   pm->error_indexed = 0;
1884
   pm->use_update_info = 0;
1885
   pm->interlace_type = PNG_INTERLACE_NONE;
1886
   pm->test_standard = 0;
1887
   pm->test_size = 0;
1888
   pm->test_transform = 0;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1889 1890 1891
   pm->use_input_precision = 0;
   pm->use_input_precision_sbit = 0;
   pm->use_input_precision_16to8 = 0;
1892
   pm->calculations_use_input_precision = 0;
1893 1894 1895
   pm->test_gamma_threshold = 0;
   pm->test_gamma_transform = 0;
   pm->test_gamma_sbit = 0;
1896
   pm->test_gamma_scale16 = 0;
1897 1898 1899
   pm->test_gamma_background = 0;
   pm->test_gamma_alpha_mode = 0;
   pm->test_gamma_expand16 = 0;
1900
   pm->test_exhaustive = 0;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
1901 1902 1903 1904 1905
   pm->log = 0;

   /* Rely on the memset for all the other fields - there are no pointers */
}

1906
#ifdef PNG_READ_TRANSFORMS_SUPPORTED
1907 1908 1909 1910 1911
/* If pm->calculations_use_input_precision is set then operations will happen
 * with only 8 bit precision unless both the input and output bit depth are 16.
 *
 * If pm->assume_16_bit_calculations is set then even 8 bit calculations use 16
 * bit precision.  This only affects those of the following limits that pertain
1912 1913
 * to a calculation - not a digitization operation - unless the following API is
 * called directly.
1914
 */
1915 1916 1917 1918 1919 1920 1921 1922 1923 1924 1925 1926 1927 1928 1929 1930 1931 1932 1933 1934 1935 1936 1937 1938 1939 1940
static double digitize(PNG_CONST png_modifier *pm, double value,
   int sample_depth, int do_round)
{
   /* 'value' is in the range 0 to 1, the result is the same value rounded to a
    * multiple of the digitization factor - 8 or 16 bits depending on both the
    * sample depth and the 'assume' setting.  Digitization is normally by
    * rounding and 'do_round' should be 1, if it is 0 the digitized value will
    * be truncated.
    */
   PNG_CONST unsigned int digitization_factor =
      (pm->assume_16_bit_calculations || sample_depth == 16) ? 65535 : 255;

   /* Limiting the range is done as a convenience to the caller - it's easier to
    * do it once here than every time at the call site.
    */
   if (value <= 0)
      value = 0;
   else if (value >= 1)
      value = 1;

   value *= digitization_factor;
   if (do_round) value += .5;
   return floor(value)/digitization_factor;
}

static double abserr(PNG_CONST png_modifier *pm, int in_depth, int out_depth)
1941
{
1942 1943 1944 1945 1946 1947 1948 1949
   /* Absolute error permitted in linear values - affected by the bit depth of
    * the calculations.
    */
   if (pm->assume_16_bit_calculations || (out_depth == 16 && (in_depth == 16 ||
      !pm->calculations_use_input_precision)))
      return pm->maxabs16;
   else
      return pm->maxabs8;
1950 1951
}

1952
static double calcerr(PNG_CONST png_modifier *pm, int in_depth, int out_depth)
1953
{
1954 1955
   /* Error in the linear composition arithmetic - only relevant when
    * composition actually happens (0 < alpha < 1).
1956
    */
1957 1958 1959
   if (pm->assume_16_bit_calculations || (out_depth == 16 && (in_depth == 16 ||
      !pm->calculations_use_input_precision)))
      return pm->maxcalc16;
1960
   else
1961
      return pm->maxcalc8;
1962 1963
}

1964
static double pcerr(PNG_CONST png_modifier *pm, int in_depth, int out_depth)
1965
{
1966 1967 1968 1969 1970 1971 1972 1973
   /* Percentage error permitted in the linear values.  Note that the specified
    * value is a percentage but this routine returns a simple number.
    */
   if (pm->assume_16_bit_calculations || (out_depth == 16 && (in_depth == 16 ||
      !pm->calculations_use_input_precision)))
      return pm->maxpc16 * .01;
   else
      return pm->maxpc8 * .01;
1974 1975
}

1976 1977 1978 1979 1980 1981 1982 1983 1984 1985 1986
/* Output error - the error in the encoded value.  This is determined by the
 * digitization of the output so can be +/-0.5 in the actual output value.  In
 * the expand_16 case with the current code in libpng the expand happens after
 * all the calculations are done in 8 bit arithmetic, so even though the output
 * depth is 16 the output error is determined by the 8 bit calculation.
 *
 * This limit is not determined by the bit depth of internal calculations.
 *
 * The specified parameter does *not* include the base .5 digitization error but
 * it is added here.
 */
1987
static double outerr(PNG_CONST png_modifier *pm, int in_depth, int out_depth)
1988 1989 1990
{
   /* There is a serious error in the 2 and 4 bit grayscale transform because
    * the gamma table value (8 bits) is simply shifted, not rounded, so the
1991
    * error in 4 bit grayscale gamma is up to the value below.  This is a hack
1992
    * to allow pngvalid to succeed:
1993 1994
    *
    * TODO: fix this in libpng
1995
    */
1996
   if (out_depth == 2)
1997 1998
      return .73182-.5;

1999
   if (out_depth == 4)
2000 2001
      return .90644-.5;

2002 2003 2004
   if (out_depth == 16 && (in_depth == 16 ||
      !pm->calculations_use_input_precision))
      return pm->maxout16;
2005

2006 2007 2008 2009 2010 2011 2012 2013 2014 2015
   /* This is the case where the value was calculated at 8-bit precision then
    * scaled to 16 bits.
    */
   else if (out_depth == 16)
      return pm->maxout8 * 257;

   else
      return pm->maxout8;
}

2016 2017 2018 2019
/* This does the same thing as the above however it returns the value to log,
 * rather than raising a warning.  This is useful for debugging to track down
 * exactly what set of parameters cause high error values.
 */
2020
static double outlog(PNG_CONST png_modifier *pm, int in_depth, int out_depth)
2021 2022 2023 2024 2025 2026 2027 2028 2029 2030 2031 2032 2033 2034 2035 2036 2037 2038 2039 2040 2041 2042 2043 2044 2045 2046 2047 2048 2049 2050 2051 2052 2053
{
   /* The command line parameters are either 8 bit (0..255) or 16 bit (0..65535)
    * and so must be adjusted for low bit depth grayscale:
    */
   if (out_depth <= 8)
   {
      if (pm->log8 == 0) /* switched off */
         return 256;

      if (out_depth < 8)
         return pm->log8 / 255 * ((1<<out_depth)-1);

      return pm->log8;
   }

   if (out_depth == 16 && (in_depth == 16 ||
      !pm->calculations_use_input_precision))
   {
      if (pm->log16 == 0)
         return 65536;

      return pm->log16;
   }

   /* This is the case where the value was calculated at 8-bit precision then
    * scaled to 16 bits.
    */
   if (pm->log8 == 0)
      return 65536;

   return pm->log8 * 257;
}

2054 2055 2056 2057 2058
/* This complements the above by providing the appropriate quantization for the
 * final value.  Normally this would just be quantization to an integral value,
 * but in the 8 bit calculation case it's actually quantization to a multiple of
 * 257!
 */
2059
static int output_quantization_factor(PNG_CONST png_modifier *pm, int in_depth,
2060 2061 2062 2063 2064 2065 2066
   int out_depth)
{
   if (out_depth == 16 && in_depth != 16
      && pm->calculations_use_input_precision)
      return 257;
   else
      return 1;
2067 2068
}

2069
/* One modification structure must be provided for each chunk to be modified (in
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
2070 2071 2072 2073 2074 2075 2076 2077 2078 2079 2080 2081
 * fact more than one can be provided if multiple separate changes are desired
 * for a single chunk.)  Modifications include adding a new chunk when a
 * suitable chunk does not exist.
 *
 * The caller of modify_fn will reset the CRC of the chunk and record 'modified'
 * or 'added' as appropriate if the modify_fn returns 1 (true).  If the
 * modify_fn is NULL the chunk is simply removed.
 */
typedef struct png_modification
{
   struct png_modification *next;
   png_uint_32              chunk;
2082

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
2083
   /* If the following is NULL all matching chunks will be removed: */
2084
   int                    (*modify_fn)(struct png_modifier *pm,
2085 2086
                               struct png_modification *me, int add);

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
2087 2088 2089 2090 2091
   /* If the following is set to PLTE, IDAT or IEND and the chunk has not been
    * found and modified (and there is a modify_fn) the modify_fn will be called
    * to add the chunk before the relevant chunk.
    */
   png_uint_32              add;
2092 2093 2094
   unsigned int             modified :1;     /* Chunk was modified */
   unsigned int             added    :1;     /* Chunk was added */
   unsigned int             removed  :1;     /* Chunk was removed */
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
2095 2096
} png_modification;

2097 2098
static void
modification_reset(png_modification *pmm)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
2099 2100 2101 2102 2103 2104 2105 2106 2107 2108 2109 2110 2111 2112 2113 2114 2115 2116 2117 2118 2119
{
   if (pmm != NULL)
   {
      pmm->modified = 0;
      pmm->added = 0;
      pmm->removed = 0;
      modification_reset(pmm->next);
   }
}

static void
modification_init(png_modification *pmm)
{
   memset(pmm, 0, sizeof *pmm);
   pmm->next = NULL;
   pmm->chunk = 0;
   pmm->modify_fn = NULL;
   pmm->add = 0;
   modification_reset(pmm);
}

2120 2121 2122 2123 2124 2125 2126 2127 2128 2129 2130 2131 2132 2133 2134 2135 2136 2137 2138 2139 2140 2141 2142 2143 2144 2145 2146 2147 2148 2149 2150 2151 2152 2153 2154 2155 2156 2157 2158 2159 2160 2161 2162 2163 2164 2165 2166 2167 2168 2169 2170 2171 2172 2173 2174 2175 2176 2177 2178 2179 2180 2181 2182 2183 2184 2185 2186 2187 2188 2189 2190 2191 2192 2193 2194 2195 2196 2197 2198 2199 2200 2201 2202 2203 2204 2205 2206 2207 2208 2209 2210
static void
modifier_current_encoding(PNG_CONST png_modifier *pm, color_encoding *ce)
{
   if (pm->current_encoding != 0)
      *ce = *pm->current_encoding;

   else
      memset(ce, 0, sizeof *ce);

   ce->gamma = pm->current_gamma;
}

static size_t
safecat_current_encoding(char *buffer, size_t bufsize, size_t pos,
   PNG_CONST png_modifier *pm)
{
   pos = safecat_color_encoding(buffer, bufsize, pos, pm->current_encoding,
      pm->current_gamma);

   if (pm->encoding_ignored)
      pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, "[overridden]");

   return pos;
}

/* Iterate through the usefully testable color encodings.  An encoding is one
 * of:
 *
 * 1) Nothing (no color space, no gamma).
 * 2) Just a gamma value from the gamma array (including 1.0)
 * 3) A color space from the encodings array with the corresponding gamma.
 * 4) The same, but with gamma 1.0 (only really useful with 16 bit calculations)
 *
 * The iterator selects these in turn, the randomizer selects one at random,
 * which is used depends on the setting of the 'test_exhaustive' flag.  Notice
 * that this function changes the colour space encoding so it must only be
 * called on completion of the previous test.  This is what 'modifier_reset'
 * does, below.
 *
 * After the function has been called the 'repeat' flag will still be set; the
 * caller of modifier_reset must reset it at the start of each run of the test!
 */
static unsigned int
modifier_total_encodings(PNG_CONST png_modifier *pm)
{
   return 1 +                 /* (1) nothing */
      pm->ngammas +           /* (2) gamma values to test */
      pm->nencodings +        /* (3) total number of encodings */
      /* The following test only works after the first time through the
       * png_modifier code because 'bit_depth' is set when the IHDR is read.
       * modifier_reset, below, preserves the setting until after it has called
       * the iterate function (also below.)
       *
       * For this reason do not rely on this function outside a call to
       * modifier_reset.
       */
      ((pm->bit_depth == 16 || pm->assume_16_bit_calculations) ?
         pm->nencodings : 0); /* (4) encodings with gamma == 1.0 */
}

static void
modifier_encoding_iterate(png_modifier *pm)
{
   if (!pm->repeat && /* Else something needs the current encoding again. */
      pm->test_uses_encoding) /* Some transform is encoding dependent */
   {
      if (pm->test_exhaustive)
      {
         if (++pm->encoding_counter >= modifier_total_encodings(pm))
            pm->encoding_counter = 0; /* This will stop the repeat */
      }

      else
      {
         /* Not exhaustive - choose an encoding at random; generate a number in
          * the range 1..(max-1), so the result is always non-zero:
          */
         if (pm->encoding_counter == 0)
            pm->encoding_counter = random_mod(modifier_total_encodings(pm)-1)+1;
         else
            pm->encoding_counter = 0;
      }

      if (pm->encoding_counter > 0)
         pm->repeat = 1;
   }

   else if (!pm->repeat)
      pm->encoding_counter = 0;
}

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
2211 2212 2213
static void
modifier_reset(png_modifier *pm)
{
2214
   store_read_reset(&pm->this);
2215 2216 2217
   pm->limit = 4E-3;
   pm->pending_len = pm->pending_chunk = 0;
   pm->flush = pm->buffer_count = pm->buffer_position = 0;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
2218 2219
   pm->modifications = NULL;
   pm->state = modifier_start;
2220 2221 2222 2223 2224 2225 2226 2227 2228 2229
   modifier_encoding_iterate(pm);
   /* The following must be set in the next run.  In particular
    * test_uses_encodings must be set in the _ini function of each transform
    * that looks at the encodings.  (Not the 'add' function!)
    */
   pm->test_uses_encoding = 0;
   pm->current_gamma = 0;
   pm->current_encoding = 0;
   pm->encoding_ignored = 0;
   /* These only become value after IHDR is read: */
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
2230
   pm->bit_depth = pm->colour_type = 0;
2231 2232 2233 2234 2235 2236 2237 2238 2239 2240 2241 2242 2243 2244 2245 2246 2247 2248 2249 2250 2251 2252 2253 2254 2255 2256 2257 2258 2259 2260 2261 2262 2263 2264 2265 2266 2267 2268 2269 2270 2271 2272 2273 2274 2275 2276 2277 2278 2279 2280 2281 2282 2283 2284 2285 2286 2287 2288
}

/* The following must be called before anything else to get the encoding set up
 * on the modifier.  In particular it must be called before the transform init
 * functions are called.
 */
static void
modifier_set_encoding(png_modifier *pm)
{
   /* Set the encoding to the one specified by the current encoding counter,
    * first clear out all the settings - this corresponds to an encoding_counter
    * of 0.
    */
   pm->current_gamma = 0;
   pm->current_encoding = 0;
   pm->encoding_ignored = 0; /* not ignored yet - happens in _ini functions. */

   /* Now, if required, set the gamma and encoding fields. */
   if (pm->encoding_counter > 0)
   {
      /* The gammas[] array is an array of screen gammas, not encoding gammas,
       * so we need the inverse:
       */
      if (pm->encoding_counter <= pm->ngammas)
         pm->current_gamma = 1/pm->gammas[pm->encoding_counter-1];

      else
      {
         unsigned int i = pm->encoding_counter - pm->ngammas;

         if (i >= pm->nencodings)
         {
            i %= pm->nencodings;
            pm->current_gamma = 1; /* Linear, only in the 16 bit case */
         }

         else
            pm->current_gamma = pm->encodings[i].gamma;

         pm->current_encoding = pm->encodings + i;
      }
   }
}

/* Enquiry functions to find out what is set.  Notice that there is an implicit
 * assumption below that the first encoding in the list is the one for sRGB.
 */
static int
modifier_color_encoding_is_sRGB(PNG_CONST png_modifier *pm)
{
   return pm->current_encoding != 0 && pm->current_encoding == pm->encodings &&
      pm->current_encoding->gamma == pm->current_gamma;
}

static int
modifier_color_encoding_is_set(PNG_CONST png_modifier *pm)
{
   return pm->current_gamma != 0;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
2289 2290 2291 2292 2293 2294 2295 2296 2297 2298 2299 2300 2301 2302 2303 2304 2305 2306 2307 2308 2309
}

/* Convenience macros. */
#define CHUNK(a,b,c,d) (((a)<<24)+((b)<<16)+((c)<<8)+(d))
#define CHUNK_IHDR CHUNK(73,72,68,82)
#define CHUNK_PLTE CHUNK(80,76,84,69)
#define CHUNK_IDAT CHUNK(73,68,65,84)
#define CHUNK_IEND CHUNK(73,69,78,68)
#define CHUNK_cHRM CHUNK(99,72,82,77)
#define CHUNK_gAMA CHUNK(103,65,77,65)
#define CHUNK_sBIT CHUNK(115,66,73,84)
#define CHUNK_sRGB CHUNK(115,82,71,66)

/* The guts of modification are performed during a read. */
static void
modifier_crc(png_bytep buffer)
{
   /* Recalculate the chunk CRC - a complete chunk must be in
    * the buffer, at the start.
    */
   uInt datalen = png_get_uint_32(buffer);
2310
   uLong crc = crc32(0, buffer+4, datalen+4);
2311 2312 2313
   /* The cast to png_uint_32 is safe because a crc32 is always a 32 bit value.
    */
   png_save_uint_32(buffer+datalen+8, (png_uint_32)crc);
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
2314 2315 2316 2317 2318 2319 2320 2321 2322 2323
}

static void
modifier_setbuffer(png_modifier *pm)
{
   modifier_crc(pm->buffer);
   pm->buffer_count = png_get_uint_32(pm->buffer)+12;
   pm->buffer_position = 0;
}

2324 2325 2326 2327
/* Separate the callback into the actual implementation (which is passed the
 * png_modifier explicitly) and the callback, which gets the modifier from the
 * png_struct.
 */
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
2328
static void
2329
modifier_read_imp(png_modifier *pm, png_bytep pb, png_size_t st)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
2330 2331 2332 2333 2334 2335 2336 2337 2338
{
   while (st > 0)
   {
      size_t cb;
      png_uint_32 len, chunk;
      png_modification *mod;

      if (pm->buffer_position >= pm->buffer_count) switch (pm->state)
      {
2339 2340
         static png_byte sign[8] = { 137, 80, 78, 71, 13, 10, 26, 10 };
         case modifier_start:
2341
            store_read_imp(&pm->this, pm->buffer, 8); /* size of signature. */
2342 2343
            pm->buffer_count = 8;
            pm->buffer_position = 0;
2344

2345
            if (memcmp(pm->buffer, sign, 8) != 0)
2346
               png_error(pm->this.pread, "invalid PNG file signature");
2347 2348
            pm->state = modifier_signature;
            break;
2349

2350
         case modifier_signature:
2351
            store_read_imp(&pm->this, pm->buffer, 13+12); /* size of IHDR */
2352 2353
            pm->buffer_count = 13+12;
            pm->buffer_position = 0;
2354

2355 2356
            if (png_get_uint_32(pm->buffer) != 13 ||
                png_get_uint_32(pm->buffer+4) != CHUNK_IHDR)
2357
               png_error(pm->this.pread, "invalid IHDR");
2358

2359
            /* Check the list of modifiers for modifications to the IHDR. */
2360 2361 2362
            mod = pm->modifications;
            while (mod != NULL)
            {
2363
               if (mod->chunk == CHUNK_IHDR && mod->modify_fn &&
2364
                   (*mod->modify_fn)(pm, mod, 0))
2365
                  {
2366 2367
                  mod->modified = 1;
                  modifier_setbuffer(pm);
2368
                  }
2369

2370
               /* Ignore removal or add if IHDR! */
2371 2372
               mod = mod->next;
            }
2373

2374 2375 2376
            /* Cache information from the IHDR (the modified one.) */
            pm->bit_depth = pm->buffer[8+8];
            pm->colour_type = pm->buffer[8+8+1];
2377

2378 2379 2380
            pm->state = modifier_IHDR;
            pm->flush = 0;
            break;
2381

2382 2383 2384 2385 2386
         case modifier_IHDR:
         default:
            /* Read a new chunk and process it until we see PLTE, IDAT or
             * IEND.  'flush' indicates that there is still some data to
             * output from the preceding chunk.
2387
             */
2388 2389 2390 2391
            if ((cb = pm->flush) > 0)
            {
               if (cb > st) cb = st;
               pm->flush -= cb;
2392
               store_read_imp(&pm->this, pb, cb);
2393 2394
               pb += cb;
               st -= cb;
2395
               if (st == 0) return;
2396
            }
2397

2398 2399 2400 2401
            /* No more bytes to flush, read a header, or handle a pending
             * chunk.
             */
            if (pm->pending_chunk != 0)
2402
            {
2403 2404 2405 2406 2407 2408
               png_save_uint_32(pm->buffer, pm->pending_len);
               png_save_uint_32(pm->buffer+4, pm->pending_chunk);
               pm->pending_len = 0;
               pm->pending_chunk = 0;
            }
            else
2409
               store_read_imp(&pm->this, pm->buffer, 8);
2410

2411 2412
            pm->buffer_count = 8;
            pm->buffer_position = 0;
2413

2414 2415 2416
            /* Check for something to modify or a terminator chunk. */
            len = png_get_uint_32(pm->buffer);
            chunk = png_get_uint_32(pm->buffer+4);
2417

2418 2419 2420 2421 2422 2423 2424
            /* Terminators first, they may have to be delayed for added
             * chunks
             */
            if (chunk == CHUNK_PLTE || chunk == CHUNK_IDAT ||
                chunk == CHUNK_IEND)
            {
               mod = pm->modifications;
2425

2426
               while (mod != NULL)
2427
               {
2428 2429 2430
                  if ((mod->add == chunk ||
                      (mod->add == CHUNK_PLTE && chunk == CHUNK_IDAT)) &&
                      mod->modify_fn != NULL && !mod->modified && !mod->added)
2431
                  {
2432 2433 2434 2435
                     /* Regardless of what the modify function does do not run
                      * this again.
                      */
                     mod->added = 1;
2436

2437
                     if ((*mod->modify_fn)(pm, mod, 1 /*add*/))
2438 2439 2440 2441 2442 2443 2444 2445 2446 2447
                     {
                        /* Reset the CRC on a new chunk */
                        if (pm->buffer_count > 0)
                           modifier_setbuffer(pm);

                        else
                           {
                           pm->buffer_position = 0;
                           mod->removed = 1;
                           }
2448

2449 2450 2451 2452 2453 2454 2455
                        /* The buffer has been filled with something (we assume)
                         * so output this.  Pend the current chunk.
                         */
                        pm->pending_len = len;
                        pm->pending_chunk = chunk;
                        break; /* out of while */
                     }
2456
                  }
2457

2458 2459
                  mod = mod->next;
               }
2460

2461
               /* Don't do any further processing if the buffer was modified -
2462 2463
                * otherwise the code will end up modifying a chunk that was
                * just added.
2464 2465 2466 2467
                */
               if (mod != NULL)
                  break; /* out of switch */
            }
2468

2469 2470
            /* If we get to here then this chunk may need to be modified.  To
             * do this it must be less than 1024 bytes in total size, otherwise
2471 2472 2473 2474
             * it just gets flushed.
             */
            if (len+12 <= sizeof pm->buffer)
            {
2475
               store_read_imp(&pm->this, pm->buffer+pm->buffer_count,
2476 2477
                   len+12-pm->buffer_count);
               pm->buffer_count = len+12;
2478

2479 2480 2481 2482 2483
               /* Check for a modification, else leave it be. */
               mod = pm->modifications;
               while (mod != NULL)
               {
                  if (mod->chunk == chunk)
2484
                  {
2485 2486 2487 2488 2489 2490 2491 2492
                     if (mod->modify_fn == NULL)
                     {
                        /* Remove this chunk */
                        pm->buffer_count = pm->buffer_position = 0;
                        mod->removed = 1;
                        break; /* Terminate the while loop */
                     }

2493
                     else if ((*mod->modify_fn)(pm, mod, 0))
2494
                     {
2495 2496 2497 2498 2499 2500 2501 2502
                        mod->modified = 1;
                        /* The chunk may have been removed: */
                        if (pm->buffer_count == 0)
                        {
                           pm->buffer_position = 0;
                           break;
                        }
                        modifier_setbuffer(pm);
2503 2504
                     }
                  }
2505

2506
                  mod = mod->next;
2507 2508 2509
               }
            }

2510 2511
            else
               pm->flush = len+12 - pm->buffer_count; /* data + crc */
2512

2513 2514
            /* Take the data from the buffer (if there is any). */
            break;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
2515 2516 2517
      }

      /* Here to read from the modifier buffer (not directly from
2518
       * the store, as in the flush case above.)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
2519 2520
       */
      cb = pm->buffer_count - pm->buffer_position;
2521 2522 2523 2524

      if (cb > st)
         cb = st;

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
2525 2526 2527 2528 2529 2530 2531
      memcpy(pb, pm->buffer + pm->buffer_position, cb);
      st -= cb;
      pb += cb;
      pm->buffer_position += cb;
   }
}

2532 2533 2534 2535
/* The callback: */
static void
modifier_read(png_structp pp, png_bytep pb, png_size_t st)
{
2536
   png_modifier *pm = voidcast(png_modifier*, png_get_io_ptr(pp));
2537 2538 2539 2540 2541 2542 2543 2544 2545 2546 2547 2548 2549 2550 2551 2552 2553 2554

   if (pm == NULL || pm->this.pread != pp)
      png_error(pp, "bad modifier_read call");

   modifier_read_imp(pm, pb, st);
}

/* Like store_progressive_read but the data is getting changed as we go so we
 * need a local buffer.
 */
static void
modifier_progressive_read(png_modifier *pm, png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
{
   if (pm->this.pread != pp || pm->this.current == NULL ||
       pm->this.next == NULL)
      png_error(pp, "store state damaged (progressive)");

   /* This is another Horowitz and Hill random noise generator.  In this case
2555
    * the aim is to stress the progressive reader with truly horrible variable
2556 2557 2558
    * buffer sizes in the range 1..500, so a sequence of 9 bit random numbers
    * is generated.  We could probably just count from 1 to 32767 and get as
    * good a result.
2559 2560 2561 2562 2563 2564 2565 2566 2567 2568 2569 2570 2571 2572 2573 2574 2575 2576 2577 2578 2579 2580 2581 2582 2583 2584 2585 2586 2587 2588 2589 2590 2591 2592 2593 2594 2595 2596 2597 2598 2599 2600
    */
   for (;;)
   {
      static png_uint_32 noise = 1;
      png_size_t cb, cbAvail;
      png_byte buffer[512];

      /* Generate 15 more bits of stuff: */
      noise = (noise << 9) | ((noise ^ (noise >> (9-5))) & 0x1ff);
      cb = noise & 0x1ff;

      /* Check that this number of bytes are available (in the current buffer.)
       * (This doesn't quite work - the modifier might delete a chunk; unlikely
       * but possible, it doesn't happen at present because the modifier only
       * adds chunks to standard images.)
       */
      cbAvail = store_read_buffer_avail(&pm->this);
      if (pm->buffer_count > pm->buffer_position)
         cbAvail += pm->buffer_count - pm->buffer_position;

      if (cb > cbAvail)
      {
         /* Check for EOF: */
         if (cbAvail == 0)
            break;

         cb = cbAvail;
      }

      modifier_read_imp(pm, buffer, cb);
      png_process_data(pp, pi, buffer, cb);
   }

   /* Check the invariants at the end (if this fails it's a problem in this
    * file!)
    */
   if (pm->buffer_count > pm->buffer_position ||
       pm->this.next != &pm->this.current->data ||
       pm->this.readpos < pm->this.current->datacount)
      png_error(pp, "progressive read implementation error");
}

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
2601 2602 2603
/* Set up a modifier. */
static png_structp
set_modifier_for_read(png_modifier *pm, png_infopp ppi, png_uint_32 id,
2604
    PNG_CONST char *name)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
2605
{
2606 2607 2608 2609 2610 2611 2612
   /* Do this first so that the modifier fields are cleared even if an error
    * happens allocating the png_struct.  No allocation is done here so no
    * cleanup is required.
    */
   pm->state = modifier_start;
   pm->bit_depth = 0;
   pm->colour_type = 255;
2613

2614 2615 2616 2617 2618
   pm->pending_len = 0;
   pm->pending_chunk = 0;
   pm->flush = 0;
   pm->buffer_count = 0;
   pm->buffer_position = 0;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
2619

2620
   return set_store_for_read(&pm->this, ppi, id, name);
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
2621
}
2622 2623 2624 2625 2626 2627 2628 2629 2630 2631 2632 2633 2634 2635 2636 2637 2638 2639 2640 2641 2642 2643 2644 2645 2646 2647 2648 2649 2650 2651 2652 2653 2654 2655 2656 2657 2658 2659 2660 2661 2662 2663 2664 2665 2666 2667 2668 2669 2670 2671 2672 2673 2674 2675 2676 2677 2678 2679 2680 2681 2682 2683 2684 2685 2686 2687 2688 2689 2690 2691 2692 2693 2694 2695 2696 2697 2698 2699 2700 2701 2702 2703 2704 2705 2706 2707 2708 2709 2710 2711 2712 2713 2714 2715 2716 2717 2718 2719 2720 2721 2722 2723 2724 2725 2726 2727 2728 2729 2730 2731 2732 2733 2734 2735 2736 2737 2738 2739 2740 2741 2742 2743 2744 2745 2746 2747 2748 2749 2750 2751 2752 2753 2754 2755 2756 2757 2758 2759 2760 2761 2762 2763 2764 2765 2766 2767 2768 2769 2770 2771 2772 2773 2774 2775 2776 2777 2778 2779 2780 2781 2782 2783 2784 2785 2786 2787 2788 2789 2790 2791 2792 2793 2794 2795 2796 2797 2798 2799 2800 2801 2802 2803 2804 2805 2806 2807 2808 2809 2810 2811 2812 2813 2814 2815 2816 2817 2818 2819 2820


/******************************** MODIFICATIONS *******************************/
/* Standard modifications to add chunks.  These do not require the _SUPPORTED
 * macros because the chunks can be there regardless of whether this specific
 * libpng supports them.
 */
typedef struct gama_modification
{
   png_modification this;
   png_fixed_point  gamma;
} gama_modification;

static int
gama_modify(png_modifier *pm, png_modification *me, int add)
{
   UNUSED(add)
   /* This simply dumps the given gamma value into the buffer. */
   png_save_uint_32(pm->buffer, 4);
   png_save_uint_32(pm->buffer+4, CHUNK_gAMA);
   png_save_uint_32(pm->buffer+8, ((gama_modification*)me)->gamma);
   return 1;
}

static void
gama_modification_init(gama_modification *me, png_modifier *pm, double gammad)
{
   double g;

   modification_init(&me->this);
   me->this.chunk = CHUNK_gAMA;
   me->this.modify_fn = gama_modify;
   me->this.add = CHUNK_PLTE;
   g = fix(gammad);
   me->gamma = (png_fixed_point)g;
   me->this.next = pm->modifications;
   pm->modifications = &me->this;
}

typedef struct chrm_modification
{
   png_modification          this;
   PNG_CONST color_encoding *encoding;
   png_fixed_point           wx, wy, rx, ry, gx, gy, bx, by;
} chrm_modification;

static int
chrm_modify(png_modifier *pm, png_modification *me, int add)
{
   UNUSED(add)
   /* As with gAMA this just adds the required cHRM chunk to the buffer. */
   png_save_uint_32(pm->buffer   , 32);
   png_save_uint_32(pm->buffer+ 4, CHUNK_cHRM);
   png_save_uint_32(pm->buffer+ 8, ((chrm_modification*)me)->wx);
   png_save_uint_32(pm->buffer+12, ((chrm_modification*)me)->wy);
   png_save_uint_32(pm->buffer+16, ((chrm_modification*)me)->rx);
   png_save_uint_32(pm->buffer+20, ((chrm_modification*)me)->ry);
   png_save_uint_32(pm->buffer+24, ((chrm_modification*)me)->gx);
   png_save_uint_32(pm->buffer+28, ((chrm_modification*)me)->gy);
   png_save_uint_32(pm->buffer+32, ((chrm_modification*)me)->bx);
   png_save_uint_32(pm->buffer+36, ((chrm_modification*)me)->by);
   return 1;
}

static void
chrm_modification_init(chrm_modification *me, png_modifier *pm,
   PNG_CONST color_encoding *encoding)
{
   CIE_color white = white_point(encoding);

   /* Original end points: */
   me->encoding = encoding;

   /* Chromaticities (in fixed point): */
   me->wx = fix(chromaticity_x(white));
   me->wy = fix(chromaticity_y(white));

   me->rx = fix(chromaticity_x(encoding->red));
   me->ry = fix(chromaticity_y(encoding->red));
   me->gx = fix(chromaticity_x(encoding->green));
   me->gy = fix(chromaticity_y(encoding->green));
   me->bx = fix(chromaticity_x(encoding->blue));
   me->by = fix(chromaticity_y(encoding->blue));

   modification_init(&me->this);
   me->this.chunk = CHUNK_cHRM;
   me->this.modify_fn = chrm_modify;
   me->this.add = CHUNK_PLTE;
   me->this.next = pm->modifications;
   pm->modifications = &me->this;
}

typedef struct srgb_modification
{
   png_modification this;
   png_byte         intent;
} srgb_modification;

static int
srgb_modify(png_modifier *pm, png_modification *me, int add)
{
   UNUSED(add)
   /* As above, ignore add and just make a new chunk */
   png_save_uint_32(pm->buffer, 1);
   png_save_uint_32(pm->buffer+4, CHUNK_sRGB);
   pm->buffer[8] = ((srgb_modification*)me)->intent;
   return 1;
}

static void
srgb_modification_init(srgb_modification *me, png_modifier *pm, png_byte intent)
{
   modification_init(&me->this);
   me->this.chunk = CHUNK_sBIT;

   if (intent <= 3) /* if valid, else *delete* sRGB chunks */
   {
      me->this.modify_fn = srgb_modify;
      me->this.add = CHUNK_PLTE;
      me->intent = intent;
   }

   else
   {
      me->this.modify_fn = 0;
      me->this.add = 0;
      me->intent = 0;
   }

   me->this.next = pm->modifications;
   pm->modifications = &me->this;
}

typedef struct sbit_modification
{
   png_modification this;
   png_byte         sbit;
} sbit_modification;

static int
sbit_modify(png_modifier *pm, png_modification *me, int add)
{
   png_byte sbit = ((sbit_modification*)me)->sbit;
   if (pm->bit_depth > sbit)
   {
      int cb = 0;
      switch (pm->colour_type)
      {
         case 0:
            cb = 1;
            break;

         case 2:
         case 3:
            cb = 3;
            break;

         case 4:
            cb = 2;
            break;

         case 6:
            cb = 4;
            break;

         default:
            png_error(pm->this.pread,
               "unexpected colour type in sBIT modification");
      }

      png_save_uint_32(pm->buffer, cb);
      png_save_uint_32(pm->buffer+4, CHUNK_sBIT);

      while (cb > 0)
         (pm->buffer+8)[--cb] = sbit;

      return 1;
   }
   else if (!add)
   {
      /* Remove the sBIT chunk */
      pm->buffer_count = pm->buffer_position = 0;
      return 1;
   }
   else
      return 0; /* do nothing */
}

static void
sbit_modification_init(sbit_modification *me, png_modifier *pm, png_byte sbit)
{
   modification_init(&me->this);
   me->this.chunk = CHUNK_sBIT;
   me->this.modify_fn = sbit_modify;
   me->this.add = CHUNK_PLTE;
   me->sbit = sbit;
   me->this.next = pm->modifications;
   pm->modifications = &me->this;
}
2821
#endif /* PNG_READ_TRANSFORMS_SUPPORTED */
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
2822 2823 2824

/***************************** STANDARD PNG FILES *****************************/
/* Standard files - write and save standard files. */
2825 2826 2827 2828 2829 2830 2831 2832 2833 2834 2835 2836
/* There are two basic forms of standard images.  Those which attempt to have
 * all the possible pixel values (not possible for 16bpp images, but a range of
 * values are produced) and those which have a range of image sizes.  The former
 * are used for testing transforms, in particular gamma correction and bit
 * reduction and increase.  The latter are reserved for testing the behavior of
 * libpng with respect to 'odd' image sizes - particularly small images where
 * rows become 1 byte and interlace passes disappear.
 *
 * The first, most useful, set are the 'transform' images, the second set of
 * small images are the 'size' images.
 *
 * The transform files are constructed with rows which fit into a 1024 byte row
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
2837
 * buffer.  This makes allocation easier below.  Further regardless of the file
2838
 * format every row has 128 pixels (giving 1024 bytes for 64bpp formats).
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
2839 2840
 *
 * Files are stored with no gAMA or sBIT chunks, with a PLTE only when needed
2841
 * and with an ID derived from the colour type, bit depth and interlace type
2842 2843 2844 2845 2846 2847 2848
 * as above (FILEID).  The width (128) and height (variable) are not stored in
 * the FILEID - instead the fields are set to 0, indicating a transform file.
 *
 * The size files ar constructed with rows a maximum of 128 bytes wide, allowing
 * a maximum width of 16 pixels (for the 64bpp case.)  They also have a maximum
 * height of 16 rows.  The width and height are stored in the FILEID and, being
 * non-zero, indicate a size file.
2849 2850 2851 2852 2853 2854 2855 2856 2857 2858 2859 2860 2861 2862
 *
 * For palette image (colour type 3) multiple transform images are stored with
 * the same bit depth to allow testing of more colour combinations -
 * particularly important for testing the gamma code because libpng uses a
 * different code path for palette images.  For size images a single palette is
 * used.
 */

/* Make a 'standard' palette.  Because there are only 256 entries in a palette
 * (maximum) this actually makes a random palette in the hope that enough tests
 * will catch enough errors.  (Note that the same palette isn't produced every
 * time for the same test - it depends on what previous tests have been run -
 * but a given set of arguments to pngvalid will always produce the same palette
 * at the same test!  This is why pseudo-random number generators are useful for
2863
 * testing.)
2864 2865 2866 2867 2868 2869 2870 2871 2872 2873 2874 2875 2876 2877 2878 2879 2880 2881 2882 2883 2884 2885 2886
 *
 * The store must be open for write when this is called, otherwise an internal
 * error will occur.  This routine contains its own magic number seed, so the
 * palettes generated don't change if there are intervening errors (changing the
 * calls to the store_mark seed.)
 */
static store_palette_entry *
make_standard_palette(png_store* ps, int npalette, int do_tRNS)
{
   static png_uint_32 palette_seed[2] = { 0x87654321, 9 };

   int i = 0;
   png_byte values[256][4];

   /* Always put in black and white plus the six primary and secondary colors.
    */
   for (; i<8; ++i)
   {
      values[i][1] = (i&1) ? 255 : 0;
      values[i][2] = (i&2) ? 255 : 0;
      values[i][3] = (i&4) ? 255 : 0;
   }

2887
   /* Then add 62 grays (one quarter of the remaining 256 slots). */
2888 2889 2890 2891 2892 2893 2894 2895 2896 2897 2898 2899 2900 2901 2902 2903 2904 2905 2906 2907 2908 2909 2910 2911 2912 2913 2914 2915 2916 2917
   {
      int j = 0;
      png_byte random_bytes[4];
      png_byte need[256];

      need[0] = 0; /*got black*/
      memset(need+1, 1, (sizeof need)-2); /*need these*/
      need[255] = 0; /*but not white*/

      while (i<70)
      {
         png_byte b;

         if (j==0)
         {
            make_four_random_bytes(palette_seed, random_bytes);
            j = 4;
         }

         b = random_bytes[--j];
         if (need[b])
         {
            values[i][1] = b;
            values[i][2] = b;
            values[i++][3] = b;
         }
      }
   }

   /* Finally add 192 colors at random - don't worry about matches to things we
2918
    * already have, chance is less than 1/65536.  Don't worry about grays,
2919 2920 2921 2922 2923 2924 2925 2926 2927 2928 2929 2930 2931 2932 2933 2934 2935 2936 2937 2938 2939 2940 2941 2942 2943 2944 2945 2946 2947 2948 2949 2950 2951 2952 2953 2954 2955 2956 2957 2958 2959 2960 2961 2962 2963 2964 2965 2966
    * chance is the same, so we get a duplicate or extra gray less than 1 time
    * in 170.
    */
   for (; i<256; ++i)
      make_four_random_bytes(palette_seed, values[i]);

   /* Fill in the alpha values in the first byte.  Just use all possible values
    * (0..255) in an apparently random order:
    */
   {
      store_palette_entry *palette;
      png_byte selector[4];

      make_four_random_bytes(palette_seed, selector);

      if (do_tRNS)
         for (i=0; i<256; ++i)
            values[i][0] = (png_byte)(i ^ selector[0]);

      else
         for (i=0; i<256; ++i)
            values[i][0] = 255; /* no transparency/tRNS chunk */

      /* 'values' contains 256 ARGB values, but we only need 'npalette'.
       * 'npalette' will always be a power of 2: 2, 4, 16 or 256.  In the low
       * bit depth cases select colors at random, else it is difficult to have
       * a set of low bit depth palette test with any chance of a reasonable
       * range of colors.  Do this by randomly permuting values into the low
       * 'npalette' entries using an XOR mask generated here.  This also
       * permutes the npalette == 256 case in a potentially useful way (there is
       * no relationship between palette index and the color value therein!)
       */
      palette = store_write_palette(ps, npalette);

      for (i=0; i<npalette; ++i)
      {
         palette[i].alpha = values[i ^ selector[1]][0];
         palette[i].red   = values[i ^ selector[1]][1];
         palette[i].green = values[i ^ selector[1]][2];
         palette[i].blue  = values[i ^ selector[1]][3];
      }

      return palette;
   }
}

/* Initialize a standard palette on a write stream.  The 'do_tRNS' argument
 * indicates whether or not to also set the tRNS chunk.
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
2967
 */
2968 2969 2970 2971 2972 2973 2974 2975 2976 2977 2978 2979 2980 2981 2982 2983 2984 2985 2986 2987 2988 2989 2990 2991 2992 2993 2994 2995 2996 2997 2998 2999 3000 3001 3002 3003 3004 3005 3006 3007 3008 3009 3010
static void
init_standard_palette(png_store *ps, png_structp pp, png_infop pi, int npalette,
   int do_tRNS)
{
   store_palette_entry *ppal = make_standard_palette(ps, npalette, do_tRNS);

   {
      int i;
      png_color palette[256];

      /* Set all entries to detect overread errors. */
      for (i=0; i<npalette; ++i)
      {
         palette[i].red = ppal[i].red;
         palette[i].green = ppal[i].green;
         palette[i].blue = ppal[i].blue;
      }

      /* Just in case fill in the rest with detectable values: */
      for (; i<256; ++i)
         palette[i].red = palette[i].green = palette[i].blue = 42;

      png_set_PLTE(pp, pi, palette, npalette);
   }

   if (do_tRNS)
   {
      int i, j;
      png_byte tRNS[256];

      /* Set all the entries, but skip trailing opaque entries */
      for (i=j=0; i<npalette; ++i)
         if ((tRNS[i] = ppal[i].alpha) < 255)
            j = i+1;

      /* Fill in the remainder with a detectable value: */
      for (; i<256; ++i)
         tRNS[i] = 24;

      if (j > 0)
         png_set_tRNS(pp, pi, tRNS, j, 0/*color*/);
   }
}
3011

3012
/* The number of passes is related to the interlace type. There was no libpng
3013
 * API to determine this prior to 1.5, so we need an inquiry function:
3014 3015 3016 3017 3018 3019 3020 3021 3022 3023 3024 3025 3026
 */
static int
npasses_from_interlace_type(png_structp pp, int interlace_type)
{
   switch (interlace_type)
   {
   default:
      png_error(pp, "invalid interlace type");

   case PNG_INTERLACE_NONE:
      return 1;

   case PNG_INTERLACE_ADAM7:
3027
      return PNG_INTERLACE_ADAM7_PASSES;
3028 3029
   }
}
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
3030

3031
static unsigned int
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
3032 3033 3034 3035
bit_size(png_structp pp, png_byte colour_type, png_byte bit_depth)
{
   switch (colour_type)
   {
3036 3037
      default: png_error(pp, "invalid color type");

3038 3039 3040 3041 3042 3043 3044 3045 3046
      case 0:  return bit_depth;

      case 2:  return 3*bit_depth;

      case 3:  return bit_depth;

      case 4:  return 2*bit_depth;

      case 6:  return 4*bit_depth;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
3047 3048 3049
   }
}

3050 3051 3052 3053
#define TRANSFORM_WIDTH  128U
#define TRANSFORM_ROWMAX (TRANSFORM_WIDTH*8U)
#define SIZE_ROWMAX (16*8U) /* 16 pixels, max 8 bytes each - 128 bytes */
#define STANDARD_ROWMAX TRANSFORM_ROWMAX /* The larger of the two */
3054
#define SIZE_HEIGHTMAX 16 /* Maximum range of size images */
3055

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
3056
static size_t
3057
transform_rowsize(png_structp pp, png_byte colour_type, png_byte bit_depth)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
3058
{
3059
   return (TRANSFORM_WIDTH * bit_size(pp, colour_type, bit_depth)) / 8;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
3060 3061
}

3062
/* transform_width(pp, colour_type, bit_depth) current returns the same number
3063 3064
 * every time, so just use a macro:
 */
3065
#define transform_width(pp, colour_type, bit_depth) TRANSFORM_WIDTH
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
3066 3067

static png_uint_32
3068
transform_height(png_structp pp, png_byte colour_type, png_byte bit_depth)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
3069 3070 3071
{
   switch (bit_size(pp, colour_type, bit_depth))
   {
3072 3073 3074 3075 3076 3077 3078 3079 3080 3081 3082 3083 3084 3085 3086 3087 3088 3089
      case 1:
      case 2:
      case 4:
         return 1;   /* Total of 128 pixels */

      case 8:
         return 2;   /* Total of 256 pixels/bytes */

      case 16:
         return 512; /* Total of 65536 pixels */

      case 24:
      case 32:
         return 512; /* 65536 pixels */

      case 48:
      case 64:
         return 2048;/* 4 x 65536 pixels. */
3090
#        define TRANSFORM_HEIGHTMAX 2048
3091 3092 3093

      default:
         return 0;   /* Error, will be caught later */
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
3094 3095 3096
   }
}

3097 3098 3099 3100 3101 3102 3103
/* The following can only be defined here, now we have the definitions
 * of the transform image sizes.
 */
static png_uint_32
standard_width(png_structp pp, png_uint_32 id)
{
   png_uint_32 width = WIDTH_FROM_ID(id);
3104
   UNUSED(pp)
3105 3106 3107 3108 3109 3110 3111 3112 3113 3114 3115 3116 3117 3118 3119 3120 3121 3122 3123 3124 3125 3126 3127 3128 3129 3130 3131

   if (width == 0)
      width = transform_width(pp, COL_FROM_ID(id), DEPTH_FROM_ID(id));

   return width;
}

static png_uint_32
standard_height(png_structp pp, png_uint_32 id)
{
   png_uint_32 height = HEIGHT_FROM_ID(id);

   if (height == 0)
      height = transform_height(pp, COL_FROM_ID(id), DEPTH_FROM_ID(id));

   return height;
}

static png_uint_32
standard_rowsize(png_structp pp, png_uint_32 id)
{
   png_uint_32 width = standard_width(pp, id);

   /* This won't overflow: */
   width *= bit_size(pp, COL_FROM_ID(id), DEPTH_FROM_ID(id));
   return (width + 7) / 8;
}
3132

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
3133
static void
3134 3135
transform_row(png_structp pp, png_byte buffer[TRANSFORM_ROWMAX],
   png_byte colour_type, png_byte bit_depth, png_uint_32 y)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
3136 3137 3138 3139 3140 3141
{
   png_uint_32 v = y << 7;
   png_uint_32 i = 0;

   switch (bit_size(pp, colour_type, bit_depth))
   {
3142 3143 3144 3145 3146 3147 3148 3149 3150 3151 3152 3153 3154 3155 3156 3157 3158 3159
      case 1:
         while (i<128/8) buffer[i] = v & 0xff, v += 17, ++i;
         return;

      case 2:
         while (i<128/4) buffer[i] = v & 0xff, v += 33, ++i;
         return;

      case 4:
         while (i<128/2) buffer[i] = v & 0xff, v += 65, ++i;
         return;

      case 8:
         /* 256 bytes total, 128 bytes in each row set as follows: */
         while (i<128) buffer[i] = v & 0xff, ++v, ++i;
         return;

      case 16:
3160 3161
         /* Generate all 65536 pixel values in order, which includes the 8 bit
          * GA case as well as the 16 bit G case.
3162 3163 3164 3165 3166 3167 3168 3169 3170 3171 3172 3173 3174 3175 3176 3177 3178 3179 3180 3181 3182 3183 3184 3185 3186 3187 3188 3189 3190 3191 3192 3193 3194 3195 3196 3197 3198 3199 3200 3201 3202 3203 3204 3205 3206 3207 3208 3209 3210 3211 3212 3213 3214 3215 3216 3217 3218 3219 3220 3221 3222 3223 3224 3225 3226 3227 3228 3229 3230 3231 3232
          */
         while (i<128)
            buffer[2*i] = (v>>8) & 0xff, buffer[2*i+1] = v & 0xff, ++v, ++i;

         return;

      case 24:
         /* 65535 pixels, but rotate the values. */
         while (i<128)
         {
            /* Three bytes per pixel, r, g, b, make b by r^g */
            buffer[3*i+0] = (v >> 8) & 0xff;
            buffer[3*i+1] = v & 0xff;
            buffer[3*i+2] = ((v >> 8) ^ v) & 0xff;
            ++v;
            ++i;
         }

         return;

      case 32:
         /* 65535 pixels, r, g, b, a; just replicate */
         while (i<128)
         {
            buffer[4*i+0] = (v >> 8) & 0xff;
            buffer[4*i+1] = v & 0xff;
            buffer[4*i+2] = (v >> 8) & 0xff;
            buffer[4*i+3] = v & 0xff;
            ++v;
            ++i;
         }

         return;

      case 48:
         /* y is maximum 2047, giving 4x65536 pixels, make 'r' increase by 1 at
          * each pixel, g increase by 257 (0x101) and 'b' by 0x1111:
          */
         while (i<128)
         {
            png_uint_32 t = v++;
            buffer[6*i+0] = (t >> 8) & 0xff;
            buffer[6*i+1] = t & 0xff;
            t *= 257;
            buffer[6*i+2] = (t >> 8) & 0xff;
            buffer[6*i+3] = t & 0xff;
            t *= 17;
            buffer[6*i+4] = (t >> 8) & 0xff;
            buffer[6*i+5] = t & 0xff;
            ++i;
         }

         return;

      case 64:
         /* As above in the 32 bit case. */
         while (i<128)
         {
            png_uint_32 t = v++;
            buffer[8*i+0] = (t >> 8) & 0xff;
            buffer[8*i+1] = t & 0xff;
            buffer[8*i+4] = (t >> 8) & 0xff;
            buffer[8*i+5] = t & 0xff;
            t *= 257;
            buffer[8*i+2] = (t >> 8) & 0xff;
            buffer[8*i+3] = t & 0xff;
            buffer[8*i+6] = (t >> 8) & 0xff;
            buffer[8*i+7] = t & 0xff;
            ++i;
         }
         return;
3233

3234 3235
      default:
         break;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
3236 3237 3238 3239 3240
   }

   png_error(pp, "internal error");
}

3241 3242 3243 3244 3245
/* This is just to do the right cast - could be changed to a function to check
 * 'bd' but there isn't much point.
 */
#define DEPTH(bd) ((png_byte)(1U << (bd)))

3246 3247 3248 3249 3250 3251
/* Make a standardized image given a an image colour type, bit depth and
 * interlace type.  The standard images have a very restricted range of
 * rows and heights and are used for testing transforms rather than image
 * layout details.  See make_size_images below for a way to make images
 * that test odd sizes along with the libpng interlace handling.
 */
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
3252
static void
3253
make_transform_image(png_store* PNG_CONST ps, png_byte PNG_CONST colour_type,
3254 3255
    png_byte PNG_CONST bit_depth, int palette_number, int interlace_type,
    png_const_charp name)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
3256
{
3257
   context(ps, fault);
3258

3259
   Try
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
3260 3261
   {
      png_infop pi;
3262 3263 3264 3265 3266 3267 3268 3269 3270 3271
      png_structp pp = set_store_for_write(ps, &pi, name);
      png_uint_32 h;

      /* In the event of a problem return control to the Catch statement below
       * to do the clean up - it is not possible to 'return' directly from a Try
       * block.
       */
      if (pp == NULL)
         Throw ps;

3272
      h = transform_height(pp, colour_type, bit_depth);
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
3273

3274
      png_set_IHDR(pp, pi, transform_width(pp, colour_type, bit_depth), h,
3275 3276 3277
         bit_depth, colour_type, interlace_type,
         PNG_COMPRESSION_TYPE_BASE, PNG_FILTER_TYPE_BASE);

3278 3279 3280 3281 3282 3283 3284 3285 3286 3287 3288 3289 3290 3291 3292 3293 3294 3295 3296 3297 3298 3299 3300 3301
#ifdef PNG_TEXT_SUPPORTED
      {
         static char key[] = "image name"; /* must be writeable */
         size_t pos;
         png_text text;
         char copy[FILE_NAME_SIZE];

         /* Use a compressed text string to test the correct interaction of text
          * compression and IDAT compression.
          */
         text.compression = PNG_TEXT_COMPRESSION_zTXt;
         text.key = key;
         /* Yuck: the text must be writable! */
         pos = safecat(copy, sizeof copy, 0, ps->wname);
         text.text = copy;
         text.text_length = pos;
         text.itxt_length = 0;
         text.lang = 0;
         text.lang_key = 0;

         png_set_text(pp, pi, &text, 1);
      }
#endif

3302
      if (colour_type == 3) /* palette */
3303
         init_standard_palette(ps, pp, pi, 1U << bit_depth, 1/*do tRNS*/);
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
3304

3305
      png_write_info(pp, pi);
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
3306

3307
      if (png_get_rowbytes(pp, pi) !=
3308
          transform_rowsize(pp, colour_type, bit_depth))
3309 3310 3311
         png_error(pp, "row size incorrect");

      else
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
3312
      {
3313
         /* Somewhat confusingly this must be called *after* png_write_info
3314
          * because if it is called before, the information in *pp has not been
3315 3316 3317 3318
          * updated to reflect the interlaced image.
          */
         int npasses = png_set_interlace_handling(pp);
         int pass;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
3319

3320 3321
         if (npasses != npasses_from_interlace_type(pp, interlace_type))
            png_error(pp, "write: png_set_interlace_handling failed");
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
3322

3323
         for (pass=0; pass<npasses; ++pass)
3324
         {
3325
            png_uint_32 y;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
3326

3327 3328
            for (y=0; y<h; ++y)
            {
3329
               png_byte buffer[TRANSFORM_ROWMAX];
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
3330

3331
               transform_row(pp, buffer, colour_type, bit_depth, y);
3332 3333
               png_write_row(pp, buffer);
            }
3334
         }
3335
      }
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
3336

3337 3338 3339 3340 3341 3342 3343 3344 3345 3346 3347 3348 3349 3350 3351 3352 3353 3354 3355 3356 3357
#ifdef PNG_TEXT_SUPPORTED
      {
         static char key[] = "end marker";
         static char comment[] = "end";
         png_text text;

         /* Use a compressed text string to test the correct interaction of text
          * compression and IDAT compression.
          */
         text.compression = PNG_TEXT_COMPRESSION_zTXt;
         text.key = key;
         text.text = comment;
         text.text_length = (sizeof comment)-1;
         text.itxt_length = 0;
         text.lang = 0;
         text.lang_key = 0;

         png_set_text(pp, pi, &text, 1);
      }
#endif

3358
      png_write_end(pp, pi);
3359

3360
      /* And store this under the appropriate id, then clean up. */
3361 3362
      store_storefile(ps, FILEID(colour_type, bit_depth, palette_number,
         interlace_type, 0, 0, 0));
3363

3364 3365
      store_write_reset(ps);
   }
3366

3367 3368
   Catch(fault)
   {
3369
      /* Use the png_store returned by the exception. This may help the compiler
3370 3371 3372 3373
       * because 'ps' is not used in this branch of the setjmp.  Note that fault
       * and ps will always be the same value.
       */
      store_write_reset(fault);
3374 3375
   }
}
3376

3377
static void
3378
make_transform_images(png_store *ps)
3379
{
3380 3381 3382 3383 3384 3385 3386 3387 3388 3389 3390
   png_byte colour_type = 0;
   png_byte bit_depth = 0;
   int palette_number = 0;

   /* This is in case of errors. */
   safecat(ps->test, sizeof ps->test, 0, "make standard images");

   /* Use next_format to enumerate all the combinations we test, including
    * generating multiple low bit depth palette images.
    */
   while (next_format(&colour_type, &bit_depth, &palette_number))
3391 3392
   {
      int interlace_type;
3393

3394 3395
      for (interlace_type = PNG_INTERLACE_NONE;
           interlace_type < PNG_INTERLACE_LAST; ++interlace_type)
3396
      {
3397 3398
         char name[FILE_NAME_SIZE];

3399 3400 3401 3402
         standard_name(name, sizeof name, 0, colour_type, bit_depth,
            palette_number, interlace_type, 0, 0, 0);
         make_transform_image(ps, colour_type, bit_depth, palette_number,
            interlace_type, name);
3403
      }
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
3404 3405 3406
   }
}

3407 3408 3409 3410 3411 3412 3413 3414 3415 3416 3417 3418 3419 3420 3421 3422 3423 3424 3425 3426 3427 3428 3429 3430 3431 3432 3433 3434 3435 3436 3437 3438 3439 3440 3441 3442 3443 3444 3445 3446 3447 3448 3449 3450
/* The following two routines use the PNG interlace support macros from
 * png.h to interlace or deinterlace rows.
 */
static void
interlace_row(png_bytep buffer, png_const_bytep imageRow,
   unsigned int pixel_size, png_uint_32 w, int pass)
{
   png_uint_32 xin, xout, xstep;

   /* Note that this can, trivially, be optimized to a memcpy on pass 7, the
    * code is presented this way to make it easier to understand.  In practice
    * consult the code in the libpng source to see other ways of doing this.
    */
   xin = PNG_PASS_START_COL(pass);
   xstep = 1U<<PNG_PASS_COL_SHIFT(pass);

   for (xout=0; xin<w; xin+=xstep)
   {
      pixel_copy(buffer, xout, imageRow, xin, pixel_size);
      ++xout;
   }
}

static void
deinterlace_row(png_bytep buffer, png_const_bytep row,
   unsigned int pixel_size, png_uint_32 w, int pass)
{
   /* The inverse of the above, 'row' is part of row 'y' of the output image,
    * in 'buffer'.  The image is 'w' wide and this is pass 'pass', distribute
    * the pixels of row into buffer and return the number written (to allow
    * this to be checked).
    */
   png_uint_32 xin, xout, xstep;

   xout = PNG_PASS_START_COL(pass);
   xstep = 1U<<PNG_PASS_COL_SHIFT(pass);

   for (xin=0; xout<w; xout+=xstep)
   {
      pixel_copy(buffer, xout, row, xin, pixel_size);
      ++xin;
   }
}

3451
/* Build a single row for the 'size' test images; this fills in only the
3452 3453 3454 3455 3456 3457 3458 3459 3460 3461 3462 3463 3464 3465 3466 3467 3468 3469 3470 3471 3472 3473 3474 3475 3476 3477 3478 3479 3480 3481 3482 3483 3484 3485
 * first bit_width bits of the sample row.
 */
static void
size_row(png_byte buffer[SIZE_ROWMAX], png_uint_32 bit_width, png_uint_32 y)
{
   /* height is in the range 1 to 16, so: */
   y = ((y & 1) << 7) + ((y & 2) << 6) + ((y & 4) << 5) + ((y & 8) << 4);
   /* the following ensures bits are set in small images: */
   y ^= 0xA5;

   while (bit_width >= 8)
      *buffer++ = (png_byte)y++, bit_width -= 8;

   /* There may be up to 7 remaining bits, these go in the most significant
    * bits of the byte.
    */
   if (bit_width > 0)
   {
      png_uint_32 mask = (1U<<(8-bit_width))-1;
      *buffer = (png_byte)((*buffer & mask) | (y & ~mask));
   }
}

static void
make_size_image(png_store* PNG_CONST ps, png_byte PNG_CONST colour_type,
    png_byte PNG_CONST bit_depth, int PNG_CONST interlace_type,
    png_uint_32 PNG_CONST w, png_uint_32 PNG_CONST h,
    int PNG_CONST do_interlace)
{
   context(ps, fault);

   Try
   {
      png_infop pi;
3486
      png_structp pp;
3487
      unsigned int pixel_size;
3488 3489 3490

      /* Make a name and get an appropriate id for the store: */
      char name[FILE_NAME_SIZE];
3491 3492
      PNG_CONST png_uint_32 id = FILEID(colour_type, bit_depth, 0/*palette*/,
         interlace_type, w, h, do_interlace);
3493 3494 3495

      standard_name_from_id(name, sizeof name, 0, id);
      pp = set_store_for_write(ps, &pi, name);
3496 3497 3498 3499 3500 3501 3502 3503 3504 3505 3506 3507

      /* In the event of a problem return control to the Catch statement below
       * to do the clean up - it is not possible to 'return' directly from a Try
       * block.
       */
      if (pp == NULL)
         Throw ps;

      png_set_IHDR(pp, pi, w, h, bit_depth, colour_type, interlace_type,
         PNG_COMPRESSION_TYPE_BASE, PNG_FILTER_TYPE_BASE);

      if (colour_type == 3) /* palette */
3508
         init_standard_palette(ps, pp, pi, 1U << bit_depth, 0/*do tRNS*/);
3509 3510 3511 3512 3513 3514 3515 3516 3517 3518 3519 3520 3521 3522 3523 3524 3525 3526 3527 3528 3529 3530 3531 3532 3533 3534 3535 3536 3537 3538 3539 3540 3541 3542 3543 3544 3545 3546 3547 3548 3549 3550 3551 3552 3553

      png_write_info(pp, pi);

      /* Calculate the bit size, divide by 8 to get the byte size - this won't
       * overflow because we know the w values are all small enough even for
       * a system where 'unsigned int' is only 16 bits.
       */
      pixel_size = bit_size(pp, colour_type, bit_depth);
      if (png_get_rowbytes(pp, pi) != ((w * pixel_size) + 7) / 8)
         png_error(pp, "row size incorrect");

      else
      {
         int npasses = npasses_from_interlace_type(pp, interlace_type);
         png_uint_32 y;
         int pass;
         png_byte image[16][SIZE_ROWMAX];

         /* To help consistent error detection make the parts of this buffer
          * that aren't set below all '1':
          */
         memset(image, 0xff, sizeof image);

         if (!do_interlace && npasses != png_set_interlace_handling(pp))
            png_error(pp, "write: png_set_interlace_handling failed");

         /* Prepare the whole image first to avoid making it 7 times: */
         for (y=0; y<h; ++y)
            size_row(image[y], w * pixel_size, y);

         for (pass=0; pass<npasses; ++pass)
         {
            /* The following two are for checking the macros: */
            PNG_CONST png_uint_32 wPass = PNG_PASS_COLS(w, pass);

            /* If do_interlace is set we don't call png_write_row for every
             * row because some of them are empty.  In fact, for a 1x1 image,
             * most of them are empty!
             */
            for (y=0; y<h; ++y)
            {
               png_const_bytep row = image[y];
               png_byte tempRow[SIZE_ROWMAX];

               /* If do_interlace *and* the image is interlaced we
3554
                * need a reduced interlace row; this may be reduced
3555 3556 3557 3558 3559 3560 3561 3562 3563 3564 3565 3566 3567 3568 3569 3570 3571 3572 3573 3574 3575 3576 3577 3578 3579 3580 3581 3582 3583 3584 3585 3586 3587 3588 3589 3590 3591 3592 3593 3594 3595 3596 3597 3598 3599 3600 3601 3602 3603 3604 3605 3606 3607 3608 3609 3610 3611 3612 3613 3614 3615 3616 3617 3618 3619 3620 3621 3622 3623 3624 3625 3626 3627 3628 3629 3630 3631 3632 3633 3634 3635 3636 3637 3638 3639 3640 3641 3642 3643 3644 3645 3646 3647 3648 3649 3650 3651 3652 3653 3654 3655 3656 3657 3658 3659
                * to empty.
                */
               if (do_interlace && interlace_type == PNG_INTERLACE_ADAM7)
               {
                  /* The row must not be written if it doesn't exist, notice
                   * that there are two conditions here, either the row isn't
                   * ever in the pass or the row would be but isn't wide
                   * enough to contribute any pixels.  In fact the wPass test
                   * can be used to skip the whole y loop in this case.
                   */
                  if (PNG_ROW_IN_INTERLACE_PASS(y, pass) && wPass > 0)
                  {
                     /* Set to all 1's for error detection (libpng tends to
                      * set unset things to 0).
                      */
                     memset(tempRow, 0xff, sizeof tempRow);
                     interlace_row(tempRow, row, pixel_size, w, pass);
                     row = tempRow;
                  }
                  else
                     continue;
               }

               /* Only get to here if the row has some pixels in it. */
               png_write_row(pp, row);
            }
         }
      }

      png_write_end(pp, pi);

      /* And store this under the appropriate id, then clean up. */
      store_storefile(ps, id);

      store_write_reset(ps);
   }

   Catch(fault)
   {
      /* Use the png_store returned by the exception. This may help the compiler
       * because 'ps' is not used in this branch of the setjmp.  Note that fault
       * and ps will always be the same value.
       */
      store_write_reset(fault);
   }
}

static void
make_size(png_store* PNG_CONST ps, png_byte PNG_CONST colour_type, int bdlo,
    int PNG_CONST bdhi)
{
   for (; bdlo <= bdhi; ++bdlo)
   {
      png_uint_32 width;

      for (width = 1; width <= 16; ++width)
      {
         png_uint_32 height;

         for (height = 1; height <= 16; ++height)
         {
            /* The four combinations of DIY interlace and interlace or not -
             * no interlace + DIY should be identical to no interlace with
             * libpng doing it.
             */
            make_size_image(ps, colour_type, DEPTH(bdlo), PNG_INTERLACE_NONE,
               width, height, 0);
            make_size_image(ps, colour_type, DEPTH(bdlo), PNG_INTERLACE_NONE,
               width, height, 1);
            make_size_image(ps, colour_type, DEPTH(bdlo), PNG_INTERLACE_ADAM7,
               width, height, 0);
            make_size_image(ps, colour_type, DEPTH(bdlo), PNG_INTERLACE_ADAM7,
               width, height, 1);
         }
      }
   }
}

static void
make_size_images(png_store *ps)
{
   /* This is in case of errors. */
   safecat(ps->test, sizeof ps->test, 0, "make size images");

   /* Arguments are colour_type, low bit depth, high bit depth
    */
   make_size(ps, 0, 0, WRITE_BDHI);
   make_size(ps, 2, 3, WRITE_BDHI);
   make_size(ps, 3, 0, 3 /*palette: max 8 bits*/);
   make_size(ps, 4, 3, WRITE_BDHI);
   make_size(ps, 6, 3, WRITE_BDHI);
}

/* Return a row based on image id and 'y' for checking: */
static void
standard_row(png_structp pp, png_byte std[STANDARD_ROWMAX], png_uint_32 id,
   png_uint_32 y)
{
   if (WIDTH_FROM_ID(id) == 0)
      transform_row(pp, std, COL_FROM_ID(id), DEPTH_FROM_ID(id), y);
   else
      size_row(std, WIDTH_FROM_ID(id) * bit_size(pp, COL_FROM_ID(id),
         DEPTH_FROM_ID(id)), y);
}

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
3660
/* Tests - individual test cases */
3661 3662 3663 3664
/* Like 'make_standard' but errors are deliberately introduced into the calls
 * to ensure that they get detected - it should not be possible to write an
 * invalid image with libpng!
 */
3665
#ifdef PNG_WARNINGS_SUPPORTED
3666 3667 3668 3669 3670 3671 3672 3673 3674 3675 3676 3677 3678 3679 3680 3681 3682 3683 3684 3685 3686 3687 3688 3689 3690 3691 3692
static void
sBIT0_error_fn(png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
{
   /* 0 is invalid... */
   png_color_8 bad;
   bad.red = bad.green = bad.blue = bad.gray = bad.alpha = 0;
   png_set_sBIT(pp, pi, &bad);
}

static void
sBIT_error_fn(png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
{
   png_byte bit_depth;
   png_color_8 bad;

   if (png_get_color_type(pp, pi) == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_PALETTE)
      bit_depth = 8;

   else
      bit_depth = png_get_bit_depth(pp, pi);

   /* Now we know the bit depth we can easily generate an invalid sBIT entry */
   bad.red = bad.green = bad.blue = bad.gray = bad.alpha =
      (png_byte)(bit_depth+1);
   png_set_sBIT(pp, pi, &bad);
}

3693
static PNG_CONST struct
3694 3695 3696 3697 3698 3699
{
   void          (*fn)(png_structp, png_infop);
   PNG_CONST char *msg;
   unsigned int    warning :1; /* the error is a warning... */
} error_test[] =
    {
3700
       /* no warnings makes these errors undetectable. */
3701 3702 3703 3704 3705
       { sBIT0_error_fn, "sBIT(0): failed to detect error", 1 },
       { sBIT_error_fn, "sBIT(too big): failed to detect error", 1 },
    };

static void
3706
make_error(png_store* volatile psIn, png_byte PNG_CONST colour_type,
3707
    png_byte bit_depth, int interlace_type, int test, png_const_charp name)
3708
{
3709 3710
   png_store * volatile ps = psIn;

3711
   context(ps, fault);
3712

3713 3714 3715 3716
   Try
   {
      png_structp pp;
      png_infop pi;
3717

3718
      pp = set_store_for_write(ps, &pi, name);
3719

3720 3721
      if (pp == NULL)
         Throw ps;
3722

3723 3724
      png_set_IHDR(pp, pi, transform_width(pp, colour_type, bit_depth),
         transform_height(pp, colour_type, bit_depth), bit_depth, colour_type,
3725
         interlace_type, PNG_COMPRESSION_TYPE_BASE, PNG_FILTER_TYPE_BASE);
3726

3727
      if (colour_type == 3) /* palette */
3728
         init_standard_palette(ps, pp, pi, 1U << bit_depth, 0/*do tRNS*/);
3729

3730
      /* Time for a few errors; these are in various optional chunks, the
3731 3732
       * standard tests test the standard chunks pretty well.
       */
3733 3734
#     define exception__prev exception_prev_1
#     define exception__env exception_env_1
3735 3736 3737 3738 3739 3740 3741
      Try
      {
         /* Expect this to throw: */
         ps->expect_error = !error_test[test].warning;
         ps->expect_warning = error_test[test].warning;
         ps->saw_warning = 0;
         error_test[test].fn(pp, pi);
3742

3743 3744
         /* Normally the error is only detected here: */
         png_write_info(pp, pi);
3745

3746 3747 3748
         /* And handle the case where it was only a warning: */
         if (ps->expect_warning && ps->saw_warning)
            Throw ps;
3749

3750 3751
         /* If we get here there is a problem, we have success - no error or
          * no warning - when we shouldn't have success.  Log an error.
3752
          */
3753
         store_log(ps, pp, error_test[test].msg, 1 /*error*/);
3754
      }
3755

3756
      Catch (fault)
3757
         ps = fault; /* expected exit, make sure ps is not clobbered */
3758 3759
#undef exception__prev
#undef exception__env
3760

3761 3762
      /* And clear these flags */
      ps->expect_error = 0;
3763
      ps->expect_warning = 0;
3764

3765 3766 3767 3768
      /* Now write the whole image, just to make sure that the detected, or
       * undetected, errro has not created problems inside libpng.
       */
      if (png_get_rowbytes(pp, pi) !=
3769
          transform_rowsize(pp, colour_type, bit_depth))
3770
         png_error(pp, "row size incorrect");
3771

3772 3773
      else
      {
3774
         png_uint_32 h = transform_height(pp, colour_type, bit_depth);
3775 3776 3777 3778 3779 3780
         int npasses = png_set_interlace_handling(pp);
         int pass;

         if (npasses != npasses_from_interlace_type(pp, interlace_type))
            png_error(pp, "write: png_set_interlace_handling failed");

3781
         for (pass=0; pass<npasses; ++pass)
3782 3783
         {
            png_uint_32 y;
3784

3785
            for (y=0; y<h; ++y)
3786
            {
3787
               png_byte buffer[TRANSFORM_ROWMAX];
3788

3789
               transform_row(pp, buffer, colour_type, bit_depth, y);
3790 3791
               png_write_row(pp, buffer);
            }
3792 3793
         }
      }
3794

3795
      png_write_end(pp, pi);
3796

3797 3798 3799
      /* The following deletes the file that was just written. */
      store_write_reset(ps);
   }
3800

3801 3802
   Catch(fault)
   {
3803
      store_write_reset(fault);
3804 3805 3806 3807 3808 3809 3810 3811 3812 3813 3814 3815 3816 3817 3818 3819 3820
   }
}

static int
make_errors(png_modifier* PNG_CONST pm, png_byte PNG_CONST colour_type,
    int bdlo, int PNG_CONST bdhi)
{
   for (; bdlo <= bdhi; ++bdlo)
   {
      int interlace_type;

      for (interlace_type = PNG_INTERLACE_NONE;
           interlace_type < PNG_INTERLACE_LAST; ++interlace_type)
      {
         unsigned int test;
         char name[FILE_NAME_SIZE];

3821 3822
         standard_name(name, sizeof name, 0, colour_type, 1<<bdlo, 0,
            interlace_type, 0, 0, 0);
3823 3824

         for (test=0; test<(sizeof error_test)/(sizeof error_test[0]); ++test)
3825
         {
3826 3827
            make_error(&pm->this, colour_type, DEPTH(bdlo), interlace_type,
               test, name);
3828

3829 3830
            if (fail(pm))
               return 0;
3831 3832
         }
      }
3833 3834 3835
   }

   return 1; /* keep going */
3836
}
3837
#endif
3838 3839 3840 3841

static void
perform_error_test(png_modifier *pm)
{
3842
#ifdef PNG_WARNINGS_SUPPORTED /* else there are no cases that work! */
3843 3844 3845
   /* Need to do this here because we just write in this test. */
   safecat(pm->this.test, sizeof pm->this.test, 0, "error test");

3846
   if (!make_errors(pm, 0, 0, WRITE_BDHI))
3847 3848
      return;

3849
   if (!make_errors(pm, 2, 3, WRITE_BDHI))
3850 3851
      return;

3852
   if (!make_errors(pm, 3, 0, 3))
3853 3854
      return;

3855
   if (!make_errors(pm, 4, 3, WRITE_BDHI))
3856 3857
      return;

3858
   if (!make_errors(pm, 6, 3, WRITE_BDHI))
3859
      return;
3860 3861 3862 3863 3864 3865 3866 3867 3868 3869 3870 3871 3872 3873 3874 3875 3876 3877 3878 3879 3880 3881 3882 3883 3884 3885 3886 3887 3888 3889 3890 3891 3892 3893 3894 3895 3896 3897 3898 3899 3900 3901 3902 3903 3904 3905 3906 3907 3908 3909 3910 3911 3912 3913 3914 3915 3916 3917 3918 3919 3920 3921 3922 3923 3924 3925 3926
#else
   UNUSED(pm)
#endif
}

/* This is just to validate the internal PNG formatting code - if this fails
 * then the warning messages the library outputs will probably be garbage.
 */
static void
perform_formatting_test(png_store *volatile ps)
{
#ifdef PNG_TIME_RFC1123_SUPPORTED
   /* The handle into the formatting code is the RFC1123 support; this test does
    * nothing if that is compiled out.
    */
   context(ps, fault);

   Try
   {
      png_const_charp correct = "29 Aug 2079 13:53:60 +0000";
      png_const_charp result;
      png_structp pp;
      png_time pt;

      pp = set_store_for_write(ps, NULL, "libpng formatting test");

      if (pp == NULL)
         Throw ps;


      /* Arbitrary settings: */
      pt.year = 2079;
      pt.month = 8;
      pt.day = 29;
      pt.hour = 13;
      pt.minute = 53;
      pt.second = 60; /* a leap second */

      result = png_convert_to_rfc1123(pp, &pt);

      if (result == NULL)
         png_error(pp, "png_convert_to_rfc1123 failed");

      if (strcmp(result, correct) != 0)
      {
         size_t pos = 0;
         char msg[128];

         pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "png_convert_to_rfc1123(");
         pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, correct);
         pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, ") returned: '");
         pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, result);
         pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "'");

         png_error(pp, msg);
      }

      store_write_reset(ps);
   }

   Catch(fault)
   {
      store_write_reset(fault);
   }
#else
   UNUSED(ps)
#endif
3927 3928
}

3929 3930 3931 3932 3933 3934
/* Because we want to use the same code in both the progressive reader and the
 * sequential reader it is necessary to deal with the fact that the progressive
 * reader callbacks only have one parameter (png_get_progressive_ptr()), so this
 * must contain all the test parameters and all the local variables directly
 * accessible to the sequential reader implementation.
 *
3935
 * The technique adopted is to reinvent part of what Dijkstra termed a
3936 3937 3938 3939 3940 3941 3942 3943 3944 3945 3946 3947 3948 3949 3950
 * 'display'; an array of pointers to the stack frames of enclosing functions so
 * that a nested function definition can access the local (C auto) variables of
 * the functions that contain its definition.  In fact C provides the first
 * pointer (the local variables - the stack frame pointer) and the last (the
 * global variables - the BCPL global vector typically implemented as global
 * addresses), this code requires one more pointer to make the display - the
 * local variables (and function call parameters) of the function that actually
 * invokes either the progressive or sequential reader.
 *
 * Perhaps confusingly this technique is confounded with classes - the
 * 'standard_display' defined here is sub-classed as the 'gamma_display' below.
 * A gamma_display is a standard_display, taking advantage of the ANSI-C
 * requirement that the pointer to the first member of a structure must be the
 * same as the pointer to the structure.  This allows us to reuse standard_
 * functions in the gamma test code; something that could not be done with
3951
 * nested functions!
3952 3953 3954 3955 3956 3957
 */
typedef struct standard_display
{
   png_store*  ps;             /* Test parameters (passed to the function) */
   png_byte    colour_type;
   png_byte    bit_depth;
3958 3959 3960 3961
   png_byte    red_sBIT;       /* Input data sBIT values. */
   png_byte    green_sBIT;
   png_byte    blue_sBIT;
   png_byte    alpha_sBIT;
3962 3963 3964 3965 3966
   int         interlace_type;
   png_uint_32 id;             /* Calculated file ID */
   png_uint_32 w;              /* Width of image */
   png_uint_32 h;              /* Height of image */
   int         npasses;        /* Number of interlaced passes */
3967 3968 3969 3970
   png_uint_32 pixel_size;     /* Width of one pixel in bits */
   png_uint_32 bit_width;      /* Width of output row in bits */
   size_t      cbRow;          /* Bytes in a row of the output image */
   int         do_interlace;   /* Do interlacing internally */
3971 3972
   int         is_transparent; /* Transparency information was present. */
   int         speed;          /* Doing a speed test */
3973
   int         use_update_info;/* Call update_info, not start_image */
3974 3975 3976 3977 3978 3979
   struct
   {
      png_uint_16 red;
      png_uint_16 green;
      png_uint_16 blue;
   }           transparent;    /* The transparent color, if set. */
3980 3981
   int         npalette;       /* Number of entries in the palette. */
   store_palette
3982
               palette;
3983 3984
} standard_display;

3985
static void
3986
standard_display_init(standard_display *dp, png_store* ps, png_uint_32 id,
3987
   int do_interlace, int use_update_info)
3988
{
3989 3990
   memset(dp, 0, sizeof *dp);

3991
   dp->ps = ps;
3992 3993
   dp->colour_type = COL_FROM_ID(id);
   dp->bit_depth = DEPTH_FROM_ID(id);
3994 3995
   if (dp->bit_depth < 1 || dp->bit_depth > 16)
      internal_error(ps, "internal: bad bit depth");
3996 3997 3998 3999 4000
   if (dp->colour_type == 3)
      dp->red_sBIT = dp->blue_sBIT = dp->green_sBIT = dp->alpha_sBIT = 8;
   else
      dp->red_sBIT = dp->blue_sBIT = dp->green_sBIT = dp->alpha_sBIT =
         dp->bit_depth;
4001 4002 4003
   dp->interlace_type = INTERLACE_FROM_ID(id);
   dp->id = id;
   /* All the rest are filled in after the read_info: */
4004 4005 4006
   dp->w = 0;
   dp->h = 0;
   dp->npasses = 0;
4007 4008
   dp->pixel_size = 0;
   dp->bit_width = 0;
4009
   dp->cbRow = 0;
4010
   dp->do_interlace = do_interlace;
4011
   dp->is_transparent = 0;
4012
   dp->speed = ps->speed;
4013
   dp->use_update_info = use_update_info;
4014
   dp->npalette = 0;
4015 4016 4017 4018
   /* Preset the transparent color to black: */
   memset(&dp->transparent, 0, sizeof dp->transparent);
   /* Preset the palette to full intensity/opaque througout: */
   memset(dp->palette, 0xff, sizeof dp->palette);
4019 4020
}

4021 4022 4023 4024 4025 4026 4027 4028 4029 4030 4031 4032 4033 4034 4035 4036 4037 4038 4039 4040 4041 4042 4043 4044 4045 4046 4047 4048 4049 4050 4051 4052 4053 4054
/* Initialize the palette fields - this must be done later because the palette
 * comes from the particular png_store_file that is selected.
 */
static void
standard_palette_init(standard_display *dp)
{
   store_palette_entry *palette = store_current_palette(dp->ps, &dp->npalette);

   /* The remaining entries remain white/opaque. */
   if (dp->npalette > 0)
   {
      int i = dp->npalette;
      memcpy(dp->palette, palette, i * sizeof *palette);

      /* Check for a non-opaque palette entry: */
      while (--i >= 0)
         if (palette[i].alpha < 255)
            break;

#     ifdef __GNUC__
         /* GCC can't handle the more obviously optimizable version. */
         if (i >= 0)
            dp->is_transparent = 1;
         else
            dp->is_transparent = 0;
#     else
         dp->is_transparent = (i >= 0);
#     endif
   }
}

/* Utility to read the palette from the PNG file and convert it into
 * store_palette format.  This returns 1 if there is any transparency in the
 * palette (it does not check for a transparent colour in the non-palette case.)
4055 4056
 */
static int
4057
read_palette(store_palette palette, int *npalette, png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
4058 4059 4060 4061 4062 4063
{
   png_colorp pal;
   png_bytep trans_alpha;
   int num;

   pal = 0;
4064 4065 4066
   *npalette = -1;

   if (png_get_PLTE(pp, pi, &pal, npalette) & PNG_INFO_PLTE)
4067
   {
4068
      int i = *npalette;
4069

4070 4071 4072 4073
      if (i <= 0 || i > 256)
         png_error(pp, "validate: invalid PLTE count");

      while (--i >= 0)
4074 4075 4076 4077 4078 4079
      {
         palette[i].red = pal[i].red;
         palette[i].green = pal[i].green;
         palette[i].blue = pal[i].blue;
      }

4080 4081 4082 4083
      /* Mark the remainder of the entries with a flag value (other than
       * white/opaque which is the flag value stored above.)
       */
      memset(palette + *npalette, 126, (256-*npalette) * sizeof *palette);
4084 4085 4086
   }

   else /* !png_get_PLTE */
4087 4088 4089 4090 4091
   {
      if (*npalette != (-1))
         png_error(pp, "validate: invalid PLTE result");
      /* But there is no palette, so record this: */
      *npalette = 0;
4092
      memset(palette, 113, sizeof (store_palette));
4093
   }
4094 4095

   trans_alpha = 0;
4096 4097 4098 4099
   num = 2; /* force error below */
   if ((png_get_tRNS(pp, pi, &trans_alpha, &num, 0) & PNG_INFO_tRNS) != 0 &&
      (trans_alpha != NULL || num != 1/*returns 1 for a transparent color*/) &&
      /* Oops, if a palette tRNS gets expanded png_read_update_info (at least so
4100 4101
       * far as 1.5.4) does not remove the trans_alpha pointer, only num_trans,
       * so in the above call we get a success, we get a pointer (who knows what
4102 4103 4104
       * to) and we get num_trans == 0:
       */
      !(trans_alpha != NULL && num == 0)) /* TODO: fix this in libpng. */
4105 4106 4107 4108 4109 4110 4111 4112 4113
   {
      int i;

      /* Any of these are crash-worthy - given the implementation of
       * png_get_tRNS up to 1.5 an app won't crash if it just checks the
       * result above and fails to check that the variables it passed have
       * actually been filled in!  Note that if the app were to pass the
       * last, png_color_16p, variable too it couldn't rely on this.
       */
4114
      if (trans_alpha == NULL || num <= 0 || num > 256 || num > *npalette)
4115 4116 4117 4118 4119
         png_error(pp, "validate: unexpected png_get_tRNS (palette) result");

      for (i=0; i<num; ++i)
         palette[i].alpha = trans_alpha[i];

4120
      for (num=*npalette; i<num; ++i)
4121 4122
         palette[i].alpha = 255;

4123 4124 4125
      for (; i<256; ++i)
         palette[i].alpha = 33; /* flag value */

4126 4127 4128 4129 4130
      return 1; /* transparency */
   }

   else
   {
4131
      /* No palette transparency - just set the alpha channel to opaque. */
4132 4133
      int i;

4134
      for (i=0, num=*npalette; i<num; ++i)
4135 4136
         palette[i].alpha = 255;

4137 4138 4139
      for (; i<256; ++i)
         palette[i].alpha = 55; /* flag value */

4140 4141 4142 4143
      return 0; /* no transparency */
   }
}

4144 4145 4146 4147 4148 4149 4150 4151 4152 4153 4154 4155 4156 4157 4158 4159 4160 4161 4162 4163 4164 4165 4166 4167 4168 4169 4170 4171 4172 4173 4174 4175 4176 4177 4178 4179
/* Utility to validate the palette if it should not have changed (the
 * non-transform case).
 */
static void
standard_palette_validate(standard_display *dp, png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
{
   int npalette;
   store_palette palette;

   if (read_palette(palette, &npalette, pp, pi) != dp->is_transparent)
      png_error(pp, "validate: palette transparency changed");

   if (npalette != dp->npalette)
   {
      size_t pos = 0;
      char msg[64];

      pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "validate: palette size changed: ");
      pos = safecatn(msg, sizeof msg, pos, dp->npalette);
      pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, " -> ");
      pos = safecatn(msg, sizeof msg, pos, npalette);
      png_error(pp, msg);
   }

   {
      int i = npalette; /* npalette is aliased */

      while (--i >= 0)
         if (palette[i].red != dp->palette[i].red ||
            palette[i].green != dp->palette[i].green ||
            palette[i].blue != dp->palette[i].blue ||
            palette[i].alpha != dp->palette[i].alpha)
            png_error(pp, "validate: PLTE or tRNS chunk changed");
   }
}

4180
/* By passing a 'standard_display' the progressive callbacks can be used
4181
 * directly by the sequential code, the functions suffixed "_imp" are the
4182 4183 4184 4185 4186 4187 4188 4189
 * implementations, the functions without the suffix are the callbacks.
 *
 * The code for the info callback is split into two because this callback calls
 * png_read_update_info or png_start_read_image and what gets called depends on
 * whether the info needs updating (we want to test both calls in pngvalid.)
 */
static void
standard_info_part1(standard_display *dp, png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
4190
{
4191
   if (png_get_bit_depth(pp, pi) != dp->bit_depth)
4192 4193
      png_error(pp, "validate: bit depth changed");

4194
   if (png_get_color_type(pp, pi) != dp->colour_type)
4195 4196 4197 4198 4199
      png_error(pp, "validate: color type changed");

   if (png_get_filter_type(pp, pi) != PNG_FILTER_TYPE_BASE)
      png_error(pp, "validate: filter type changed");

4200
   if (png_get_interlace_type(pp, pi) != dp->interlace_type)
4201 4202 4203 4204 4205
      png_error(pp, "validate: interlacing changed");

   if (png_get_compression_type(pp, pi) != PNG_COMPRESSION_TYPE_BASE)
      png_error(pp, "validate: compression type changed");

4206 4207
   dp->w = png_get_image_width(pp, pi);

4208
   if (dp->w != standard_width(pp, dp->id))
4209 4210 4211 4212
      png_error(pp, "validate: image width changed");

   dp->h = png_get_image_height(pp, pi);

4213
   if (dp->h != standard_height(pp, dp->id))
4214 4215
      png_error(pp, "validate: image height changed");

4216 4217 4218 4219 4220 4221 4222 4223 4224 4225 4226 4227 4228 4229 4230 4231 4232 4233 4234 4235 4236 4237 4238 4239 4240 4241 4242 4243 4244 4245 4246 4247 4248 4249 4250 4251 4252 4253 4254 4255 4256 4257 4258 4259 4260 4261 4262 4263 4264 4265 4266 4267 4268 4269 4270
   /* Record (but don't check at present) the input sBIT according to the colour
    * type information.
    */
   {
      png_color_8p sBIT = 0;

      if (png_get_sBIT(pp, pi, &sBIT) & PNG_INFO_sBIT)
      {
         int sBIT_invalid = 0;

         if (sBIT == 0)
            png_error(pp, "validate: unexpected png_get_sBIT result");

         if (dp->colour_type & PNG_COLOR_MASK_COLOR)
         {
            if (sBIT->red == 0 || sBIT->red > dp->bit_depth)
               sBIT_invalid = 1;
            else
               dp->red_sBIT = sBIT->red;

            if (sBIT->green == 0 || sBIT->green > dp->bit_depth)
               sBIT_invalid = 1;
            else
               dp->green_sBIT = sBIT->green;

            if (sBIT->blue == 0 || sBIT->blue > dp->bit_depth)
               sBIT_invalid = 1;
            else
               dp->blue_sBIT = sBIT->blue;
         }

         else /* !COLOR */
         {
            if (sBIT->gray == 0 || sBIT->gray > dp->bit_depth)
               sBIT_invalid = 1;
            else
               dp->blue_sBIT = dp->green_sBIT = dp->red_sBIT = sBIT->gray;
         }

         /* All 8 bits in tRNS for a palette image are significant - see the
          * spec.
          */
         if (dp->colour_type & PNG_COLOR_MASK_ALPHA)
         {
            if (sBIT->alpha == 0 || sBIT->alpha > dp->bit_depth)
               sBIT_invalid = 1;
            else
               dp->alpha_sBIT = sBIT->alpha;
         }

         if (sBIT_invalid)
            png_error(pp, "validate: sBIT value out of range");
      }
   }

4271 4272
   /* Important: this is validating the value *before* any transforms have been
    * put in place.  It doesn't matter for the standard tests, where there are
4273
    * no transforms, but it does for other tests where rowbytes may change after
4274 4275
    * png_read_update_info.
    */
4276
   if (png_get_rowbytes(pp, pi) != standard_rowsize(pp, dp->id))
4277 4278
      png_error(pp, "validate: row size changed");

4279 4280
   /* Validate the colour type 3 palette (this can be present on other color
    * types.)
4281
    */
4282
   standard_palette_validate(dp, pp, pi);
4283

4284 4285 4286 4287
   /* In any case always check for a tranparent color (notice that the
    * colour type 3 case must not give a successful return on the get_tRNS call
    * with these arguments!)
    */
4288 4289 4290 4291 4292 4293 4294 4295 4296 4297 4298 4299 4300 4301 4302 4303 4304 4305 4306 4307 4308 4309 4310 4311 4312 4313 4314 4315 4316 4317 4318 4319 4320 4321
   {
      png_color_16p trans_color = 0;

      if (png_get_tRNS(pp, pi, 0, 0, &trans_color) & PNG_INFO_tRNS)
      {
         if (trans_color == 0)
            png_error(pp, "validate: unexpected png_get_tRNS (color) result");

         switch (dp->colour_type)
         {
         case 0:
            dp->transparent.red = dp->transparent.green = dp->transparent.blue =
               trans_color->gray;
            dp->is_transparent = 1;
            break;

         case 2:
            dp->transparent.red = trans_color->red;
            dp->transparent.green = trans_color->green;
            dp->transparent.blue = trans_color->blue;
            dp->is_transparent = 1;
            break;

         case 3:
            /* Not expected because it should result in the array case
             * above.
             */
            png_error(pp, "validate: unexpected png_get_tRNS result");
            break;

         default:
            png_error(pp, "validate: invalid tRNS chunk with alpha image");
         }
      }
4322 4323 4324 4325
   }

   /* Read the number of passes - expected to match the value used when
    * creating the image (interlaced or not).  This has the side effect of
4326
    * turning on interlace handling (if do_interlace is not set.)
4327
    */
4328 4329
   dp->npasses = npasses_from_interlace_type(pp, dp->interlace_type);
   if (!dp->do_interlace && dp->npasses != png_set_interlace_handling(pp))
4330 4331
      png_error(pp, "validate: file changed interlace type");

4332 4333 4334
   /* Caller calls png_read_update_info or png_start_read_image now, then calls
    * part2.
    */
4335 4336
}

4337 4338 4339 4340
/* This must be called *after* the png_read_update_info call to get the correct
 * 'rowbytes' value, otherwise png_get_rowbytes will refer to the untransformed
 * image.
 */
4341
static void
4342 4343
standard_info_part2(standard_display *dp, png_structp pp, png_infop pi,
    int nImages)
4344
{
4345
   /* Record cbRow now that it can be found. */
4346 4347 4348
   dp->pixel_size = bit_size(pp, png_get_color_type(pp, pi),
      png_get_bit_depth(pp, pi));
   dp->bit_width = png_get_image_width(pp, pi) * dp->pixel_size;
4349
   dp->cbRow = png_get_rowbytes(pp, pi);
4350

4351 4352 4353 4354
   /* Validate the rowbytes here again. */
   if (dp->cbRow != (dp->bit_width+7)/8)
      png_error(pp, "bad png_get_rowbytes calculation");

4355
   /* Then ensure there is enough space for the output image(s). */
4356
   store_ensure_image(dp->ps, pp, nImages, dp->cbRow, dp->h);
4357 4358 4359
}

static void
4360 4361
standard_info_imp(standard_display *dp, png_structp pp, png_infop pi,
    int nImages)
4362 4363 4364 4365
{
   /* Note that the validation routine has the side effect of turning on
    * interlace handling in the subsequent code.
    */
4366
   standard_info_part1(dp, pp, pi);
4367 4368 4369 4370

   /* And the info callback has to call this (or png_read_update_info - see
    * below in the png_modifier code for that variant.
    */
4371 4372 4373 4374 4375 4376 4377 4378 4379 4380
   if (dp->use_update_info)
   {
      /* For debugging the effect of multiple calls: */
      int i = dp->use_update_info;
      while (i-- > 0)
         png_read_update_info(pp, pi);
   }

   else
      png_start_read_image(pp);
4381 4382 4383 4384

   /* Validate the height, width and rowbytes plus ensure that sufficient buffer
    * exists for decoding the image.
    */
4385 4386 4387 4388 4389 4390
   standard_info_part2(dp, pp, pi, nImages);
}

static void
standard_info(png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
{
4391 4392
   standard_display *dp = voidcast(standard_display*,
      png_get_progressive_ptr(pp));
4393 4394 4395 4396

   /* Call with nImages==1 because the progressive reader can only produce one
    * image.
    */
4397
   standard_info_imp(dp, pp, pi, 1 /*only one image*/);
4398 4399 4400 4401 4402
}

static void
progressive_row(png_structp pp, png_bytep new_row, png_uint_32 y, int pass)
{
4403 4404
   PNG_CONST standard_display *dp = voidcast(standard_display*,
      png_get_progressive_ptr(pp));
4405 4406

   /* When handling interlacing some rows will be absent in each pass, the
4407 4408 4409
    * callback still gets called, but with a NULL pointer.  This is checked
    * in the 'else' clause below.  We need our own 'cbRow', but we can't call
    * png_get_rowbytes because we got no info structure.
4410 4411 4412
    */
   if (new_row != NULL)
   {
4413 4414 4415 4416 4417 4418
      png_bytep row;

      /* In the case where the reader doesn't do the interlace it gives
       * us the y in the sub-image:
       */
      if (dp->do_interlace && dp->interlace_type == PNG_INTERLACE_ADAM7)
4419
      {
4420
#ifdef PNG_USER_TRANSFORM_INFO_SUPPORTED
4421 4422 4423 4424
         /* Use this opportunity to validate the png 'current' APIs: */
         if (y != png_get_current_row_number(pp))
            png_error(pp, "png_get_current_row_number is broken");

4425 4426
         if (pass != png_get_current_pass_number(pp))
            png_error(pp, "png_get_current_pass_number is broken");
4427
#endif
4428

4429
         y = PNG_ROW_FROM_PASS_ROW(y, pass);
4430
      }
4431 4432 4433 4434 4435

      /* Validate this just in case. */
      if (y >= dp->h)
         png_error(pp, "invalid y to progressive row callback");

4436
      row = store_image_row(dp->ps, pp, 0, y);
4437

4438
#ifdef PNG_READ_INTERLACING_SUPPORTED
4439
      /* Combine the new row into the old: */
4440 4441 4442 4443 4444
      if (dp->do_interlace)
      {
         if (dp->interlace_type == PNG_INTERLACE_ADAM7)
            deinterlace_row(row, new_row, dp->pixel_size, dp->w, pass);
         else
4445
            row_copy(row, new_row, dp->pixel_size * dp->w);
4446 4447 4448 4449 4450 4451 4452
      }
      else
         png_progressive_combine_row(pp, row, new_row);
   } else if (dp->interlace_type == PNG_INTERLACE_ADAM7 &&
      PNG_ROW_IN_INTERLACE_PASS(y, pass) &&
      PNG_PASS_COLS(dp->w, pass) > 0)
      png_error(pp, "missing row in progressive de-interlacing");
4453
#endif /* PNG_READ_INTERLACING_SUPPORTED */
4454 4455
}

4456 4457
static void
sequential_row(standard_display *dp, png_structp pp, png_infop pi,
4458
    PNG_CONST int iImage, PNG_CONST int iDisplay)
4459 4460
{
   PNG_CONST int         npasses = dp->npasses;
4461 4462 4463 4464
   PNG_CONST int         do_interlace = dp->do_interlace &&
      dp->interlace_type == PNG_INTERLACE_ADAM7;
   PNG_CONST png_uint_32 height = standard_height(pp, dp->id);
   PNG_CONST png_uint_32 width = standard_width(pp, dp->id);
4465
   PNG_CONST png_store*  ps = dp->ps;
4466 4467
   int pass;

4468
   for (pass=0; pass<npasses; ++pass)
4469 4470
   {
      png_uint_32 y;
4471
      png_uint_32 wPass = PNG_PASS_COLS(width, pass);
4472

4473
      for (y=0; y<height; ++y)
4474
      {
4475 4476 4477 4478 4479 4480 4481 4482 4483 4484 4485 4486 4487 4488
         if (do_interlace)
         {
            /* wPass may be zero or this row may not be in this pass.
             * png_read_row must not be called in either case.
             */
            if (wPass > 0 && PNG_ROW_IN_INTERLACE_PASS(y, pass))
            {
               /* Read the row into a pair of temporary buffers, then do the
                * merge here into the output rows.
                */
               png_byte row[STANDARD_ROWMAX], display[STANDARD_ROWMAX];

               /* The following aids (to some extent) error detection - we can
                * see where png_read_row wrote.  Use opposite values in row and
4489 4490 4491
                * display to make this easier.  Don't use 0xff (which is used in
                * the image write code to fill unused bits) or 0 (which is a
                * likely value to overwrite unused bits with).
4492
                */
4493 4494
               memset(row, 0xc5, sizeof row);
               memset(display, 0x5c, sizeof display);
4495 4496 4497

               png_read_row(pp, row, display);

4498 4499 4500
               if (iImage >= 0)
                  deinterlace_row(store_image_row(ps, pp, iImage, y), row,
                     dp->pixel_size, dp->w, pass);
4501

4502 4503 4504
               if (iDisplay >= 0)
                  deinterlace_row(store_image_row(ps, pp, iDisplay, y), display,
                     dp->pixel_size, dp->w, pass);
4505 4506 4507
            }
         }
         else
4508 4509 4510
            png_read_row(pp,
               iImage >= 0 ? store_image_row(ps, pp, iImage, y) : NULL,
               iDisplay >= 0 ? store_image_row(ps, pp, iDisplay, y) : NULL);
4511 4512 4513 4514 4515 4516 4517 4518 4519
      }
   }

   /* And finish the read operation (only really necessary if the caller wants
    * to find additional data in png_info from chunks after the last IDAT.)
    */
   png_read_end(pp, pi);
}

4520
static void
4521 4522
standard_row_validate(standard_display *dp, png_structp pp,
   int iImage, int iDisplay, png_uint_32 y)
4523
{
4524
   int where;
4525 4526
   png_byte std[STANDARD_ROWMAX];

4527 4528 4529 4530
   /* The row must be pre-initialized to the magic number here for the size
    * tests to pass:
    */
   memset(std, 178, sizeof std);
4531 4532 4533 4534 4535 4536
   standard_row(pp, std, dp->id, y);

   /* At the end both the 'row' and 'display' arrays should end up identical.
    * In earlier passes 'row' will be partially filled in, with only the pixels
    * that have been read so far, but 'display' will have those pixels
    * replicated to fill the unread pixels while reading an interlaced image.
4537
#if PNG_LIBPNG_VER < 10506
4538 4539 4540 4541 4542 4543
    * The side effect inside the libpng sequential reader is that the 'row'
    * array retains the correct values for unwritten pixels within the row
    * bytes, while the 'display' array gets bits off the end of the image (in
    * the last byte) trashed.  Unfortunately in the progressive reader the
    * row bytes are always trashed, so we always do a pixel_cmp here even though
    * a memcmp of all cbRow bytes will succeed for the sequential reader.
4544
#endif
4545
    */
4546 4547 4548
   if (iImage >= 0 &&
      (where = pixel_cmp(std, store_image_row(dp->ps, pp, iImage, y),
            dp->bit_width)) != 0)
4549 4550
   {
      char msg[64];
4551 4552 4553
      sprintf(msg, "PNG image row[%d][%d] changed from %.2x to %.2x", y,
         where-1, std[where-1],
         store_image_row(dp->ps, pp, iImage, y)[where-1]);
4554 4555 4556
      png_error(pp, msg);
   }

4557
#if PNG_LIBPNG_VER < 10506
4558 4559
   /* In this case use pixel_cmp because we need to compare a partial
    * byte at the end of the row if the row is not an exact multiple
4560 4561
    * of 8 bits wide.  (This is fixed in libpng-1.5.6 and pixel_cmp is
    * changed to match!)
4562
    */
4563
#endif
4564 4565 4566
   if (iDisplay >= 0 &&
      (where = pixel_cmp(std, store_image_row(dp->ps, pp, iDisplay, y),
         dp->bit_width)) != 0)
4567 4568
   {
      char msg[64];
4569 4570 4571
      sprintf(msg, "display  row[%d][%d] changed from %.2x to %.2x", y,
         where-1, std[where-1],
         store_image_row(dp->ps, pp, iDisplay, y)[where-1]);
4572 4573 4574 4575 4576
      png_error(pp, msg);
   }
}

static void
4577 4578
standard_image_validate(standard_display *dp, png_structp pp, int iImage,
    int iDisplay)
4579 4580 4581
{
   png_uint_32 y;

4582 4583
   if (iImage >= 0)
      store_image_check(dp->ps, pp, iImage);
4584

4585 4586
   if (iDisplay >= 0)
      store_image_check(dp->ps, pp, iDisplay);
4587

4588 4589
   for (y=0; y<dp->h; ++y)
      standard_row_validate(dp, pp, iImage, iDisplay, y);
4590 4591

   /* This avoids false positives if the validation code is never called! */
4592
   dp->ps->validated = 1;
4593 4594 4595 4596 4597
}

static void
standard_end(png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
{
4598 4599
   standard_display *dp = voidcast(standard_display*,
      png_get_progressive_ptr(pp));
4600

4601
   UNUSED(pi)
4602 4603 4604 4605

   /* Validate the image - progressive reading only produces one variant for
    * interlaced images.
    */
4606
   standard_image_validate(dp, pp, 0, -1);
4607 4608
}

4609
/* A single test run checking the standard image to ensure it is not damaged. */
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
4610
static void
4611
standard_test(png_store* PNG_CONST psIn, png_uint_32 PNG_CONST id,
4612
   int do_interlace, int use_update_info)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
4613
{
4614 4615 4616 4617 4618 4619
   standard_display d;
   context(psIn, fault);

   /* Set up the display (stack frame) variables from the arguments to the
    * function and initialize the locals that are filled in later.
    */
4620
   standard_display_init(&d, psIn, id, do_interlace, use_update_info);
4621

4622 4623 4624
   /* Everything is protected by a Try/Catch.  The functions called also
    * typically have local Try/Catch blocks.
    */
4625 4626
   Try
   {
4627 4628 4629
      png_structp pp;
      png_infop pi;

4630
      /* Get a png_struct for reading the image. This will throw an error if it
4631 4632
       * fails, so we don't need to check the result.
       */
4633
      pp = set_store_for_read(d.ps, &pi, d.id,
4634 4635 4636 4637
         d.do_interlace ?  (d.ps->progressive ?
            "pngvalid progressive deinterlacer" :
            "pngvalid sequential deinterlacer") : (d.ps->progressive ?
               "progressive reader" : "sequential reader"));
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
4638

4639 4640 4641
      /* Initialize the palette correctly from the png_store_file. */
      standard_palette_init(&d);

4642
      /* Introduce the correct read function. */
4643
      if (d.ps->progressive)
4644
      {
4645 4646
         png_set_progressive_read_fn(pp, &d, standard_info, progressive_row,
            standard_end);
4647

4648
         /* Now feed data into the reader until we reach the end: */
4649
         store_progressive_read(d.ps, pp, pi);
4650
      }
4651 4652
      else
      {
4653 4654
         /* Note that this takes the store, not the display. */
         png_set_read_fn(pp, d.ps, store_read);
4655

4656 4657
         /* Check the header values: */
         png_read_info(pp, pi);
4658

4659 4660 4661
         /* The code tests both versions of the images that the sequential
          * reader can produce.
          */
4662
         standard_info_imp(&d, pp, pi, 2 /*images*/);
4663

4664
         /* Need the total bytes in the image below; we can't get to this point
4665 4666 4667
          * unless the PNG file values have been checked against the expected
          * values.
          */
4668
         {
4669
            sequential_row(&d, pp, pi, 0, 1);
4670 4671 4672 4673

            /* After the last pass loop over the rows again to check that the
             * image is correct.
             */
4674 4675
            if (!d.speed)
               standard_image_validate(&d, pp, 0, 1);
4676 4677
            else
               d.ps->validated = 1;
4678
         }
4679
      }
4680

4681
      /* Check for validation. */
4682
      if (!d.ps->validated)
4683
         png_error(pp, "image read failed silently");
4684

4685
      /* Successful completion. */
4686
   }
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
4687

4688
   Catch(fault)
4689 4690 4691 4692
      d.ps = fault; /* make sure this hasn't been clobbered. */

   /* In either case clean up the store. */
   store_read_reset(d.ps);
4693
}
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
4694

4695 4696
static int
test_standard(png_modifier* PNG_CONST pm, png_byte PNG_CONST colour_type,
4697
    int bdlo, int PNG_CONST bdhi)
4698 4699 4700
{
   for (; bdlo <= bdhi; ++bdlo)
   {
4701
      int interlace_type;
4702

4703 4704 4705
      for (interlace_type = PNG_INTERLACE_NONE;
           interlace_type < PNG_INTERLACE_LAST; ++interlace_type)
      {
4706
         standard_test(&pm->this, FILEID(colour_type, DEPTH(bdlo), 0/*palette*/,
4707
            interlace_type, 0, 0, 0), 0/*do_interlace*/, pm->use_update_info);
4708 4709 4710 4711

         if (fail(pm))
            return 0;
      }
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
4712
   }
4713

4714
   return 1; /* keep going */
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
4715 4716 4717 4718 4719
}

static void
perform_standard_test(png_modifier *pm)
{
4720 4721 4722
   /* Test each colour type over the valid range of bit depths (expressed as
    * log2(bit_depth) in turn, stop as soon as any error is detected.
    */
4723
   if (!test_standard(pm, 0, 0, READ_BDHI))
4724 4725
      return;

4726
   if (!test_standard(pm, 2, 3, READ_BDHI))
4727 4728
      return;

4729
   if (!test_standard(pm, 3, 0, 3))
4730 4731
      return;

4732
   if (!test_standard(pm, 4, 3, READ_BDHI))
4733 4734
      return;

4735
   if (!test_standard(pm, 6, 3, READ_BDHI))
4736
      return;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
4737 4738 4739
}


4740 4741 4742 4743 4744 4745 4746 4747 4748 4749 4750 4751 4752 4753 4754 4755 4756 4757 4758 4759 4760 4761 4762 4763 4764
/********************************** SIZE TESTS ********************************/
static int
test_size(png_modifier* PNG_CONST pm, png_byte PNG_CONST colour_type,
    int bdlo, int PNG_CONST bdhi)
{
   /* Run the tests on each combination.
    *
    * NOTE: on my 32 bit x86 each of the following blocks takes
    * a total of 3.5 seconds if done across every combo of bit depth
    * width and height.  This is a waste of time in practice, hence the
    * hinc and winc stuff:
    */
   static PNG_CONST png_byte hinc[] = {1, 3, 11, 1, 5};
   static PNG_CONST png_byte winc[] = {1, 9, 5, 7, 1};
   for (; bdlo <= bdhi; ++bdlo)
   {
      png_uint_32 h, w;

      for (h=1; h<=16; h+=hinc[bdlo]) for (w=1; w<=16; w+=winc[bdlo])
      {
         /* First test all the 'size' images against the sequential
          * reader using libpng to deinterlace (where required.)  This
          * validates the write side of libpng.  There are four possibilities
          * to validate.
          */
4765
         standard_test(&pm->this, FILEID(colour_type, DEPTH(bdlo), 0/*palette*/,
4766 4767
            PNG_INTERLACE_NONE, w, h, 0), 0/*do_interlace*/,
            pm->use_update_info);
4768 4769 4770 4771

         if (fail(pm))
            return 0;

4772
         standard_test(&pm->this, FILEID(colour_type, DEPTH(bdlo), 0/*palette*/,
4773 4774
            PNG_INTERLACE_NONE, w, h, 1), 0/*do_interlace*/,
            pm->use_update_info);
4775 4776 4777 4778

         if (fail(pm))
            return 0;

4779
         standard_test(&pm->this, FILEID(colour_type, DEPTH(bdlo), 0/*palette*/,
4780 4781
            PNG_INTERLACE_ADAM7, w, h, 0), 0/*do_interlace*/,
            pm->use_update_info);
4782 4783 4784 4785

         if (fail(pm))
            return 0;

4786
         standard_test(&pm->this, FILEID(colour_type, DEPTH(bdlo), 0/*palette*/,
4787 4788
            PNG_INTERLACE_ADAM7, w, h, 1), 0/*do_interlace*/,
            pm->use_update_info);
4789 4790 4791 4792 4793 4794 4795 4796

         if (fail(pm))
            return 0;

         /* Now validate the interlaced read side - do_interlace true,
          * in the progressive case this does actually make a difference
          * to the code used in the non-interlaced case too.
          */
4797
         standard_test(&pm->this, FILEID(colour_type, DEPTH(bdlo), 0/*palette*/,
4798 4799
            PNG_INTERLACE_NONE, w, h, 0), 1/*do_interlace*/,
            pm->use_update_info);
4800 4801 4802 4803

         if (fail(pm))
            return 0;

4804
         standard_test(&pm->this, FILEID(colour_type, DEPTH(bdlo), 0/*palette*/,
4805 4806
            PNG_INTERLACE_ADAM7, w, h, 0), 1/*do_interlace*/,
            pm->use_update_info);
4807 4808 4809 4810 4811 4812 4813 4814 4815 4816 4817 4818 4819 4820 4821 4822 4823 4824 4825 4826 4827 4828

         if (fail(pm))
            return 0;
      }
   }

   return 1; /* keep going */
}

static void
perform_size_test(png_modifier *pm)
{
   /* Test each colour type over the valid range of bit depths (expressed as
    * log2(bit_depth) in turn, stop as soon as any error is detected.
    */
   if (!test_size(pm, 0, 0, READ_BDHI))
      return;

   if (!test_size(pm, 2, 3, READ_BDHI))
      return;

   /* For the moment don't do the palette test - it's a waste of time when
4829
    * compared to the grayscale test.
4830 4831 4832 4833 4834 4835 4836 4837 4838 4839 4840 4841 4842 4843
    */
#if 0
   if (!test_size(pm, 3, 0, 3))
      return;
#endif

   if (!test_size(pm, 4, 3, READ_BDHI))
      return;

   if (!test_size(pm, 6, 3, READ_BDHI))
      return;
}


4844
/******************************* TRANSFORM TESTS ******************************/
4845
#ifdef PNG_READ_TRANSFORMS_SUPPORTED
4846 4847 4848 4849 4850 4851
/* A set of tests to validate libpng image transforms.  The possibilities here
 * are legion because the transforms can be combined in a combinatorial
 * fashion.  To deal with this some measure of restraint is required, otherwise
 * the tests would take forever.
 */
typedef struct image_pixel
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
4852
{
4853 4854 4855 4856 4857 4858
   /* A local (pngvalid) representation of a PNG pixel, in all its
    * various forms.
    */
   unsigned int red, green, blue, alpha; /* For non-palette images. */
   unsigned int palette_index;           /* For a palette image. */
   png_byte colour_type;                 /* As in the spec. */
4859 4860
   png_byte bit_depth;                   /* Defines bit size in row */
   png_byte sample_depth;                /* Scale of samples */
4861 4862 4863 4864 4865 4866 4867 4868 4869 4870 4871 4872 4873
   int      have_tRNS;                   /* tRNS chunk may need processing */

   /* For checking the code calculates double precision floating point values
    * along with an error value, accumulated from the transforms.  Because an
    * sBIT setting allows larger error bounds (indeed, by the spec, apparently
    * up to just less than +/-1 in the scaled value) the *lowest* sBIT for each
    * channel is stored.  This sBIT value is folded in to the stored error value
    * at the end of the application of the transforms to the pixel.
    */
   double   redf, greenf, bluef, alphaf;
   double   rede, greene, bluee, alphae;
   png_byte red_sBIT, green_sBIT, blue_sBIT, alpha_sBIT;
} image_pixel;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
4874

4875 4876 4877
/* Shared utility function, see below. */
static void
image_pixel_setf(image_pixel *this, unsigned int max)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
4878
{
4879 4880 4881 4882 4883 4884 4885 4886 4887 4888 4889 4890 4891 4892 4893 4894 4895 4896 4897 4898 4899
   this->redf = this->red / (double)max;
   this->greenf = this->green / (double)max;
   this->bluef = this->blue / (double)max;
   this->alphaf = this->alpha / (double)max;

   if (this->red < max)
      this->rede = this->redf * DBL_EPSILON;
   else
      this->rede = 0;
   if (this->green < max)
      this->greene = this->greenf * DBL_EPSILON;
   else
      this->greene = 0;
   if (this->blue < max)
      this->bluee = this->bluef * DBL_EPSILON;
   else
      this->bluee = 0;
   if (this->alpha < max)
      this->alphae = this->alphaf * DBL_EPSILON;
   else
      this->alphae = 0;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
4900 4901
}

4902 4903 4904 4905
/* Initialize the structure for the next pixel - call this before doing any
 * transforms and call it for each pixel since all the fields may need to be
 * reset.
 */
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
4906
static void
4907
image_pixel_init(image_pixel *this, png_const_bytep row, png_byte colour_type,
4908
    png_byte bit_depth, png_uint_32 x, store_palette palette)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
4909
{
4910 4911 4912
   PNG_CONST png_byte sample_depth = (png_byte)(colour_type ==
      PNG_COLOR_TYPE_PALETTE ? 8 : bit_depth);
   PNG_CONST unsigned int max = (1U<<sample_depth)-1;
G
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
4913

4914 4915 4916 4917 4918 4919 4920 4921
   /* Initially just set everything to the same number and the alpha to opaque.
    * Note that this currently assumes a simple palette where entry x has colour
    * rgb(x,x,x)!
    */
   this->palette_index = this->red = this->green = this->blue =
      sample(row, colour_type, bit_depth, x, 0);
   this->alpha = max;
   this->red_sBIT = this->green_sBIT = this->blue_sBIT = this->alpha_sBIT =
4922 4923 4924 4925 4926 4927 4928 4929 4930
      sample_depth;

   /* Then override as appropriate: */
   if (colour_type == 3) /* palette */
   {
      /* This permits the caller to default to the sample value. */
      if (palette != 0)
      {
         PNG_CONST unsigned int i = this->palette_index;
4931

4932 4933 4934 4935 4936 4937 4938 4939
         this->red = palette[i].red;
         this->green = palette[i].green;
         this->blue = palette[i].blue;
         this->alpha = palette[i].alpha;
      }
   }

   else /* not palette */
4940
   {
4941 4942 4943 4944 4945 4946 4947 4948 4949 4950
      unsigned int i = 0;

      if (colour_type & 2)
      {
         this->green = sample(row, colour_type, bit_depth, x, 1);
         this->blue = sample(row, colour_type, bit_depth, x, 2);
         i = 2;
      }
      if (colour_type & 4)
         this->alpha = sample(row, colour_type, bit_depth, x, ++i);
4951
   }
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
4952

4953 4954 4955 4956 4957
   /* Calculate the scaled values, these are simply the values divided by
    * 'max' and the error is initialized to the double precision epsilon value
    * from the header file.
    */
   image_pixel_setf(this, max);
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
4958

4959 4960 4961 4962 4963
   /* Store the input information for use in the transforms - these will
    * modify the information.
    */
   this->colour_type = colour_type;
   this->bit_depth = bit_depth;
4964
   this->sample_depth = sample_depth;
4965
   this->have_tRNS = 0;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
4966 4967
}

4968
/* Convert a palette image to an rgb image.  This necessarily converts the tRNS
4969 4970 4971 4972 4973
 * chunk at the same time, because the tRNS will be in palette form.  The way
 * palette validation works means that the original palette is never updated,
 * instead the image_pixel value from the row contains the RGB of the
 * corresponding palette entry and *this* is updated.  Consequently this routine
 * only needs to change the colour type information.
4974
 */
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
4975
static void
4976
image_pixel_convert_PLTE(image_pixel *this)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
4977
{
4978
   if (this->colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_PALETTE)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
4979
   {
4980 4981 4982 4983 4984 4985 4986 4987
      if (this->have_tRNS)
      {
         this->colour_type = PNG_COLOR_TYPE_RGB_ALPHA;
         this->have_tRNS = 0;
      }
      else
         this->colour_type = PNG_COLOR_TYPE_RGB;

4988 4989
      /* The bit depth of the row changes at this point too (notice that this is
       * the row format, not the sample depth, which is separate.)
4990
       */
4991
      this->bit_depth = 8;
4992
   }
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
4993 4994
}

4995
/* Add an alpha channel; this will import the tRNS information because tRNS is
4996 4997 4998 4999
 * not valid in an alpha image.  The bit depth will invariably be set to at
 * least 8.  Palette images will be converted to alpha (using the above API).
 */
static void
5000
image_pixel_add_alpha(image_pixel *this, PNG_CONST standard_display *display)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
5001
{
5002
   if (this->colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_PALETTE)
5003
      image_pixel_convert_PLTE(this);
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
5004

5005
   if ((this->colour_type & PNG_COLOR_MASK_ALPHA) == 0)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
5006
   {
5007
      if (this->colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_GRAY)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
5008
      {
5009 5010
         if (this->bit_depth < 8)
            this->bit_depth = 8;
5011

5012 5013 5014
         if (this->have_tRNS)
         {
            this->have_tRNS = 0;
5015

5016 5017 5018 5019 5020 5021 5022 5023 5024 5025
            /* Check the input, original, channel value here against the
             * original tRNS gray chunk valie.
             */
            if (this->red == display->transparent.red)
               this->alphaf = 0;
            else
               this->alphaf = 1;
         }
         else
            this->alphaf = 1;
5026

5027
         this->colour_type = PNG_COLOR_TYPE_GRAY_ALPHA;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
5028 5029
      }

5030 5031 5032 5033 5034
      else if (this->colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_RGB)
      {
         if (this->have_tRNS)
         {
            this->have_tRNS = 0;
5035

5036 5037 5038 5039 5040 5041 5042 5043 5044
            /* Again, check the exact input values, not the current transformed
             * value!
             */
            if (this->red == display->transparent.red &&
               this->green == display->transparent.green &&
               this->blue == display->transparent.blue)
               this->alphaf = 0;
            else
               this->alphaf = 1;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
5045

5046 5047 5048 5049 5050 5051 5052 5053 5054
            this->colour_type = PNG_COLOR_TYPE_RGB_ALPHA;
         }
      }

      /* The error in the alpha is zero and the sBIT value comes from the
       * original sBIT data (actually it will always be the original bit depth).
       */
      this->alphae = 0;
      this->alpha_sBIT = display->alpha_sBIT;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
5055 5056 5057
   }
}

5058 5059
struct transform_display;
typedef struct image_transform
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
5060
{
5061 5062 5063 5064 5065 5066
   /* The name of this transform: a string. */
   PNG_CONST char *name;

   /* Each transform can be disabled from the command line: */
   int enable;

5067 5068
   /* The global list of transforms; read only. */
   struct image_transform *PNG_CONST list;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
5069

5070 5071 5072 5073 5074 5075 5076 5077 5078 5079 5080 5081 5082 5083 5084 5085
   /* The global count of the number of times this transform has been set on an
    * image.
    */
   unsigned int global_use;

   /* The local count of the number of times this transform has been set. */
   unsigned int local_use;

   /* The next transform in the list, each transform must call its own next
    * transform after it has processed the pixel successfully.
    */
   PNG_CONST struct image_transform *next;

   /* A single transform for the image, expressed as a series of function
    * callbacks and some space for values.
    *
5086 5087 5088 5089 5090 5091 5092
    * First a callback to add any required modifications to the png_modifier;
    * this gets called just before the modifier is set up for read.
    */
   void (*ini)(PNG_CONST struct image_transform *this,
      struct transform_display *that);

   /* And a callback to set the transform on the current png_read_struct:
5093 5094 5095 5096 5097 5098 5099 5100 5101 5102 5103 5104 5105 5106 5107 5108 5109 5110 5111
    */
   void (*set)(PNG_CONST struct image_transform *this,
      struct transform_display *that, png_structp pp, png_infop pi);

   /* Then a transform that takes an input pixel in one PNG format or another
    * and modifies it by a pngvalid implementation of the transform (thus
    * duplicating the libpng intent without, we hope, duplicating the bugs
    * in the libpng implementation!)  The png_structp is solely to allow error
    * reporting via png_error and png_warning.
    */
   void (*mod)(PNG_CONST struct image_transform *this, image_pixel *that,
      png_structp pp, PNG_CONST struct transform_display *display);

   /* Add this transform to the list and return true if the transform is
    * meaningful for this colour type and bit depth - if false then the
    * transform should have no effect on the image so there's not a lot of
    * point running it.
    */
   int (*add)(struct image_transform *this,
5112
      PNG_CONST struct image_transform **that, png_byte colour_type,
5113 5114 5115 5116
      png_byte bit_depth);
} image_transform;

typedef struct transform_display
5117 5118 5119 5120
{
   standard_display this;

   /* Parameters */
5121 5122
   png_modifier*              pm;
   PNG_CONST image_transform* transform_list;
5123 5124

   /* Local variables */
5125 5126
   png_byte output_colour_type;
   png_byte output_bit_depth;
5127

5128 5129 5130 5131
   /* Modifications (not necessarily used.) */
   gama_modification gama_mod;
   chrm_modification chrm_mod;
   srgb_modification srgb_mod;
5132
} transform_display;
5133

5134 5135 5136 5137 5138 5139 5140 5141 5142 5143 5144 5145 5146 5147 5148 5149 5150 5151 5152 5153 5154 5155 5156 5157 5158 5159 5160 5161 5162 5163 5164 5165 5166 5167 5168 5169
/* Set sRGB, cHRM and gAMA transforms as required by the current encoding. */
static void
transform_set_encoding(transform_display *this)
{
   /* Set up the png_modifier '_current' fields then use these to determine how
    * to add appropriate chunks.
    */
   png_modifier *pm = this->pm;

   modifier_set_encoding(pm);

   if (modifier_color_encoding_is_set(pm))
   {
      if (modifier_color_encoding_is_sRGB(pm))
         srgb_modification_init(&this->srgb_mod, pm, PNG_sRGB_INTENT_ABSOLUTE);

      else
      {
         /* Set gAMA and cHRM separately. */
         gama_modification_init(&this->gama_mod, pm, pm->current_gamma);

         if (pm->current_encoding != 0)
            chrm_modification_init(&this->chrm_mod, pm, pm->current_encoding);
      }
   }
}

/* Three functions to end the list: */
static void
image_transform_ini_end(PNG_CONST image_transform *this,
   transform_display *that)
{
   UNUSED(this)
   UNUSED(that)
}

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
5170
static void
5171 5172
image_transform_set_end(PNG_CONST image_transform *this,
   transform_display *that, png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
5173
{
5174 5175 5176 5177
   UNUSED(this)
   UNUSED(that)
   UNUSED(pp)
   UNUSED(pi)
5178
}
5179

5180 5181 5182 5183 5184 5185 5186 5187 5188 5189 5190 5191 5192 5193 5194 5195 5196 5197 5198 5199 5200
/* At the end of the list recalculate the output image pixel value from the
 * double precision values set up by the preceding 'mod' calls:
 */
static unsigned int
sample_scale(double sample_value, unsigned int scale)
{
   sample_value = floor(sample_value * scale + .5);

   /* Return NaN as 0: */
   if (!(sample_value > 0))
      sample_value = 0;
   else if (sample_value > scale)
      sample_value = scale;

   return (unsigned int)sample_value;
}

static void
image_transform_mod_end(PNG_CONST image_transform *this, image_pixel *that,
    png_structp pp, PNG_CONST transform_display *display)
{
5201
   PNG_CONST unsigned int scale = (1U<<that->sample_depth)-1;
5202

5203 5204 5205
   UNUSED(this)
   UNUSED(pp)
   UNUSED(display)
5206

5207 5208 5209 5210
   /* At the end recalculate the digitized red green and blue values according
    * to the current sample_depth of the pixel.
    *
    * The sample value is simply scaled to the maximum, checking for over
5211 5212 5213 5214 5215 5216 5217 5218 5219 5220
    * and underflow (which can both happen for some image transforms,
    * including simple size scaling, though libpng doesn't do that at present.
    */
   that->red = sample_scale(that->redf, scale);

   /* The error value is increased, at the end, according to the lowest sBIT
    * value seen.  Common sense tells us that the intermediate integer
    * representations are no more accurate than +/- 0.5 in the integral values,
    * the sBIT allows the implementation to be worse than this.  In addition the
    * PNG specification actually permits any error within the range (-1..+1),
5221 5222 5223 5224
    * but that is ignored here.  Instead the final digitized value is compared,
    * below to the digitized value of the error limits - this has the net effect
    * of allowing (almost) +/-1 in the output value.  It's difficult to see how
    * any algorithm that digitizes intermediate results can be more accurate.
5225 5226 5227 5228 5229 5230 5231 5232 5233 5234 5235 5236 5237 5238 5239 5240 5241
    */
   that->rede += 1./(2*((1U<<that->red_sBIT)-1));

   if (that->colour_type & PNG_COLOR_MASK_COLOR)
   {
      that->green = sample_scale(that->greenf, scale);
      that->blue = sample_scale(that->bluef, scale);
      that->greene += 1./(2*((1U<<that->green_sBIT)-1));
      that->bluee += 1./(2*((1U<<that->blue_sBIT)-1));
   }
   else
   {
      that->blue = that->green = that->red;
      that->bluef = that->greenf = that->redf;
      that->bluee = that->greene = that->rede;
   }

5242 5243
   if ((that->colour_type & PNG_COLOR_MASK_ALPHA) ||
      that->colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_PALETTE)
5244 5245 5246 5247 5248 5249 5250 5251 5252 5253 5254 5255 5256 5257 5258
   {
      that->alpha = sample_scale(that->alphaf, scale);
      that->alphae += 1./(2*((1U<<that->alpha_sBIT)-1));
   }
   else
   {
      that->alpha = scale; /* opaque */
      that->alpha = 1;     /* Override this. */
      that->alphae = 0;    /* It's exact ;-) */
   }
}

/* Static 'end' structure: */
static image_transform image_transform_end =
{
5259 5260
   "(end)", /* name */
   1, /* enable */
5261 5262 5263 5264
   0, /* list */
   0, /* global_use */
   0, /* local_use */
   0, /* next */
5265
   image_transform_ini_end,
5266 5267 5268 5269 5270 5271 5272 5273 5274 5275 5276 5277
   image_transform_set_end,
   image_transform_mod_end,
   0 /* never called, I want it to crash if it is! */
};

/* Reader callbacks and implementations, where they differ from the standard
 * ones.
 */
static void
transform_display_init(transform_display *dp, png_modifier *pm, png_uint_32 id,
    PNG_CONST image_transform *transform_list)
{
5278
   memset(dp, 0, sizeof *dp);
5279

5280
   /* Standard fields */
5281
   standard_display_init(&dp->this, &pm->this, id, 0/*do_interlace*/,
5282
      pm->use_update_info);
5283 5284 5285 5286 5287 5288 5289 5290 5291 5292 5293 5294 5295 5296 5297 5298 5299 5300 5301 5302

   /* Parameter fields */
   dp->pm = pm;
   dp->transform_list = transform_list;

   /* Local variable fields */
   dp->output_colour_type = 255; /* invalid */
   dp->output_bit_depth = 255;  /* invalid */
}

static void
transform_info_imp(transform_display *dp, png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
{
   /* Reuse the standard stuff as appropriate. */
   standard_info_part1(&dp->this, pp, pi);

   /* Now set the list of transforms. */
   dp->transform_list->set(dp->transform_list, dp, pp, pi);

   /* Update the info structure for these transforms: */
5303 5304 5305 5306 5307 5308 5309
   {
      int i = dp->this.use_update_info;
      /* Always do one call, even if use_update_info is 0. */
      do
         png_read_update_info(pp, pi);
      while (--i > 0);
   }
5310 5311 5312 5313 5314 5315 5316 5317 5318 5319 5320 5321 5322 5323 5324 5325 5326 5327 5328 5329 5330 5331 5332 5333 5334 5335 5336 5337 5338 5339 5340 5341 5342 5343 5344 5345 5346 5347 5348 5349 5350 5351 5352 5353 5354 5355 5356 5357 5358 5359

   /* And get the output information into the standard_display */
   standard_info_part2(&dp->this, pp, pi, 1/*images*/);

   /* Plus the extra stuff we need for the transform tests: */
   dp->output_colour_type = png_get_color_type(pp, pi);
   dp->output_bit_depth = png_get_bit_depth(pp, pi);

   /* Validate the combination of colour type and bit depth that we are getting
    * out of libpng; the semantics of something not in the PNG spec are, at
    * best, unclear.
    */
   switch (dp->output_colour_type)
   {
   case PNG_COLOR_TYPE_PALETTE:
      if (dp->output_bit_depth > 8) goto error;
      /*FALL THROUGH*/
   case PNG_COLOR_TYPE_GRAY:
      if (dp->output_bit_depth == 1 || dp->output_bit_depth == 2 ||
         dp->output_bit_depth == 4)
         break;
      /*FALL THROUGH*/
   default:
      if (dp->output_bit_depth == 8 || dp->output_bit_depth == 16)
         break;
      /*FALL THROUGH*/
   error:
      {
         char message[128];
         size_t pos;

         pos = safecat(message, sizeof message, 0,
            "invalid final bit depth: colour type(");
         pos = safecatn(message, sizeof message, pos, dp->output_colour_type);
         pos = safecat(message, sizeof message, pos, ") with bit depth: ");
         pos = safecatn(message, sizeof message, pos, dp->output_bit_depth);

         png_error(pp, message);
      }
   }

   /* Use a test pixel to check that the output agrees with what we expect -
    * this avoids running the whole test if the output is unexpected.
    */
   {
      image_pixel test_pixel;

      memset(&test_pixel, 0, sizeof test_pixel);
      test_pixel.colour_type = dp->this.colour_type; /* input */
      test_pixel.bit_depth = dp->this.bit_depth;
5360 5361 5362 5363
      if (test_pixel.colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_PALETTE)
         test_pixel.sample_depth = 8;
      else
         test_pixel.sample_depth = test_pixel.bit_depth;
5364 5365 5366
      /* Don't need sBIT here, but it must be set to non-zero to avoid
       * arithmetic overflows.
       */
5367
      test_pixel.have_tRNS = dp->this.is_transparent;
5368 5369
      test_pixel.red_sBIT = test_pixel.green_sBIT = test_pixel.blue_sBIT =
         test_pixel.alpha_sBIT = test_pixel.sample_depth;
5370 5371 5372 5373 5374 5375 5376 5377 5378 5379 5380 5381 5382 5383 5384 5385 5386 5387 5388 5389 5390 5391 5392 5393 5394 5395

      dp->transform_list->mod(dp->transform_list, &test_pixel, pp, dp);

      if (test_pixel.colour_type != dp->output_colour_type)
      {
         char message[128];
         size_t pos = safecat(message, sizeof message, 0, "colour type ");

         pos = safecatn(message, sizeof message, pos, dp->output_colour_type);
         pos = safecat(message, sizeof message, pos, " expected ");
         pos = safecatn(message, sizeof message, pos, test_pixel.colour_type);

         png_error(pp, message);
      }

      if (test_pixel.bit_depth != dp->output_bit_depth)
      {
         char message[128];
         size_t pos = safecat(message, sizeof message, 0, "bit depth ");

         pos = safecatn(message, sizeof message, pos, dp->output_bit_depth);
         pos = safecat(message, sizeof message, pos, " expected ");
         pos = safecatn(message, sizeof message, pos, test_pixel.bit_depth);

         png_error(pp, message);
      }
5396 5397 5398 5399 5400 5401 5402 5403 5404 5405 5406 5407 5408 5409 5410 5411 5412 5413 5414 5415 5416

      /* If both bit depth and colour type are correct check the sample depth.
       * I believe these are both internal errors.
       */
      if (test_pixel.colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_PALETTE)
      {
         if (test_pixel.sample_depth != 8) /* oops - internal error! */
            png_error(pp, "pngvalid: internal: palette sample depth not 8");
      }
      else if (test_pixel.sample_depth != dp->output_bit_depth)
      {
         char message[128];
         size_t pos = safecat(message, sizeof message, 0,
            "internal: sample depth ");

         pos = safecatn(message, sizeof message, pos, dp->output_bit_depth);
         pos = safecat(message, sizeof message, pos, " expected ");
         pos = safecatn(message, sizeof message, pos, test_pixel.sample_depth);

         png_error(pp, message);
      }
5417 5418 5419 5420 5421 5422
   }
}

static void
transform_info(png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
{
5423 5424
   transform_info_imp(voidcast(transform_display*, png_get_progressive_ptr(pp)),
      pp, pi);
5425 5426 5427
}

static void
5428 5429
transform_range_check(png_structp pp, unsigned int r, unsigned int g,
   unsigned int b, unsigned int a, unsigned int in_digitized, double in,
5430 5431
   unsigned int out, png_byte sample_depth, double err, double limit,
   PNG_CONST char *name, double digitization_error)
5432 5433 5434 5435
{
   /* Compare the scaled, digitzed, values of our local calculation (in+-err)
    * with the digitized values libpng produced;  'sample_depth' is the actual
    * digitization depth of the libpng output colors (the bit depth except for
5436
    * palette images where it is always 8.)  The check on 'err' is to detect
5437
    * internal errors in pngvalid itself.
5438 5439
    */
   unsigned int max = (1U<<sample_depth)-1;
5440 5441
   double in_min = ceil((in-err)*max - digitization_error);
   double in_max = floor((in+err)*max + digitization_error);
5442
   if (err > limit || !(out >= in_min && out <= in_max))
5443
   {
5444
      char message[256];
5445 5446 5447
      size_t pos;

      pos = safecat(message, sizeof message, 0, name);
5448 5449 5450 5451 5452 5453 5454 5455 5456 5457
      pos = safecat(message, sizeof message, pos, " output value error: rgba(");
      pos = safecatn(message, sizeof message, pos, r);
      pos = safecat(message, sizeof message, pos, ",");
      pos = safecatn(message, sizeof message, pos, g);
      pos = safecat(message, sizeof message, pos, ",");
      pos = safecatn(message, sizeof message, pos, b);
      pos = safecat(message, sizeof message, pos, ",");
      pos = safecatn(message, sizeof message, pos, a);
      pos = safecat(message, sizeof message, pos, "): ");
      pos = safecatn(message, sizeof message, pos, out);
5458
      pos = safecat(message, sizeof message, pos, " expected: ");
5459 5460 5461
      pos = safecatn(message, sizeof message, pos, in_digitized);
      pos = safecat(message, sizeof message, pos, " (");
      pos = safecatd(message, sizeof message, pos, (in-err)*max, 3);
5462
      pos = safecat(message, sizeof message, pos, "..");
5463 5464
      pos = safecatd(message, sizeof message, pos, (in+err)*max, 3);
      pos = safecat(message, sizeof message, pos, ")");
5465 5466 5467 5468 5469 5470

      png_error(pp, message);
   }
}

static void
5471
transform_image_validate(transform_display *dp, png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
5472 5473
{
   /* Constants for the loop below: */
5474
   PNG_CONST png_store* PNG_CONST ps = dp->this.ps;
5475 5476 5477 5478 5479 5480
   PNG_CONST png_byte in_ct = dp->this.colour_type;
   PNG_CONST png_byte in_bd = dp->this.bit_depth;
   PNG_CONST png_uint_32 w = dp->this.w;
   PNG_CONST png_uint_32 h = dp->this.h;
   PNG_CONST png_byte out_ct = dp->output_colour_type;
   PNG_CONST png_byte out_bd = dp->output_bit_depth;
5481 5482
   PNG_CONST png_byte sample_depth = (png_byte)(out_ct ==
      PNG_COLOR_TYPE_PALETTE ? 8 : out_bd);
5483 5484 5485 5486 5487
   PNG_CONST png_byte red_sBIT = dp->this.red_sBIT;
   PNG_CONST png_byte green_sBIT = dp->this.green_sBIT;
   PNG_CONST png_byte blue_sBIT = dp->this.blue_sBIT;
   PNG_CONST png_byte alpha_sBIT = dp->this.alpha_sBIT;
   PNG_CONST int have_tRNS = dp->this.is_transparent;
5488
   double digitization_error;
5489

5490
   store_palette out_palette;
5491 5492
   png_uint_32 y;

5493 5494
   UNUSED(pi)

5495 5496 5497
   /* Check for row overwrite errors */
   store_image_check(dp->this.ps, pp, 0);

5498 5499 5500 5501
   /* Read the palette corresponding to the output if the output colour type
    * indicates a palette, othewise set out_palette to garbage.
    */
   if (out_ct == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_PALETTE)
5502 5503 5504 5505 5506 5507 5508 5509 5510
   {
      /* Validate that the palette count itself has not changed - this is not
       * expected.
       */
      int npalette = (-1);

      (void)read_palette(out_palette, &npalette, pp, pi);
      if (npalette != dp->this.npalette)
         png_error(pp, "unexpected change in palette size");
5511 5512

      digitization_error = .5;
5513
   }
5514
   else
5515 5516 5517
   {
      png_byte in_sample_depth;

5518 5519
      memset(out_palette, 0x5e, sizeof out_palette);

5520 5521 5522 5523 5524 5525 5526 5527 5528 5529 5530 5531 5532 5533 5534 5535 5536 5537 5538 5539 5540 5541
      /* assume-8-bit-calculations means assume that if the input has 8 bit
       * (or less) samples and the output has 16 bit samples the calculations
       * will be done with 8 bit precision, not 16.
       *
       * TODO: fix this in libpng; png_set_expand_16 should cause 16 bit
       * calculations to be used throughout.
       */
      if (in_ct == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_PALETTE || in_bd < 16)
         in_sample_depth = 8;
      else
         in_sample_depth = in_bd;

      if (sample_depth != 16 || in_sample_depth > 8 ||
         !dp->pm->calculations_use_input_precision)
         digitization_error = .5;

      /* Else errors are at 8 bit precision, scale .5 in 8 bits to the 16 bits:
       */
      else
         digitization_error = .5 * 257;
   }

5542
   for (y=0; y<h; ++y)
5543
   {
5544
      png_const_bytep PNG_CONST pRow = store_image_row(ps, pp, 0, y);
5545 5546 5547 5548 5549 5550 5551 5552 5553 5554 5555 5556 5557
      png_uint_32 x;

      /* The original, standard, row pre-transforms. */
      png_byte std[STANDARD_ROWMAX];

      transform_row(pp, std, in_ct, in_bd, y);

      /* Go through each original pixel transforming it and comparing with what
       * libpng did to the same pixel.
       */
      for (x=0; x<w; ++x)
      {
         image_pixel in_pixel, out_pixel;
5558
         unsigned int r, g, b, a;
5559 5560

         /* Find out what we think the pixel should be: */
5561 5562
         image_pixel_init(&in_pixel, std, in_ct, in_bd, x, dp->this.palette);

5563 5564 5565 5566 5567 5568
         in_pixel.red_sBIT = red_sBIT;
         in_pixel.green_sBIT = green_sBIT;
         in_pixel.blue_sBIT = blue_sBIT;
         in_pixel.alpha_sBIT = alpha_sBIT;
         in_pixel.have_tRNS = have_tRNS;

5569 5570 5571 5572 5573 5574
         /* For error detection, below. */
         r = in_pixel.red;
         g = in_pixel.green;
         b = in_pixel.blue;
         a = in_pixel.alpha;

5575 5576 5577
         dp->transform_list->mod(dp->transform_list, &in_pixel, pp, dp);

         /* Read the output pixel and compare it to what we got, we don't
5578
          * use the error field here, so no need to update sBIT.
5579
          */
5580
         image_pixel_init(&out_pixel, pRow, out_ct, out_bd, x, out_palette);
5581

5582 5583 5584 5585 5586
         /* We don't expect changes to the index here even if the bit depth is
          * changed.
          */
         if (in_ct == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_PALETTE &&
            out_ct == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_PALETTE)
5587 5588 5589 5590 5591
         {
            if (in_pixel.palette_index != out_pixel.palette_index)
               png_error(pp, "unexpected transformed palette index");
         }

5592 5593 5594 5595 5596
         /* Check the colours for palette images too - in fact the palette could
          * be separately verified itself in most cases.
          */
         if (in_pixel.red != out_pixel.red)
            transform_range_check(pp, r, g, b, a, in_pixel.red, in_pixel.redf,
5597 5598
               out_pixel.red, sample_depth, in_pixel.rede,
               dp->pm->limit + 1./(2*((1U<<in_pixel.red_sBIT)-1)), "red/gray",
5599
               digitization_error);
5600 5601 5602 5603 5604

         if ((out_ct & PNG_COLOR_MASK_COLOR) != 0 &&
            in_pixel.green != out_pixel.green)
            transform_range_check(pp, r, g, b, a, in_pixel.green,
               in_pixel.greenf, out_pixel.green, sample_depth, in_pixel.greene,
5605 5606
               dp->pm->limit + 1./(2*((1U<<in_pixel.green_sBIT)-1)), "green",
               digitization_error);
5607 5608 5609 5610

         if ((out_ct & PNG_COLOR_MASK_COLOR) != 0 &&
            in_pixel.blue != out_pixel.blue)
            transform_range_check(pp, r, g, b, a, in_pixel.blue, in_pixel.bluef,
5611 5612
               out_pixel.blue, sample_depth, in_pixel.bluee,
               dp->pm->limit + 1./(2*((1U<<in_pixel.blue_sBIT)-1)), "blue",
5613
               digitization_error);
5614 5615 5616 5617 5618

         if ((out_ct & PNG_COLOR_MASK_ALPHA) != 0 &&
            in_pixel.alpha != out_pixel.alpha)
            transform_range_check(pp, r, g, b, a, in_pixel.alpha,
               in_pixel.alphaf, out_pixel.alpha, sample_depth, in_pixel.alphae,
5619 5620
               dp->pm->limit + 1./(2*((1U<<in_pixel.alpha_sBIT)-1)), "alpha",
               digitization_error);
5621 5622 5623 5624 5625 5626 5627 5628 5629 5630
      } /* pixel (x) loop */
   } /* row (y) loop */

   /* Record that something was actually checked to avoid a false positive. */
   dp->this.ps->validated = 1;
}

static void
transform_end(png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
{
5631 5632
   transform_display *dp = voidcast(transform_display*,
      png_get_progressive_ptr(pp));
5633

5634 5635 5636 5637
   if (!dp->this.speed)
      transform_image_validate(dp, pp, pi);
   else
      dp->this.ps->validated = 1;
5638 5639 5640 5641 5642
}

/* A single test run. */
static void
transform_test(png_modifier *pmIn, PNG_CONST png_uint_32 idIn,
5643
    PNG_CONST image_transform* transform_listIn, PNG_CONST char * volatile name)
5644 5645 5646 5647 5648 5649 5650 5651
{
   transform_display d;
   context(&pmIn->this, fault);

   transform_display_init(&d, pmIn, idIn, transform_listIn);

   Try
   {
5652
      size_t pos = 0;
5653 5654
      png_structp pp;
      png_infop pi;
5655 5656 5657 5658 5659 5660 5661 5662 5663 5664 5665 5666 5667
      char full_name[256];

      /* Make sure the encoding fields are correct and enter the required
       * modifications.
       */
      transform_set_encoding(&d);

      /* Add any modifications required by the transform list. */
      d.transform_list->ini(d.transform_list, &d);

      /* Add the color space information, if any, to the name. */
      pos = safecat(full_name, sizeof full_name, pos, name);
      pos = safecat_current_encoding(full_name, sizeof full_name, pos, d.pm);
5668

5669
      /* Get a png_struct for reading the image. */
5670
      pp = set_modifier_for_read(d.pm, &pi, d.this.id, full_name);
5671
      standard_palette_init(&d.this);
5672

5673 5674 5675 5676 5677 5678 5679 5680 5681 5682 5683 5684
#     if 0
         /* Logging (debugging only) */
         {
            char buffer[256];

            (void)store_message(&d.pm->this, pp, buffer, sizeof buffer, 0,
               "running test");

            fprintf(stderr, "%s\n", buffer);
         }
#     endif

5685 5686 5687 5688 5689 5690 5691 5692 5693 5694 5695 5696 5697 5698 5699 5700 5701 5702 5703 5704 5705
      /* Introduce the correct read function. */
      if (d.pm->this.progressive)
      {
         /* Share the row function with the standard implementation. */
         png_set_progressive_read_fn(pp, &d, transform_info, progressive_row,
            transform_end);

         /* Now feed data into the reader until we reach the end: */
         modifier_progressive_read(d.pm, pp, pi);
      }
      else
      {
         /* modifier_read expects a png_modifier* */
         png_set_read_fn(pp, d.pm, modifier_read);

         /* Check the header values: */
         png_read_info(pp, pi);

         /* Process the 'info' requirements. Only one image is generated */
         transform_info_imp(&d, pp, pi);

5706
         sequential_row(&d.this, pp, pi, -1, 0);
5707

5708 5709
         if (!d.this.speed)
            transform_image_validate(&d, pp, pi);
5710 5711
         else
            d.this.ps->validated = 1;
5712 5713 5714 5715 5716 5717
      }

      modifier_reset(d.pm);
   }

   Catch(fault)
5718
   {
5719
      modifier_reset((png_modifier*)fault);
5720
   }
5721 5722 5723 5724
}

/* The transforms: */
#define ITSTRUCT(name) image_transform_##name
5725 5726
#define ITDATA(name) image_transform_data_##name
#define image_transform_ini image_transform_default_ini
5727
#define IT(name)\
5728 5729
static image_transform ITSTRUCT(name) =\
{\
5730 5731
   #name,\
   1, /*enable*/\
5732
   &PT, /*list*/\
5733 5734 5735
   0, /*global_use*/\
   0, /*local_use*/\
   0, /*next*/\
5736
   image_transform_ini,\
5737 5738 5739 5740
   image_transform_png_set_##name##_set,\
   image_transform_png_set_##name##_mod,\
   image_transform_png_set_##name##_add\
}
5741
#define PT ITSTRUCT(end) /* stores the previous transform */
5742

5743
/* To save code: */
5744 5745 5746 5747 5748 5749 5750
static void
image_transform_default_ini(PNG_CONST image_transform *this,
    transform_display *that)
{
   this->next->ini(this->next, that);
}

5751
static int
5752 5753
image_transform_default_add(image_transform *this,
    PNG_CONST image_transform **that, png_byte colour_type, png_byte bit_depth)
5754
{
5755 5756 5757
   UNUSED(colour_type)
   UNUSED(bit_depth)

5758 5759 5760
   this->next = *that;
   *that = this;

5761
   return 1;
5762 5763
}

5764
#ifdef PNG_READ_EXPAND_SUPPORTED
5765 5766 5767 5768 5769 5770 5771 5772 5773 5774 5775 5776 5777 5778
/* png_set_palette_to_rgb */
static void
image_transform_png_set_palette_to_rgb_set(PNG_CONST image_transform *this,
    transform_display *that, png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
{
   png_set_palette_to_rgb(pp);
   this->next->set(this->next, that, pp, pi);
}

static void
image_transform_png_set_palette_to_rgb_mod(PNG_CONST image_transform *this,
    image_pixel *that, png_structp pp, PNG_CONST transform_display *display)
{
   if (that->colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_PALETTE)
5779
      image_pixel_convert_PLTE(that);
5780 5781 5782 5783 5784 5785

   this->next->mod(this->next, that, pp, display);
}

static int
image_transform_png_set_palette_to_rgb_add(image_transform *this,
5786
    PNG_CONST image_transform **that, png_byte colour_type, png_byte bit_depth)
5787
{
5788
   UNUSED(bit_depth)
5789 5790 5791 5792 5793 5794 5795

   this->next = *that;
   *that = this;

   return colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_PALETTE;
}

5796 5797 5798 5799
IT(palette_to_rgb);
#undef PT
#define PT ITSTRUCT(palette_to_rgb)
#endif /* PNG_READ_EXPAND_SUPPORTED */
5800

5801
#ifdef PNG_READ_EXPAND_SUPPORTED
5802 5803 5804 5805 5806 5807 5808 5809 5810 5811 5812 5813 5814
/* png_set_tRNS_to_alpha */
static void
image_transform_png_set_tRNS_to_alpha_set(PNG_CONST image_transform *this,
   transform_display *that, png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
{
   png_set_tRNS_to_alpha(pp);
   this->next->set(this->next, that, pp, pi);
}

static void
image_transform_png_set_tRNS_to_alpha_mod(PNG_CONST image_transform *this,
   image_pixel *that, png_structp pp, PNG_CONST transform_display *display)
{
5815 5816
   /* LIBPNG BUG: this always forces palette images to RGB. */
   if (that->colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_PALETTE)
5817
      image_pixel_convert_PLTE(that);
5818

5819
   /* This effectively does an 'expand' only if there is some transparency to
5820
    * convert to an alpha channel.
5821 5822 5823 5824 5825
    */
   if (that->have_tRNS)
      image_pixel_add_alpha(that, &display->this);

   /* LIBPNG BUG: otherwise libpng still expands to 8 bits! */
5826 5827 5828 5829 5830 5831 5832
   else
   {
      if (that->bit_depth < 8)
         that->bit_depth =8;
      if (that->sample_depth < 8)
         that->sample_depth = 8;
   }
5833 5834 5835 5836 5837 5838

   this->next->mod(this->next, that, pp, display);
}

static int
image_transform_png_set_tRNS_to_alpha_add(image_transform *this,
5839
    PNG_CONST image_transform **that, png_byte colour_type, png_byte bit_depth)
5840
{
5841
   UNUSED(bit_depth)
5842 5843 5844 5845 5846 5847 5848 5849 5850 5851 5852

   this->next = *that;
   *that = this;

   /* We don't know yet whether there will be a tRNS chunk, but we know that
    * this transformation should do nothing if there already is an alpha
    * channel.
    */
   return (colour_type & PNG_COLOR_MASK_ALPHA) == 0;
}

5853 5854 5855 5856
IT(tRNS_to_alpha);
#undef PT
#define PT ITSTRUCT(tRNS_to_alpha)
#endif /* PNG_READ_EXPAND_SUPPORTED */
5857

5858
#ifdef PNG_READ_GRAY_TO_RGB_SUPPORTED
5859 5860 5861 5862 5863 5864 5865 5866 5867 5868 5869 5870 5871 5872 5873 5874 5875 5876 5877 5878 5879 5880 5881 5882 5883 5884
/* png_set_gray_to_rgb */
static void
image_transform_png_set_gray_to_rgb_set(PNG_CONST image_transform *this,
    transform_display *that, png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
{
   png_set_gray_to_rgb(pp);
   this->next->set(this->next, that, pp, pi);
}

static void
image_transform_png_set_gray_to_rgb_mod(PNG_CONST image_transform *this,
    image_pixel *that, png_structp pp, PNG_CONST transform_display *display)
{
   /* NOTE: we can actually pend the tRNS processing at this point because we
    * can correctly recognize the original pixel value even though we have
    * mapped the one gray channel to the three RGB ones, but in fact libpng
    * doesn't do this, so we don't either.
    */
   if ((that->colour_type & PNG_COLOR_MASK_COLOR) == 0 && that->have_tRNS)
      image_pixel_add_alpha(that, &display->this);

   /* Simply expand the bit depth and alter the colour type as required. */
   if (that->colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_GRAY)
   {
      /* RGB images have a bit depth at least equal to '8' */
      if (that->bit_depth < 8)
5885
         that->sample_depth = that->bit_depth = 8;
5886 5887 5888 5889 5890 5891 5892 5893 5894 5895 5896 5897 5898 5899 5900

      /* And just changing the colour type works here because the green and blue
       * channels are being maintained in lock-step with the red/gray:
       */
      that->colour_type = PNG_COLOR_TYPE_RGB;
   }

   else if (that->colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_GRAY_ALPHA)
      that->colour_type = PNG_COLOR_TYPE_RGB_ALPHA;

   this->next->mod(this->next, that, pp, display);
}

static int
image_transform_png_set_gray_to_rgb_add(image_transform *this,
5901
    PNG_CONST image_transform **that, png_byte colour_type, png_byte bit_depth)
5902
{
5903
   UNUSED(bit_depth)
5904 5905 5906 5907 5908 5909 5910

   this->next = *that;
   *that = this;

   return (colour_type & PNG_COLOR_MASK_COLOR) == 0;
}

5911 5912 5913 5914
IT(gray_to_rgb);
#undef PT
#define PT ITSTRUCT(gray_to_rgb)
#endif /* PNG_READ_GRAY_TO_RGB_SUPPORTED */
5915

5916
#ifdef PNG_READ_EXPAND_SUPPORTED
5917 5918 5919 5920 5921 5922 5923 5924 5925 5926 5927 5928 5929 5930 5931
/* png_set_expand */
static void
image_transform_png_set_expand_set(PNG_CONST image_transform *this,
    transform_display *that, png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
{
   png_set_expand(pp);
   this->next->set(this->next, that, pp, pi);
}

static void
image_transform_png_set_expand_mod(PNG_CONST image_transform *this,
    image_pixel *that, png_structp pp, PNG_CONST transform_display *display)
{
   /* The general expand case depends on what the colour type is: */
   if (that->colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_PALETTE)
5932
      image_pixel_convert_PLTE(that);
5933 5934
   else if (that->bit_depth < 8) /* grayscale */
      that->sample_depth = that->bit_depth = 8;
5935 5936 5937 5938 5939 5940 5941 5942 5943

   if (that->have_tRNS)
      image_pixel_add_alpha(that, &display->this);

   this->next->mod(this->next, that, pp, display);
}

static int
image_transform_png_set_expand_add(image_transform *this,
5944
    PNG_CONST image_transform **that, png_byte colour_type, png_byte bit_depth)
5945
{
5946
   UNUSED(bit_depth)
5947 5948 5949 5950 5951 5952 5953 5954 5955 5956

   this->next = *that;
   *that = this;

   /* 'expand' should do nothing for RGBA or GA input - no tRNS and the bit
    * depth is at least 8 already.
    */
   return (colour_type & PNG_COLOR_MASK_ALPHA) == 0;
}

5957 5958 5959 5960
IT(expand);
#undef PT
#define PT ITSTRUCT(expand)
#endif /* PNG_READ_EXPAND_SUPPORTED */
5961

5962
#ifdef PNG_READ_EXPAND_SUPPORTED
5963 5964 5965 5966 5967 5968 5969 5970 5971 5972 5973 5974 5975 5976 5977 5978 5979 5980 5981 5982 5983 5984 5985 5986 5987 5988 5989 5990
/* png_set_expand_gray_1_2_4_to_8
 * LIBPNG BUG: this just does an 'expand'
 */
static void
image_transform_png_set_expand_gray_1_2_4_to_8_set(
    PNG_CONST image_transform *this, transform_display *that, png_structp pp,
    png_infop pi)
{
   png_set_expand_gray_1_2_4_to_8(pp);
   this->next->set(this->next, that, pp, pi);
}

static void
image_transform_png_set_expand_gray_1_2_4_to_8_mod(
    PNG_CONST image_transform *this, image_pixel *that, png_structp pp,
    PNG_CONST transform_display *display)
{
   image_transform_png_set_expand_mod(this, that, pp, display);
}

static int
image_transform_png_set_expand_gray_1_2_4_to_8_add(image_transform *this,
    PNG_CONST image_transform **that, png_byte colour_type, png_byte bit_depth)
{
   return image_transform_png_set_expand_add(this, that, colour_type,
      bit_depth);
}

5991 5992 5993 5994 5995 5996
IT(expand_gray_1_2_4_to_8);
#undef PT
#define PT ITSTRUCT(expand_gray_1_2_4_to_8)
#endif /* PNG_READ_EXPAND_SUPPORTED */

#ifdef PNG_READ_EXPAND_16_SUPPORTED
5997 5998 5999 6000 6001 6002 6003 6004 6005 6006 6007 6008 6009 6010 6011 6012 6013
/* png_set_expand_16 */
static void
image_transform_png_set_expand_16_set(PNG_CONST image_transform *this,
    transform_display *that, png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
{
   png_set_expand_16(pp);
   this->next->set(this->next, that, pp, pi);
}

static void
image_transform_png_set_expand_16_mod(PNG_CONST image_transform *this,
    image_pixel *that, png_structp pp, PNG_CONST transform_display *display)
{
   /* Expect expand_16 to expand everything to 16 bits as a result of also
    * causing 'expand' to happen.
    */
   if (that->colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_PALETTE)
6014
      image_pixel_convert_PLTE(that);
6015 6016 6017 6018 6019 6020 6021 6022 6023 6024 6025 6026 6027 6028 6029 6030 6031 6032 6033 6034 6035 6036 6037

   if (that->have_tRNS)
      image_pixel_add_alpha(that, &display->this);

   if (that->bit_depth < 16)
      that->sample_depth = that->bit_depth = 16;

   this->next->mod(this->next, that, pp, display);
}

static int
image_transform_png_set_expand_16_add(image_transform *this,
    PNG_CONST image_transform **that, png_byte colour_type, png_byte bit_depth)
{
   UNUSED(colour_type)

   this->next = *that;
   *that = this;

   /* expand_16 does something unless the bit depth is already 16. */
   return bit_depth < 16;
}

6038 6039 6040 6041
IT(expand_16);
#undef PT
#define PT ITSTRUCT(expand_16)
#endif /* PNG_READ_EXPAND_16_SUPPORTED */
6042

6043
#ifdef PNG_READ_SCALE_16_TO_8_SUPPORTED  /* API added in 1.5.4 */
6044
/* png_set_scale_16 */
6045
static void
6046
image_transform_png_set_scale_16_set(PNG_CONST image_transform *this,
6047 6048
    transform_display *that, png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
{
6049
   png_set_scale_16(pp);
6050 6051 6052 6053
   this->next->set(this->next, that, pp, pi);
}

static void
6054
image_transform_png_set_scale_16_mod(PNG_CONST image_transform *this,
6055 6056 6057 6058
    image_pixel *that, png_structp pp, PNG_CONST transform_display *display)
{
   if (that->bit_depth == 16)
   {
6059
      that->sample_depth = that->bit_depth = 8;
6060 6061 6062 6063 6064 6065 6066 6067 6068 6069
      if (that->red_sBIT > 8) that->red_sBIT = 8;
      if (that->green_sBIT > 8) that->green_sBIT = 8;
      if (that->blue_sBIT > 8) that->blue_sBIT = 8;
      if (that->alpha_sBIT > 8) that->alpha_sBIT = 8;
   }

   this->next->mod(this->next, that, pp, display);
}

static int
6070
image_transform_png_set_scale_16_add(image_transform *this,
6071
    PNG_CONST image_transform **that, png_byte colour_type, png_byte bit_depth)
6072
{
6073
   UNUSED(colour_type)
6074 6075 6076 6077 6078 6079 6080

   this->next = *that;
   *that = this;

   return bit_depth > 8;
}

6081
IT(scale_16);
6082
#undef PT
6083
#define PT ITSTRUCT(scale_16)
6084
#endif /* PNG_READ_SCALE_16_TO_8_SUPPORTED (1.5.4 on) */
6085

6086
#ifdef PNG_READ_16_TO_8_SUPPORTED /* the default before 1.5.4 */
6087
/* png_set_strip_16 */
6088
static void
6089
image_transform_png_set_strip_16_set(PNG_CONST image_transform *this,
6090 6091
    transform_display *that, png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
{
6092
   png_set_strip_16(pp);
6093 6094 6095 6096
   this->next->set(this->next, that, pp, pi);
}

static void
6097
image_transform_png_set_strip_16_mod(PNG_CONST image_transform *this,
6098 6099 6100 6101 6102 6103 6104 6105 6106 6107
    image_pixel *that, png_structp pp, PNG_CONST transform_display *display)
{
   if (that->bit_depth == 16)
   {
      that->sample_depth = that->bit_depth = 8;
      if (that->red_sBIT > 8) that->red_sBIT = 8;
      if (that->green_sBIT > 8) that->green_sBIT = 8;
      if (that->blue_sBIT > 8) that->blue_sBIT = 8;
      if (that->alpha_sBIT > 8) that->alpha_sBIT = 8;

6108 6109 6110
      /* Prior to 1.5.4 png_set_strip_16 would use an 'accurate' method if this
       * configuration option is set.  From 1.5.4 the flag is never set and the
       * 'scale' API (above) must be used.
6111
       */
6112 6113 6114 6115 6116 6117 6118 6119 6120 6121 6122 6123 6124 6125 6126 6127 6128 6129
#     ifdef PNG_READ_ACCURATE_SCALE_SUPPORTED
#        if PNG_LIBPNG_VER >= 10504
#           error PNG_READ_ACCURATE_SCALE should not be set
#        endif

         /* The strip 16 algorithm drops the low 8 bits rather than calculating
          * 1/257, so we need to adjust the permitted errors appropriately:
          * Notice that this is only relevant prior to the addition of the
          * png_set_scale_16 API in 1.5.4 (but 1.5.4+ always defines the above!)
          */
         {
            PNG_CONST double d = (255-128.5)/65535;
            that->rede += d;
            that->greene += d;
            that->bluee += d;
            that->alphae += d;
         }
#     endif
6130 6131 6132 6133 6134 6135
   }

   this->next->mod(this->next, that, pp, display);
}

static int
6136
image_transform_png_set_strip_16_add(image_transform *this,
6137 6138 6139 6140 6141 6142 6143 6144 6145 6146
    PNG_CONST image_transform **that, png_byte colour_type, png_byte bit_depth)
{
   UNUSED(colour_type)

   this->next = *that;
   *that = this;

   return bit_depth > 8;
}

6147
IT(strip_16);
6148
#undef PT
6149
#define PT ITSTRUCT(strip_16)
6150
#endif /* PNG_READ_16_TO_8_SUPPORTED */
6151

6152
#ifdef PNG_READ_STRIP_ALPHA_SUPPORTED
6153 6154 6155 6156 6157 6158 6159 6160 6161 6162 6163 6164 6165 6166 6167 6168 6169 6170
/* png_set_strip_alpha */
static void
image_transform_png_set_strip_alpha_set(PNG_CONST image_transform *this,
    transform_display *that, png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
{
   png_set_strip_alpha(pp);
   this->next->set(this->next, that, pp, pi);
}

static void
image_transform_png_set_strip_alpha_mod(PNG_CONST image_transform *this,
    image_pixel *that, png_structp pp, PNG_CONST transform_display *display)
{
   if (that->colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_GRAY_ALPHA)
      that->colour_type = PNG_COLOR_TYPE_GRAY;
   else if (that->colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_RGB_ALPHA)
      that->colour_type = PNG_COLOR_TYPE_RGB;

6171 6172 6173 6174 6175 6176 6177 6178 6179 6180 6181 6182 6183 6184 6185 6186 6187 6188 6189 6190 6191 6192 6193 6194 6195 6196 6197 6198 6199 6200 6201 6202 6203 6204 6205 6206 6207 6208 6209 6210 6211 6212 6213 6214 6215 6216 6217 6218 6219 6220 6221 6222 6223 6224 6225 6226 6227 6228 6229 6230 6231 6232 6233 6234 6235 6236 6237 6238 6239 6240 6241 6242 6243 6244 6245 6246 6247 6248 6249 6250 6251 6252 6253 6254 6255 6256 6257 6258 6259 6260 6261 6262 6263 6264 6265 6266 6267 6268 6269 6270 6271 6272 6273 6274 6275 6276 6277 6278 6279 6280 6281 6282 6283 6284 6285 6286 6287 6288 6289 6290 6291 6292 6293 6294 6295 6296 6297 6298 6299 6300 6301 6302 6303 6304 6305 6306 6307 6308 6309 6310 6311 6312 6313 6314 6315 6316 6317 6318 6319 6320 6321 6322 6323 6324 6325 6326
   that->have_tRNS = 0;
   that->alphaf = 1;

   this->next->mod(this->next, that, pp, display);
}

static int
image_transform_png_set_strip_alpha_add(image_transform *this,
    PNG_CONST image_transform **that, png_byte colour_type, png_byte bit_depth)
{
   UNUSED(bit_depth)

   this->next = *that;
   *that = this;

   return (colour_type & PNG_COLOR_MASK_ALPHA) != 0;
}

IT(strip_alpha);
#undef PT
#define PT ITSTRUCT(strip_alpha)
#endif /* PNG_READ_STRIP_ALPHA_SUPPORTED */

#ifdef PNG_READ_RGB_TO_GRAY_SUPPORTED
/* png_set_rgb_to_gray(png_structp, int err_action, double red, double green)
 * png_set_rgb_to_gray_fixed(png_structp, int err_action, png_fixed_point red,
 *    png_fixed_point green)
 * png_get_rgb_to_gray_status
 *
 * The 'default' test here uses values known to be used inside libpng:
 *
 *   red:    6968
 *   green: 23434
 *   blue:   2366
 *
 * These values are being retained for compatibility, along with the somewhat
 * broken truncation calculation in the fast-and-inaccurate code path.  Older
 * versions of libpng will fail the accuracy tests below because they use the
 * truncation algorithm everywhere.
 */
#define data ITDATA(rgb_to_gray)
static struct
{
   double gamma;      /* File gamma to use in processing */

   /* The following are the parameters for png_set_rgb_to_gray: */
#  ifdef PNG_FLOATING_POINT_SUPPORTED
      double red_to_set;
      double green_to_set;
#  else
      png_fixed_point red_to_set;
      png_fixed_point green_to_set;
#  endif

   /* The actual coefficients: */
   double red_coefficient;
   double green_coefficient;
   double blue_coefficient;

   /* Set if the coeefficients have been overridden. */
   int coefficients_overridden;
} data;

#undef image_transform_ini
#define image_transform_ini image_transform_png_set_rgb_to_gray_ini
static void
image_transform_png_set_rgb_to_gray_ini(PNG_CONST image_transform *this,
    transform_display *that)
{
   png_modifier *pm = that->pm;
   PNG_CONST color_encoding *e = pm->current_encoding;

   UNUSED(this)

   /* Since we check the encoding this flag must be set: */
   pm->test_uses_encoding = 1;

   /* If 'e' is not NULL chromaticity information is present and either a cHRM
    * or an sRGB chunk will be inserted.
    */
   if (e != 0)
   {
      /* Coefficients come from the encoding, but may need to be normalized to a
       * white point Y of 1.0
       */
      PNG_CONST double whiteY = e->red.Y + e->green.Y + e->blue.Y;

      data.red_coefficient = e->red.Y;
      data.green_coefficient = e->green.Y;
      data.blue_coefficient = e->blue.Y;

      if (whiteY != 1)
      {
         data.red_coefficient /= whiteY;
         data.green_coefficient /= whiteY;
         data.blue_coefficient /= whiteY;
      }
   }

   else
   {
      /* The default (built in) coeffcients, as above: */
      data.red_coefficient = 6968 / 32768.;
      data.green_coefficient = 23434 / 32768.;
      data.blue_coefficient = 2366 / 32768.;
   }

   data.gamma = pm->current_gamma;

   /* If not set then the calculations assume linear encoding (implicitly): */
   if (data.gamma == 0)
      data.gamma = 1;

   /* The arguments to png_set_rgb_to_gray can override the coefficients implied
    * by the color space encoding.  If doing exhaustive checks do the override
    * in each case, otherwise do it randomly.
    */
   if (pm->test_exhaustive)
   {
      /* First time in coefficients_overridden is 0, the following sets it to 1,
       * so repeat if it is set.  If a test fails this may mean we subsequently
       * skip a non-override test, ignore that.
       */
      data.coefficients_overridden = !data.coefficients_overridden;
      pm->repeat = data.coefficients_overridden != 0;
   }

   else
      data.coefficients_overridden = random_choice();

   if (data.coefficients_overridden)
   {
      /* These values override the color encoding defaults, simply use random
       * numbers.
       */
      png_uint_32 ru;
      double total;

      RANDOMIZE(ru);
      data.green_coefficient = total = (ru & 0xffff) / 65535.;
      ru >>= 16;
      data.red_coefficient = (1 - total) * (ru & 0xffff) / 65535.;
      total += data.red_coefficient;
      data.blue_coefficient = 1 - total;

#     ifdef PNG_FLOATING_POINT_SUPPORTED
         data.red_to_set = data.red_coefficient;
         data.green_to_set = data.green_coefficient;
#     else
         data.red_to_set = fix(data.red_coefficient);
         data.green_to_set = fix(data.green_coefficient);
#     endif

      /* The following just changes the error messages: */
      pm->encoding_ignored = 1;
   }
6327

6328 6329 6330 6331 6332
   else
   {
      data.red_to_set = -1;
      data.green_to_set = -1;
   }
6333

6334 6335 6336 6337 6338 6339 6340 6341 6342 6343 6344 6345
   /* Adjust the error limit in the png_modifier because of the larger errors
    * produced in the digitization during the gamma handling.
    */
   if (data.gamma != 1) /* Use gamma tables */
   {
      if (that->this.bit_depth == 16 || pm->assume_16_bit_calculations)
      {
         /* The 16 bit case ends up producing a maximum error of about
          * +/-5 in 65535, allow for +/-8 with the given gamma.
          */
         that->pm->limit += pow(8./65535, data.gamma);
      }
6346

6347 6348 6349 6350 6351 6352 6353 6354 6355
      else
      {
         /* Rounding to 8 bits in the linear space causes massive errors which
          * will trigger the error check in transform_range_check.  Fix that
          * here by taking the gamma encoding into account.
          */
         that->pm->limit += pow(1./255, data.gamma);
      }
   }
6356

6357 6358 6359 6360 6361 6362 6363 6364
   else
   {
      /* With no gamma correction a large error comes from the truncation of the
       * calculation in the 8 bit case, allow for that here.
       */
      if (that->this.bit_depth != 16)
         that->pm->limit += 4E-3;
   }
6365 6366 6367 6368 6369 6370 6371 6372 6373
}

static void
image_transform_png_set_rgb_to_gray_set(PNG_CONST image_transform *this,
    transform_display *that, png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
{
   PNG_CONST int error_action = 1; /* no error, no defines in png.h */

#  ifdef PNG_FLOATING_POINT_SUPPORTED
6374
      png_set_rgb_to_gray(pp, error_action, data.red_to_set, data.green_to_set);
6375
#  else
6376 6377
      png_set_rgb_to_gray_fixed(pp, error_action, data.red_to_set,
         data.green_to_set);
6378 6379
#  endif

6380 6381 6382 6383 6384 6385 6386 6387 6388 6389 6390 6391 6392 6393 6394 6395 6396 6397 6398 6399 6400 6401 6402 6403 6404 6405 6406 6407 6408 6409 6410 6411 6412 6413 6414 6415 6416 6417 6418 6419 6420 6421 6422 6423 6424 6425 6426 6427 6428 6429 6430 6431 6432 6433 6434 6435 6436 6437 6438 6439 6440 6441 6442 6443 6444 6445 6446 6447 6448 6449 6450 6451 6452 6453 6454 6455 6456 6457 6458 6459 6460 6461 6462 6463 6464 6465 6466 6467 6468 6469 6470 6471 6472 6473 6474 6475 6476 6477 6478 6479 6480 6481 6482 6483 6484 6485 6486 6487 6488 6489 6490
#  ifdef PNG_READ_cHRM_SUPPORTED
      if (that->pm->current_encoding != 0)
      {
         /* We have an encoding so a cHRM chunk may have been set; if so then
          * check that the libpng APIs give the correct (X,Y,Z) values within
          * some margin of error for the round trip through the chromaticity
          * form.
          */
#        ifdef PNG_FLOATING_POINT_SUPPORTED
#           define API_function png_get_cHRM_XYZ
#           define API_form "FP"
#           define API_type double
#           define API_cvt(x) (x)
#        else
#           define API_function png_get_cHRM_XYZ_fixed
#           define API_form "fixed"
#           define API_type png_fixed_point
#           define API_cvt(x) ((double)(x)/PNG_FP_1)
#        endif

         API_type rX, gX, bX;
         API_type rY, gY, bY;
         API_type rZ, gZ, bZ;

         if ((API_function(pp, pi, &rX, &rY, &rZ, &gX, &gY, &gZ, &bX, &bY, &bZ)
               & PNG_INFO_cHRM) != 0)
         {
            double maxe;
            PNG_CONST char *el;
            color_encoding e, o;

            /* Expect libpng to return a normalized result, but the original
             * color space encoding may not be normalized.
             */
            modifier_current_encoding(that->pm, &o);
            normalize_color_encoding(&o);

            /* Sanity check the pngvalid code - the coefficients should match
             * the normalized Y values of the encoding unless they were
             * overridden.
             */
            if (data.red_to_set == -1 && data.green_to_set == -1 &&
               (fabs(o.red.Y - data.red_coefficient) > DBL_EPSILON ||
               fabs(o.green.Y - data.green_coefficient) > DBL_EPSILON ||
               fabs(o.blue.Y - data.blue_coefficient) > DBL_EPSILON))
               png_error(pp, "internal pngvalid cHRM coefficient error");

            /* Generate a colour space encoding. */
            e.gamma = o.gamma; /* not used */
            e.red.X = API_cvt(rX);
            e.red.Y = API_cvt(rY);
            e.red.Z = API_cvt(rZ);
            e.green.X = API_cvt(gX);
            e.green.Y = API_cvt(gY);
            e.green.Z = API_cvt(gZ);
            e.blue.X = API_cvt(bX);
            e.blue.Y = API_cvt(bY);
            e.blue.Z = API_cvt(bZ);

            /* This should match the original one from the png_modifier, within
             * the range permitted by the libpng fixed point representation.
             */
            maxe = 0;
            el = "-"; /* Set to element name with error */

#           define CHECK(col,x)\
            {\
               double err = fabs(o.col.x - e.col.x);\
               if (err > maxe)\
               {\
                  maxe = err;\
                  el = #col "(" #x ")";\
               }\
            }

            CHECK(red,X)
            CHECK(red,Y)
            CHECK(red,Z)
            CHECK(green,X)
            CHECK(green,Y)
            CHECK(green,Z)
            CHECK(blue,X)
            CHECK(blue,Y)
            CHECK(blue,Z)

            /* Here in both fixed and floating cases to check the values read
             * from the cHRm chunk.  PNG uses fixed point in the cHRM chunk, so
             * we can't expect better than +/-.5E-5 on the result, allow 1E-5.
             */
            if (maxe >= 1E-5)
            {
               size_t pos = 0;
               char buffer[256];

               pos = safecat(buffer, sizeof buffer, pos, API_form);
               pos = safecat(buffer, sizeof buffer, pos, " cHRM ");
               pos = safecat(buffer, sizeof buffer, pos, el);
               pos = safecat(buffer, sizeof buffer, pos, " error: ");
               pos = safecatd(buffer, sizeof buffer, pos, maxe, 7);
               pos = safecat(buffer, sizeof buffer, pos, " ");
               /* Print the color space without the gamma value: */
               pos = safecat_color_encoding(buffer, sizeof buffer, pos, &o, 0);
               pos = safecat(buffer, sizeof buffer, pos, " -> ");
               pos = safecat_color_encoding(buffer, sizeof buffer, pos, &e, 0);

               png_error(pp, buffer);
            }
         }
      }
#  endif /* READ_cHRM */

6491 6492 6493 6494 6495 6496 6497 6498 6499
   this->next->set(this->next, that, pp, pi);
}

static void
image_transform_png_set_rgb_to_gray_mod(PNG_CONST image_transform *this,
    image_pixel *that, png_structp pp, PNG_CONST transform_display *display)
{
   if ((that->colour_type & PNG_COLOR_MASK_COLOR) != 0)
   {
6500 6501
      double gray, err;

6502
      if (that->colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_PALETTE)
6503
         image_pixel_convert_PLTE(that);
6504 6505

      /* Image now has RGB channels... */
6506 6507 6508 6509 6510 6511 6512 6513 6514 6515 6516 6517 6518 6519 6520 6521 6522 6523 6524 6525 6526 6527 6528 6529 6530 6531 6532 6533 6534 6535 6536 6537 6538 6539 6540 6541 6542 6543 6544 6545 6546 6547 6548 6549 6550 6551 6552 6553 6554 6555 6556 6557 6558 6559 6560 6561 6562 6563 6564 6565 6566 6567 6568 6569 6570 6571 6572
      {
         PNG_CONST png_modifier *pm = display->pm;
         PNG_CONST unsigned int sample_depth = that->sample_depth;
         int isgray;
         double r, g, b;
         double rlo, rhi, glo, ghi, blo, bhi, graylo, grayhi;

         /* Do this using interval arithmetic, otherwise it is too difficult to
          * handle the errors correctly.
          *
          * To handle the gamma correction work out the upper and lower bounds
          * of the digitized value.  Assume rounding here - normally the values
          * will be identical after this operation if there is only one
          * transform, feel free to delete the png_error checks on this below in
          * the future (this is just me trying to ensure it works!)
          */
         r = rlo = rhi = that->redf;
         rlo -= that->rede;
         rlo = digitize(pm, rlo, sample_depth, 1/*round*/);
         rhi += that->rede;
         rhi = digitize(pm, rhi, sample_depth, 1/*round*/);

         g = glo = ghi = that->greenf;
         glo -= that->greene;
         glo = digitize(pm, glo, sample_depth, 1/*round*/);
         ghi += that->greene;
         ghi = digitize(pm, ghi, sample_depth, 1/*round*/);

         b = blo = bhi = that->bluef;
         blo -= that->bluee;
         blo = digitize(pm, blo, sample_depth, 1/*round*/);
         bhi += that->greene;
         bhi = digitize(pm, bhi, sample_depth, 1/*round*/);

         isgray = r==g && g==b;

         if (data.gamma != 1)
         {
            PNG_CONST double power = 1/data.gamma;
            PNG_CONST double abse = abserr(pm, sample_depth, sample_depth);

            /* 'abse' is the absolute error permitted in linear calculations. It
             * is used here to capture the error permitted in the handling
             * (undoing) of the gamma encoding.  Once again digitization occurs
             * to handle the upper and lower bounds of the values.  This is
             * where the real errors are introduced.
             */
            r = pow(r, power);
            rlo = digitize(pm, pow(rlo, power)-abse, sample_depth, 1);
            rhi = digitize(pm, pow(rhi, power)+abse, sample_depth, 1);

            g = pow(g, power);
            glo = digitize(pm, pow(glo, power)-abse, sample_depth, 1);
            ghi = digitize(pm, pow(ghi, power)+abse, sample_depth, 1);

            b = pow(b, power);
            blo = digitize(pm, pow(blo, power)-abse, sample_depth, 1);
            bhi = digitize(pm, pow(bhi, power)+abse, sample_depth, 1);
         }

         /* Now calculate the actual gray values.  Although the error in the
          * coefficients depends on whether they were specified on the command
          * line (in which case truncation to 15 bits happened) or not (rounding
          * was used) the maxium error in an individual coefficient is always
          * 1/32768, because even in the rounding case the requirement that
          * coefficients add up to 32768 can cause a larger rounding error.
          *
6573
          * The only time when rounding doesn't occur in 1.5.5 and later is when
6574 6575 6576 6577 6578 6579 6580 6581 6582 6583 6584 6585 6586 6587 6588 6589 6590 6591 6592 6593 6594 6595 6596 6597 6598 6599 6600 6601 6602 6603 6604 6605 6606 6607 6608 6609 6610 6611 6612 6613 6614 6615 6616 6617 6618 6619 6620 6621 6622 6623 6624 6625 6626 6627 6628 6629 6630 6631 6632 6633 6634 6635 6636 6637
          * the non-gamma code path is used for less than 16 bit data.
          */
         gray = r * data.red_coefficient + g * data.green_coefficient +
            b * data.blue_coefficient;

         {
            PNG_CONST int do_round = data.gamma != 1 || sample_depth == 16;
            PNG_CONST double ce = 1. / 32768;

            graylo = digitize(pm, rlo * (data.red_coefficient-ce) +
               glo * (data.green_coefficient-ce) +
               blo * (data.blue_coefficient-ce), sample_depth, do_round);
            if (graylo <= 0)
               graylo = 0;

            grayhi = digitize(pm, rhi * (data.red_coefficient+ce) +
               ghi * (data.green_coefficient+ce) +
               bhi * (data.blue_coefficient+ce), sample_depth, do_round);
            if (grayhi >= 1)
               grayhi = 1;
         }

         /* And invert the gamma. */
         if (data.gamma != 1)
         {
            PNG_CONST double power = data.gamma;

            gray = pow(gray, power);
            graylo = digitize(pm, pow(graylo, power), sample_depth, 1);
            grayhi = digitize(pm, pow(grayhi, power), sample_depth, 1);
         }

         /* Now the error can be calculated.
          *
          * If r==g==b because there is no overall gamma correction libpng
          * currently preserves the original value.
          */
         if (isgray)
            err = (that->rede + that->greene + that->bluee)/3;

         else
         {
            err = fabs(grayhi-gray);
            if (fabs(gray - graylo) > err)
               err = fabs(graylo-gray);

            /* Check that this worked: */
            if (err > display->pm->limit)
            {
               size_t pos = 0;
               char buffer[128];

               pos = safecat(buffer, sizeof buffer, pos, "rgb_to_gray error ");
               pos = safecatd(buffer, sizeof buffer, pos, err, 6);
               pos = safecat(buffer, sizeof buffer, pos, " exceeds limit ");
               pos = safecatd(buffer, sizeof buffer, pos,
                  display->pm->limit, 6);
               png_error(pp, buffer);
            }
         }
      }

      that->bluef = that->greenf = that->redf = gray;
      that->bluee = that->greene = that->rede = err;
6638 6639 6640 6641 6642 6643 6644 6645

      /* The sBIT is the minium of the three colour channel sBITs. */
      if (that->red_sBIT > that->green_sBIT)
         that->red_sBIT = that->green_sBIT;
      if (that->red_sBIT > that->blue_sBIT)
         that->red_sBIT = that->blue_sBIT;
      that->blue_sBIT = that->green_sBIT = that->red_sBIT;

6646
      /* And remove the colour bit in the type: */
6647 6648 6649 6650 6651 6652 6653 6654 6655 6656 6657
      if (that->colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_RGB)
         that->colour_type = PNG_COLOR_TYPE_GRAY;
      else if (that->colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_RGB_ALPHA)
         that->colour_type = PNG_COLOR_TYPE_GRAY_ALPHA;
   }

   this->next->mod(this->next, that, pp, display);
}

static int
image_transform_png_set_rgb_to_gray_add(image_transform *this,
6658
    PNG_CONST image_transform **that, png_byte colour_type, png_byte bit_depth)
6659
{
6660
   UNUSED(bit_depth)
6661 6662 6663 6664 6665 6666 6667

   this->next = *that;
   *that = this;

   return (colour_type & PNG_COLOR_MASK_COLOR) != 0;
}

6668
#undef data
6669 6670 6671
IT(rgb_to_gray);
#undef PT
#define PT ITSTRUCT(rgb_to_gray)
6672 6673
#undef image_transform_ini
#define image_transform_ini image_transform_default_ini
6674
#endif /* PNG_READ_RGB_TO_GRAY_SUPPORTED */
6675

6676
#ifdef PNG_READ_BACKGROUND_SUPPORTED
6677 6678 6679 6680 6681 6682
/* png_set_background(png_structp, png_const_color_16p background_color,
 *    int background_gamma_code, int need_expand, double background_gamma)
 * png_set_background_fixed(png_structp, png_const_color_16p background_color,
 *    int background_gamma_code, int need_expand,
 *    png_fixed_point background_gamma)
 *
6683
 * As with rgb_to_gray this ignores the gamma (at present.)
6684
*/
6685 6686 6687
#define data ITDATA(background)
static image_pixel data;

6688 6689 6690 6691
static void
image_transform_png_set_background_set(PNG_CONST image_transform *this,
    transform_display *that, png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
{
6692 6693
   png_byte colour_type, bit_depth;
   png_byte random_bytes[8]; /* 8 bytes - 64 bits - the biggest pixel */
6694 6695
   png_color_16 back;

6696 6697 6698 6699 6700 6701 6702 6703 6704
   /* We need a background colour, because we don't know exactly what transforms
    * have been set we have to supply the colour in the original file format and
    * so we need to know what that is!  The background colour is stored in the
    * transform_display.
    */
   RANDOMIZE(random_bytes);

   /* Read the random value, for colour type 3 the background colour is actually
    * expressed as a 24bit rgb, not an index.
6705
    */
6706 6707 6708 6709 6710 6711 6712 6713 6714 6715
   colour_type = that->this.colour_type;
   if (colour_type == 3)
   {
      colour_type = PNG_COLOR_TYPE_RGB;
      bit_depth = 8;
   }

   else
      bit_depth = that->this.bit_depth;

6716
   image_pixel_init(&data, random_bytes, colour_type,
6717
      bit_depth, 0/*x*/, 0/*unused: palette*/);
6718

6719 6720 6721 6722 6723 6724 6725
   /* Extract the background colour from this image_pixel, but make sure the
    * unused fields of 'back' are garbage.
    */
   RANDOMIZE(back);

   if (colour_type & PNG_COLOR_MASK_COLOR)
   {
6726 6727 6728
      back.red = (png_uint_16)data.red;
      back.green = (png_uint_16)data.green;
      back.blue = (png_uint_16)data.blue;
6729 6730 6731
   }

   else
6732
      back.gray = (png_uint_16)data.red;
6733

6734
#  ifdef PNG_FLOATING_POINT_SUPPORTED
6735 6736
      png_set_background(pp, &back, PNG_BACKGROUND_GAMMA_FILE, 1/*need expand*/,
         0);
6737
#  else
6738 6739
      png_set_background_fixed(pp, &back, PNG_BACKGROUND_GAMMA_FILE,
         1/*need expand*/, 0);
6740 6741 6742 6743 6744 6745 6746 6747 6748
#  endif

   this->next->set(this->next, that, pp, pi);
}

static void
image_transform_png_set_background_mod(PNG_CONST image_transform *this,
    image_pixel *that, png_structp pp, PNG_CONST transform_display *display)
{
6749 6750
   /* Check for tRNS first: */
   if (that->have_tRNS && that->colour_type != PNG_COLOR_TYPE_PALETTE)
6751 6752
      image_pixel_add_alpha(that, &display->this);

6753 6754
   /* This is only necessary if the alpha value is less than 1. */
   if (that->alphaf < 1)
6755
   {
6756
      /* Now we do the background calculation without any gamma correction. */
6757 6758
      if (that->alphaf <= 0)
      {
6759 6760 6761
         that->redf = data.redf;
         that->greenf = data.greenf;
         that->bluef = data.bluef;
6762

6763 6764 6765
         that->rede = data.rede;
         that->greene = data.greene;
         that->bluee = data.bluee;
6766

6767 6768 6769
         that->red_sBIT= data.red_sBIT;
         that->green_sBIT= data.green_sBIT;
         that->blue_sBIT= data.blue_sBIT;
6770 6771
      }

6772
      else /* 0 < alpha < 1 */
6773
      {
6774 6775
         double alf = 1 - that->alphaf;

6776 6777
         that->redf = that->redf * that->alphaf + data.redf * alf;
         that->rede = that->rede * that->alphaf + data.rede * alf +
6778
            DBL_EPSILON;
6779 6780
         that->greenf = that->greenf * that->alphaf + data.greenf * alf;
         that->greene = that->greene * that->alphaf + data.greene * alf +
6781
            DBL_EPSILON;
6782 6783
         that->bluef = that->bluef * that->alphaf + data.bluef * alf;
         that->bluee = that->bluee * that->alphaf + data.bluee * alf +
6784 6785 6786
            DBL_EPSILON;
      }

6787
      /* Remove the alpha type and set the alpha (not in that order.) */
6788 6789 6790 6791 6792 6793 6794
      that->alphaf = 1;
      that->alphae = 0;

      if (that->colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_RGB_ALPHA)
         that->colour_type = PNG_COLOR_TYPE_RGB;
      else if (that->colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_GRAY_ALPHA)
         that->colour_type = PNG_COLOR_TYPE_GRAY;
6795
      /* PNG_COLOR_TYPE_PALETTE is not changed */
6796 6797
   }

6798 6799 6800 6801 6802
   this->next->mod(this->next, that, pp, display);
}

#define image_transform_png_set_background_add image_transform_default_add

6803
#undef data
6804 6805 6806 6807
IT(background);
#undef PT
#define PT ITSTRUCT(background)
#endif /* PNG_READ_BACKGROUND_SUPPORTED */
6808

6809 6810
/* This may just be 'end' if all the transforms are disabled! */
static image_transform *PNG_CONST image_transform_first = &PT;
6811 6812 6813 6814 6815 6816 6817 6818 6819 6820 6821 6822

static void
transform_enable(PNG_CONST char *name)
{
   /* Everything starts out enabled, so if we see an 'enable' disabled
    * everything else the first time round.
    */
   static int all_disabled = 0;
   int found_it = 0;
   image_transform *list = image_transform_first;

   while (list != &image_transform_end)
6823
   {
6824 6825 6826 6827 6828 6829 6830 6831 6832
      if (strcmp(list->name, name) == 0)
      {
         list->enable = 1;
         found_it = 1;
      }
      else if (!all_disabled)
         list->enable = 0;

      list = list->list;
6833 6834
   }

6835 6836 6837 6838 6839 6840 6841 6842
   all_disabled = 1;

   if (!found_it)
   {
      fprintf(stderr, "pngvalid: --transform-enable=%s: unknown transform\n",
         name);
      exit(1);
   }
6843 6844
}

6845 6846
static void
transform_disable(PNG_CONST char *name)
6847
{
6848
   image_transform *list = image_transform_first;
6849

6850 6851 6852 6853 6854 6855 6856
   while (list != &image_transform_end)
   {
      if (strcmp(list->name, name) == 0)
      {
         list->enable = 0;
         return;
      }
6857

6858 6859
      list = list->list;
   }
6860

6861 6862 6863
   fprintf(stderr, "pngvalid: --transform-disable=%s: unknown transform\n",
      name);
   exit(1);
6864 6865
}

6866 6867 6868 6869 6870
static void
image_transform_reset_count(void)
{
   image_transform *next = image_transform_first;
   int count = 0;
6871

6872 6873 6874 6875 6876 6877 6878
   while (next != &image_transform_end)
   {
      next->local_use = 0;
      next->next = 0;
      next = next->list;
      ++count;
   }
6879

6880 6881 6882 6883 6884 6885 6886 6887
   /* This can only happen if we every have more than 32 transforms (excluding
    * the end) in the list.
    */
   if (count > 32) abort();
}

static int
image_transform_test_counter(png_uint_32 counter, unsigned int max)
6888
{
6889 6890 6891 6892 6893 6894 6895 6896 6897 6898 6899 6900 6901 6902 6903 6904 6905 6906
   /* Test the list to see if there is any point contining, given a current
    * counter and a 'max' value.
    */
   image_transform *next = image_transform_first;

   while (next != &image_transform_end)
   {
      /* For max 0 or 1 continue until the counter overflows: */
      counter >>= 1;

      /* Continue if any entry hasn't reacked the max. */
      if (max > 1 && next->local_use < max)
         return 1;
      next = next->list;
   }

   return max <= 1 && counter == 0;
}
6907 6908

static png_uint_32
6909
image_transform_add(PNG_CONST image_transform **this, unsigned int max,
6910 6911 6912
   png_uint_32 counter, char *name, size_t sizeof_name, size_t *pos,
   png_byte colour_type, png_byte bit_depth)
{
6913
   for (;;) /* until we manage to add something */
6914
   {
6915 6916
      png_uint_32 mask;
      image_transform *list;
6917

6918 6919 6920 6921 6922 6923 6924 6925 6926 6927 6928 6929 6930
      /* Find the next counter value, if the counter is zero this is the start
       * of the list.  This routine always returns the current counter (not the
       * next) so it returns 0 at the end and expects 0 at the beginning.
       */
      if (counter == 0) /* first time */
      {
         image_transform_reset_count();
         if (max <= 1)
            counter = 1;
         else
            counter = random_32();
      }
      else /* advance the counter */
6931
      {
6932 6933 6934 6935 6936 6937 6938
         switch (max)
         {
            case 0:  ++counter; break;
            case 1:  counter <<= 1; break;
            default: counter = random_32(); break;
         }
      }
6939

6940 6941 6942 6943
      /* Now add all these items, if possible */
      *this = &image_transform_end;
      list = image_transform_first;
      mask = 1;
6944

6945 6946 6947 6948 6949
      /* Go through the whole list adding anything that the counter selects: */
      while (list != &image_transform_end)
      {
         if ((counter & mask) != 0 && list->enable &&
             (max == 0 || list->local_use < max))
6950
         {
6951 6952
            /* Candidate to add: */
            if (list->add(list, this, colour_type, bit_depth) || max == 0)
6953
            {
6954 6955 6956
               /* Added, so add to the name too. */
               *pos = safecat(name, sizeof_name, *pos, " +");
               *pos = safecat(name, sizeof_name, *pos, list->name);
6957 6958
            }

6959
            else
6960
            {
6961
               /* Not useful and max>0, so remove it from *this: */
6962 6963
               *this = list->next;
               list->next = 0;
6964

6965 6966 6967 6968 6969
               /* And, since we know it isn't useful, stop it being added again
                * in this run:
                */
               list->local_use = max;
            }
6970 6971
         }

6972 6973 6974
         mask <<= 1;
         list = list->list;
      }
6975

6976 6977 6978
      /* Now if anything was added we have something to do. */
      if (*this != &image_transform_end)
         return counter;
6979

6980 6981 6982
      /* Nothing added, but was there anything in there to add? */
      if (!image_transform_test_counter(counter, max))
         return 0;
6983 6984 6985 6986 6987 6988 6989 6990 6991 6992 6993 6994 6995 6996 6997 6998 6999 7000 7001 7002 7003 7004 7005 7006 7007 7008 7009 7010 7011 7012 7013 7014 7015 7016 7017 7018 7019 7020 7021 7022 7023 7024 7025 7026 7027 7028 7029 7030 7031 7032 7033 7034 7035 7036 7037 7038 7039 7040 7041 7042 7043 7044 7045 7046 7047 7048 7049 7050 7051 7052 7053 7054 7055 7056 7057 7058 7059 7060 7061
   }
}

#ifdef THIS_IS_THE_PROFORMA
static void
image_transform_png_set_@_set(PNG_CONST image_transform *this,
    transform_display *that, png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
{
   png_set_@(pp);
   this->next->set(this->next, that, pp, pi);
}

static void
image_transform_png_set_@_mod(PNG_CONST image_transform *this,
    image_pixel *that, png_structp pp, PNG_CONST transform_display *display)
{
   this->next->mod(this->next, that, pp, display);
}

static int
image_transform_png_set_@_add(image_transform *this,
    PNG_CONST image_transform **that, char *name, size_t sizeof_name,
    size_t *pos, png_byte colour_type, png_byte bit_depth)
{
   this->next = *that;
   *that = this;

   *pos = safecat(name, sizeof_name, *pos, " +@");

   return 1;
}

IT(@);
#endif

/* png_set_quantize(png_structp, png_colorp palette, int num_palette,
 *    int maximum_colors, png_const_uint_16p histogram, int full_quantize)
 *
 * Very difficult to validate this!
 */
/*NOTE: TBD NYI */

/* The data layout transforms are handled by swapping our own channel data,
 * necessarily these need to happen at the end of the transform list because the
 * semantic of the channels changes after these are executed.  Some of these,
 * like set_shift and set_packing, can't be done at present because they change
 * the layout of the data at the sub-sample level so sample() won't get the
 * right answer.
 */
/* png_set_invert_alpha */
/*NOTE: TBD NYI */

/* png_set_bgr */
/*NOTE: TBD NYI */

/* png_set_swap_alpha */
/*NOTE: TBD NYI */

/* png_set_swap */
/*NOTE: TBD NYI */

/* png_set_filler, (png_structp png_ptr, png_uint_32 filler, int flags)); */
/*NOTE: TBD NYI */

/* png_set_add_alpha, (png_structp png_ptr, png_uint_32 filler, int flags)); */
/*NOTE: TBD NYI */

/* png_set_packing */
/*NOTE: TBD NYI */

/* png_set_packswap */
/*NOTE: TBD NYI */

/* png_set_invert_mono */
/*NOTE: TBD NYI */

/* png_set_shift(png_structp, png_const_color_8p true_bits) */
/*NOTE: TBD NYI */

7062 7063
static void
perform_transform_test(png_modifier *pm)
7064
{
7065 7066 7067 7068 7069
   png_byte colour_type = 0;
   png_byte bit_depth = 0;
   int palette_number = 0;

   while (next_format(&colour_type, &bit_depth, &palette_number))
7070
   {
7071
      png_uint_32 counter = 0;
7072 7073 7074 7075 7076 7077 7078 7079 7080 7081
      size_t base_pos;
      char name[64];

      base_pos = safecat(name, sizeof name, 0, "transform:");

      for (;;)
      {
         size_t pos = base_pos;
         PNG_CONST image_transform *list = 0;

7082
         /* 'max' is currently hardwired to '1'; this should be settable on the
7083 7084 7085 7086
          * command line.
          */
         counter = image_transform_add(&list, 1/*max*/, counter,
            name, sizeof name, &pos, colour_type, bit_depth);
7087 7088 7089 7090 7091

         if (counter == 0)
            break;

         /* The command line can change this to checking interlaced images. */
7092 7093 7094 7095 7096
         do
         {
            pm->repeat = 0;
            transform_test(pm, FILEID(colour_type, bit_depth, palette_number,
               pm->interlace_type, 0, 0, 0), list, name);
7097

7098 7099 7100 7101
            if (fail(pm))
               return;
         }
         while (pm->repeat);
7102 7103 7104
      }
   }
}
7105
#endif /* PNG_READ_TRANSFORMS_SUPPORTED */
7106 7107

/********************************* GAMMA TESTS ********************************/
7108
#ifdef PNG_READ_GAMMA_SUPPORTED
7109 7110 7111 7112 7113 7114 7115 7116 7117 7118 7119
/* Reader callbacks and implementations, where they differ from the standard
 * ones.
 */
typedef struct gamma_display
{
   standard_display this;

   /* Parameters */
   png_modifier*    pm;
   double           file_gamma;
   double           screen_gamma;
7120
   double           background_gamma;
7121 7122 7123
   png_byte         sbit;
   int              threshold_test;
   int              use_input_precision;
7124
   int              scale16;
7125 7126 7127
   int              expand16;
   int              do_background;
   png_color_16     background_color;
7128 7129 7130 7131 7132 7133 7134

   /* Local variables */
   double       maxerrout;
   double       maxerrpc;
   double       maxerrabs;
} gamma_display;

7135 7136
#define ALPHA_MODE_OFFSET 4

7137 7138 7139
static void
gamma_display_init(gamma_display *dp, png_modifier *pm, png_uint_32 id,
    double file_gamma, double screen_gamma, png_byte sbit, int threshold_test,
7140
    int use_input_precision, int scale16, int expand16,
7141 7142
    int do_background, PNG_CONST png_color_16 *pointer_to_the_background_color,
    double background_gamma)
7143 7144
{
   /* Standard fields */
7145
   standard_display_init(&dp->this, &pm->this, id, 0/*do_interlace*/,
7146
      pm->use_update_info);
7147 7148 7149 7150 7151

   /* Parameter fields */
   dp->pm = pm;
   dp->file_gamma = file_gamma;
   dp->screen_gamma = screen_gamma;
7152
   dp->background_gamma = background_gamma;
7153 7154
   dp->sbit = sbit;
   dp->threshold_test = threshold_test;
7155
   dp->use_input_precision = use_input_precision;
7156
   dp->scale16 = scale16;
7157 7158 7159 7160 7161 7162
   dp->expand16 = expand16;
   dp->do_background = do_background;
   if (do_background && pointer_to_the_background_color != 0)
      dp->background_color = *pointer_to_the_background_color;
   else
      memset(&dp->background_color, 0, sizeof dp->background_color);
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
7163

7164 7165 7166
   /* Local variable fields */
   dp->maxerrout = dp->maxerrpc = dp->maxerrabs = 0;
}
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
7167

7168 7169 7170
static void
gamma_info_imp(gamma_display *dp, png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
{
7171
   /* Reuse the standard stuff as appropriate. */
7172
   standard_info_part1(&dp->this, pp, pi);
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
7173

7174 7175 7176 7177 7178
   /* If requested strip 16 to 8 bits - this is handled automagically below
    * because the output bit depth is read from the library.  Note that there
    * are interactions with sBIT but, internally, libpng makes sbit at most
    * PNG_MAX_GAMMA_8 when doing the following.
    */
7179
   if (dp->scale16)
7180
#     ifdef PNG_READ_SCALE_16_TO_8_SUPPORTED
7181
         png_set_scale_16(pp);
7182
#     else
7183 7184 7185 7186 7187 7188
         /* The following works both in 1.5.4 and earlier versions: */
#        ifdef PNG_READ_16_TO_8_SUPPORTED
            png_set_strip_16(pp);
#        else
            png_error(pp, "scale16 (16 to 8 bit conversion) not supported");
#        endif
7189
#     endif
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
7190

7191 7192 7193 7194 7195 7196 7197 7198 7199 7200 7201 7202 7203 7204 7205 7206 7207 7208 7209 7210
   if (dp->expand16)
#     ifdef PNG_READ_EXPAND_16_SUPPORTED
         png_set_expand_16(pp);
#     else
         png_error(pp, "expand16 (8 to 16 bit conversion) not supported");
#     endif

   if (dp->do_background >= ALPHA_MODE_OFFSET)
   {
#     ifdef PNG_READ_ALPHA_MODE_SUPPORTED
      {
         /* This tests the alpha mode handling, if supported. */
         int mode = dp->do_background - ALPHA_MODE_OFFSET;

         /* The gamma value is the output gamma, and is in the standard,
          * non-inverted, represenation.  It provides a default for the PNG file
          * gamma, but since the file has a gAMA chunk this does not matter.
          */
         PNG_CONST double sg = dp->screen_gamma;
#        ifndef PNG_FLOATING_POINT_SUPPORTED
7211
            PNG_CONST png_fixed_point g = fix(sg);
7212 7213 7214 7215 7216 7217 7218 7219 7220 7221 7222 7223 7224 7225 7226 7227 7228
#        endif

#        ifdef PNG_FLOATING_POINT_SUPPORTED
            png_set_alpha_mode(pp, mode, sg);
#        else
            png_set_alpha_mode_fixed(pp, mode, g);
#        endif

         /* However, for the standard Porter-Duff algorithm the output defaults
          * to be linear, so if the test requires non-linear output it must be
          * corrected here.
          */
         if (mode == PNG_ALPHA_STANDARD && sg != 1)
         {
#           ifdef PNG_FLOATING_POINT_SUPPORTED
               png_set_gamma(pp, sg, dp->file_gamma);
#           else
7229
               png_fixed_point f = fix(dp->file_gamma);
7230 7231 7232 7233 7234 7235 7236 7237 7238 7239 7240 7241 7242 7243 7244 7245
               png_set_gamma_fixed(pp, g, f);
#           endif
         }
      }
#     else
         png_error(pp, "alpha mode handling not supported");
#     endif
   }

   else
   {
      /* Set up gamma processing. */
#     ifdef PNG_FLOATING_POINT_SUPPORTED
         png_set_gamma(pp, dp->screen_gamma, dp->file_gamma);
#     else
      {
7246 7247
         png_fixed_point s = fix(dp->screen_gamma);
         png_fixed_point f = fix(dp->file_gamma);
7248 7249 7250 7251 7252 7253 7254 7255 7256 7257 7258
         png_set_gamma_fixed(pp, s, f);
      }
#     endif

      if (dp->do_background)
      {
#     ifdef PNG_READ_BACKGROUND_SUPPORTED
         /* NOTE: this assumes the caller provided the correct background gamma!
          */
         PNG_CONST double bg = dp->background_gamma;
#        ifndef PNG_FLOATING_POINT_SUPPORTED
7259
            PNG_CONST png_fixed_point g = fix(bg);
7260 7261 7262 7263 7264 7265 7266 7267 7268 7269 7270 7271 7272 7273 7274
#        endif

#        ifdef PNG_FLOATING_POINT_SUPPORTED
            png_set_background(pp, &dp->background_color, dp->do_background,
               0/*need_expand*/, bg);
#        else
            png_set_background_fixed(pp, &dp->background_color,
               dp->do_background, 0/*need_expand*/, g);
#        endif
#     else
         png_error(pp, "png_set_background not supported");
#     endif
      }
   }

7275 7276 7277 7278 7279 7280 7281
   {
      int i = dp->this.use_update_info;
      /* Always do one call, even if use_update_info is 0. */
      do
         png_read_update_info(pp, pi);
      while (--i > 0);
   }
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
7282

7283
   /* Now we may get a different cbRow: */
7284
   standard_info_part2(&dp->this, pp, pi, 1 /*images*/);
7285 7286 7287 7288 7289
}

static void
gamma_info(png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
{
7290 7291
   gamma_info_imp(voidcast(gamma_display*, png_get_progressive_ptr(pp)), pp,
      pi);
7292
}
7293

7294 7295 7296 7297 7298 7299 7300 7301 7302 7303 7304
/* Validate a single component value - the routine gets the input and output
 * sample values as unscaled PNG component values along with a cache of all the
 * information required to validate the values.
 */
typedef struct validate_info
{
   png_structp  pp;
   gamma_display *dp;
   png_byte sbit;
   int use_input_precision;
   int do_background;
7305
   int scale16;
7306 7307 7308 7309 7310 7311 7312 7313 7314 7315 7316 7317 7318 7319
   unsigned int sbit_max;
   unsigned int isbit_shift;
   unsigned int outmax;

   double gamma_correction; /* Overall correction required. */
   double file_inverse;     /* Inverse of file gamma. */
   double screen_gamma;
   double screen_inverse;   /* Inverse of screen gamma. */

   double background_red;   /* Linear background value, red or gray. */
   double background_green;
   double background_blue;

   double maxabs;
7320
   double maxpc;
7321 7322
   double maxcalc;
   double maxout;
7323
   double maxout_total;     /* Total including quantization error */
7324
   double outlog;
7325
   int    outquant;
7326 7327 7328 7329 7330
}
validate_info;

static void
init_validate_info(validate_info *vi, gamma_display *dp, png_struct *pp,
7331
    int in_depth, int out_depth)
7332
{
7333
   PNG_CONST unsigned int outmax = (1U<<out_depth)-1;
7334 7335 7336

   vi->pp = pp;
   vi->dp = dp;
7337 7338 7339 7340 7341 7342 7343 7344 7345 7346 7347 7348 7349 7350

   if (dp->sbit > 0 && dp->sbit < in_depth)
   {
      vi->sbit = dp->sbit;
      vi->isbit_shift = in_depth - dp->sbit;
   }

   else
   {
      vi->sbit = (png_byte)in_depth;
      vi->isbit_shift = 0;
   }

   vi->sbit_max = (1U << vi->sbit)-1;
7351 7352 7353 7354 7355 7356 7357 7358 7359 7360 7361 7362

   /* This mimics the libpng threshold test, '0' is used to prevent gamma
    * correction in the validation test.
    */
   vi->screen_gamma = dp->screen_gamma;
   if (fabs(vi->screen_gamma-1) < PNG_GAMMA_THRESHOLD)
      vi->screen_gamma = vi->screen_inverse = 0;
   else
      vi->screen_inverse = 1/vi->screen_gamma;

   vi->use_input_precision = dp->use_input_precision;
   vi->outmax = outmax;
7363 7364 7365 7366 7367 7368
   vi->maxabs = abserr(dp->pm, in_depth, out_depth);
   vi->maxpc = pcerr(dp->pm, in_depth, out_depth);
   vi->maxcalc = calcerr(dp->pm, in_depth, out_depth);
   vi->maxout = outerr(dp->pm, in_depth, out_depth);
   vi->outquant = output_quantization_factor(dp->pm, in_depth, out_depth);
   vi->maxout_total = vi->maxout + vi->outquant * .5;
7369
   vi->outlog = outlog(dp->pm, in_depth, out_depth);
7370

7371 7372
   if ((dp->this.colour_type & PNG_COLOR_MASK_ALPHA) != 0 ||
      (dp->this.colour_type == 3 && dp->this.is_transparent))
7373 7374 7375 7376 7377 7378 7379 7380 7381 7382 7383 7384 7385 7386 7387 7388 7389 7390 7391 7392 7393 7394 7395 7396 7397 7398 7399 7400 7401 7402 7403 7404 7405 7406 7407 7408 7409 7410 7411 7412 7413 7414 7415
   {
      vi->do_background = dp->do_background;

      if (vi->do_background != 0)
      {
         PNG_CONST double bg_inverse = 1/dp->background_gamma;
         double r, g, b;

         /* Caller must at least put the gray value into the red channel */
         r = dp->background_color.red; r /= outmax;
         g = dp->background_color.green; g /= outmax;
         b = dp->background_color.blue; b /= outmax;

#     if 0
         /* libpng doesn't do this optimization, if we do pngvalid will fail.
          */
         if (fabs(bg_inverse-1) >= PNG_GAMMA_THRESHOLD)
#     endif
         {
            r = pow(r, bg_inverse);
            g = pow(g, bg_inverse);
            b = pow(b, bg_inverse);
         }

         vi->background_red = r;
         vi->background_green = g;
         vi->background_blue = b;
      }
   }
   else
      vi->do_background = 0;

   if (vi->do_background == 0)
      vi->background_red = vi->background_green = vi->background_blue = 0;

   vi->gamma_correction = 1/(dp->file_gamma*dp->screen_gamma);
   if (fabs(vi->gamma_correction-1) < PNG_GAMMA_THRESHOLD)
      vi->gamma_correction = 0;

   vi->file_inverse = 1/dp->file_gamma;
   if (fabs(vi->file_inverse-1) < PNG_GAMMA_THRESHOLD)
      vi->file_inverse = 0;

7416
   vi->scale16 = dp->scale16;
7417 7418
}

7419 7420 7421 7422 7423 7424 7425 7426 7427 7428 7429 7430 7431 7432 7433 7434 7435 7436 7437 7438 7439 7440 7441 7442 7443 7444 7445 7446 7447 7448 7449 7450 7451 7452 7453 7454 7455 7456 7457 7458 7459 7460 7461 7462 7463 7464 7465 7466 7467 7468 7469 7470 7471 7472 7473 7474 7475 7476 7477 7478 7479 7480 7481 7482 7483 7484
/* This function handles composition of a single non-alpha component.  The
 * argument is the input sample value, in the range 0..1, and the alpha value.
 * The result is the composed, linear, input sample.  If alpha is less than zero
 * this is the alpha component and the function should not be called!
 */
static double
gamma_component_compose(int do_background, double input_sample, double alpha,
   double background, int *compose)
{
   switch (do_background)
   {
      case PNG_BACKGROUND_GAMMA_SCREEN:
      case PNG_BACKGROUND_GAMMA_FILE:
      case PNG_BACKGROUND_GAMMA_UNIQUE:
         /* Standard PNG background processing. */
         if (alpha < 1)
         {
            if (alpha > 0)
            {
               input_sample = input_sample * alpha + background * (1-alpha);
               if (compose != NULL)
                  *compose = 1;
            }

            else
               input_sample = background;
         }
         break;

#ifdef PNG_READ_ALPHA_MODE_SUPPORTED
      case ALPHA_MODE_OFFSET + PNG_ALPHA_STANDARD:
      case ALPHA_MODE_OFFSET + PNG_ALPHA_BROKEN:
         /* The components are premultiplied in either case and the output is
          * gamma encoded (to get standard Porter-Duff we expect the output
          * gamma to be set to 1.0!)
          */
      case ALPHA_MODE_OFFSET + PNG_ALPHA_OPTIMIZED:
         /* The optimization is that the partial-alpha entries are linear
          * while the opaque pixels are gamma encoded, but this only affects the
          * output encoding.
          */
         if (alpha < 1)
         {
            if (alpha > 0)
            {
               input_sample *= alpha;
               if (compose != NULL)
                  *compose = 1;
            }

            else
               input_sample = 0;
         }
         break;
#endif

      default:
         /* Standard cases where no compositing is done (so the component
          * value is already correct.)
          */
         break;
   }

   return input_sample;
}

7485 7486 7487 7488 7489 7490 7491 7492 7493 7494 7495 7496 7497 7498 7499 7500 7501 7502 7503 7504 7505 7506 7507 7508 7509 7510 7511 7512 7513 7514 7515 7516 7517 7518 7519 7520 7521 7522 7523 7524 7525 7526 7527 7528 7529 7530 7531 7532 7533 7534 7535 7536 7537
/* This API returns the encoded *input* component, in the range 0..1 */
static double
gamma_component_validate(PNG_CONST char *name, PNG_CONST validate_info *vi,
    PNG_CONST unsigned int id, PNG_CONST unsigned int od,
    PNG_CONST double alpha /* <0 for the alpha channel itself */,
    PNG_CONST double background /* component background value */)
{
   PNG_CONST unsigned int isbit = id >> vi->isbit_shift;
   PNG_CONST unsigned int sbit_max = vi->sbit_max;
   PNG_CONST unsigned int outmax = vi->outmax;
   PNG_CONST int do_background = vi->do_background;

   double i;

   /* First check on the 'perfect' result obtained from the digitized input
    * value, id, and compare this against the actual digitized result, 'od'.
    * 'i' is the input result in the range 0..1:
    */
   i = isbit; i /= sbit_max;

   /* Check for the fast route: if we don't do any background composition or if
    * this is the alpha channel ('alpha' < 0) or if the pixel is opaque then
    * just use the gamma_correction field to correct to the final output gamma.
    */
   if (alpha == 1 /* opaque pixel component */ || !do_background
#ifdef PNG_READ_ALPHA_MODE_SUPPORTED
      || do_background == ALPHA_MODE_OFFSET + PNG_ALPHA_PNG
#endif
      || (alpha < 0 /* alpha channel */
#ifdef PNG_READ_ALPHA_MODE_SUPPORTED
      && do_background != ALPHA_MODE_OFFSET + PNG_ALPHA_BROKEN
#endif
      ))
   {
      /* Then get the gamma corrected version of 'i' and compare to 'od', any
       * error less than .5 is insignificant - just quantization of the output
       * value to the nearest digital value (nevertheless the error is still
       * recorded - it's interesting ;-)
       */
      double encoded_sample = i;
      double encoded_error;

      /* alpha less than 0 indicates the alpha channel, which is always linear
       */
      if (alpha >= 0 && vi->gamma_correction > 0)
         encoded_sample = pow(encoded_sample, vi->gamma_correction);
      encoded_sample *= outmax;

      encoded_error = fabs(od-encoded_sample);

      if (encoded_error > vi->dp->maxerrout)
         vi->dp->maxerrout = encoded_error;

7538
      if (encoded_error < vi->maxout_total && encoded_error < vi->outlog)
7539 7540 7541 7542 7543 7544 7545 7546 7547 7548 7549 7550 7551
         return i;
   }

   /* The slow route - attempt to do linear calculations. */
   /* There may be an error, or background processing is required, so calculate
    * the actual sample values - unencoded light intensity values.  Note that in
    * practice these are not completely unencoded because they include a
    * 'viewing correction' to decrease or (normally) increase the perceptual
    * contrast of the image.  There's nothing we can do about this - we don't
    * know what it is - so assume the unencoded value is perceptually linear.
    */
   {
      double input_sample = i; /* In range 0..1 */
7552
      double output, error, encoded_sample, encoded_error;
7553
      double es_lo, es_hi;
7554 7555
      int compose = 0;           /* Set to one if composition done */
      int output_is_encoded;     /* Set if encoded to screen gamma */
7556
      int log_max_error = 1;     /* Check maximum error values */
7557
      png_const_charp pass = 0;  /* Reason test passes (or 0 for fail) */
7558 7559 7560 7561

      /* Convert to linear light (with the above caveat.)  The alpha channel is
       * already linear.
       */
7562 7563 7564 7565
      if (alpha >= 0)
      {
         int tcompose;

7566
         if (vi->file_inverse > 0)
7567 7568 7569 7570 7571 7572 7573 7574 7575 7576
            input_sample = pow(input_sample, vi->file_inverse);

         /* Handle the compose processing: */
         tcompose = 0;
         input_sample = gamma_component_compose(do_background, input_sample,
            alpha, background, &tcompose);

         if (tcompose)
            compose = 1;
      }
7577 7578

      /* And similarly for the output value, but we need to check the background
7579
       * handling to linearize it correctly.
7580 7581 7582 7583
       */
      output = od;
      output /= outmax;

7584
      output_is_encoded = vi->screen_gamma > 0;
7585

7586 7587
      if (alpha < 0) /* The alpha channel */
      {
7588
#ifdef PNG_READ_ALPHA_MODE_SUPPORTED
7589
         if (do_background != ALPHA_MODE_OFFSET + PNG_ALPHA_BROKEN)
7590
#endif
7591
         {
7592 7593 7594
            /* In all other cases the output alpha channel is linear already,
             * don't log errors here, they are much larger in linear data.
             */
7595
            output_is_encoded = 0;
7596
            log_max_error = 0;
7597
         }
7598 7599
      }

7600
#ifdef PNG_READ_ALPHA_MODE_SUPPORTED
7601
      else /* A component */
7602
      {
7603 7604 7605 7606 7607 7608
         if (do_background == ALPHA_MODE_OFFSET + PNG_ALPHA_OPTIMIZED &&
            alpha < 1) /* the optimized case - linear output */
         {
            if (alpha > 0) log_max_error = 0;
            output_is_encoded = 0;
         }
7609
      }
7610
#endif
7611

7612 7613 7614
      if (output_is_encoded)
         output = pow(output, vi->screen_gamma);

7615 7616 7617 7618 7619 7620 7621 7622
      /* Calculate (or recalculate) the encoded_sample value and repeat the
       * check above (unnecessary if we took the fast route, but harmless.)
       */
      encoded_sample = input_sample;
      if (output_is_encoded)
         encoded_sample = pow(encoded_sample, vi->screen_inverse);
      encoded_sample *= outmax;

7623
      encoded_error = fabs(od-encoded_sample);
7624

7625 7626 7627 7628 7629
      /* Don't log errors in the alpha channel, or the 'optimized' case,
       * neither are significant to the overall perception.
       */
      if (log_max_error && encoded_error > vi->dp->maxerrout)
         vi->dp->maxerrout = encoded_error;
7630

7631 7632 7633
      if (encoded_error < vi->maxout_total)
      {
         if (encoded_error < vi->outlog)
7634
            return i;
7635 7636 7637 7638 7639

         /* Test passed but error is bigger than the log limit, record why the
          * test passed:
          */
         pass = "less than maxout:\n";
7640 7641
      }

7642 7643 7644 7645 7646 7647 7648 7649 7650 7651 7652
      /* i: the original input value in the range 0..1
       *
       * pngvalid calculations:
       *  input_sample: linear result; i linearized and composed, range 0..1
       *  encoded_sample: encoded result; input_sample scaled to ouput bit depth
       *
       * libpng calculations:
       *  output: linear result; od scaled to 0..1 and linearized
       *  od: encoded result from libpng
       */

7653 7654 7655 7656 7657 7658 7659 7660 7661
      /* Now we have the numbers for real errors, both absolute values as as a
       * percentage of the correct value (output):
       */
      error = fabs(input_sample-output);

      if (log_max_error && error > vi->dp->maxerrabs)
         vi->dp->maxerrabs = error;

      /* The following is an attempt to ignore the tendency of quantization to
7662
       * dominate the percentage errors for lower result values:
7663
       */
7664
      if (log_max_error && input_sample > .5)
7665 7666 7667 7668 7669 7670 7671 7672 7673 7674 7675 7676 7677 7678 7679
      {
         double percentage_error = error/input_sample;
         if (percentage_error > vi->dp->maxerrpc)
            vi->dp->maxerrpc = percentage_error;
      }

      /* Now calculate the digitization limits for 'encoded_sample' using the
       * 'max' values.  Note that maxout is in the encoded space but maxpc and
       * maxabs are in linear light space.
       *
       * First find the maximum error in linear light space, range 0..1:
       */
      {
         double tmp = input_sample * vi->maxpc;
         if (tmp < vi->maxabs) tmp = vi->maxabs;
7680 7681 7682 7683 7684 7685
         /* If 'compose' is true the composition was done in linear space using
          * integer arithmetic.  This introduces an extra error of +/- 0.5 (at
          * least) in the integer space used.  'maxcalc' records this, taking
          * into account the possibility that even for 16 bit output 8 bit space
          * may have been used.
          */
7686 7687
         if (compose && tmp < vi->maxcalc) tmp = vi->maxcalc;

7688 7689 7690
         /* The 'maxout' value refers to the encoded result, to compare with
          * this encode input_sample adjusted by the maximum error (tmp) above.
          */
7691 7692 7693 7694 7695 7696 7697 7698 7699
         es_lo = encoded_sample - vi->maxout;

         if (es_lo > 0 && input_sample-tmp > 0)
         {
            double low_value = input_sample-tmp;
            if (output_is_encoded)
               low_value = pow(low_value, vi->screen_inverse);
            low_value *= outmax;
            if (low_value < es_lo) es_lo = low_value;
7700 7701 7702

            /* Quantize this appropriately: */
            es_lo = ceil(es_lo / vi->outquant - .5) * vi->outquant;
7703 7704 7705 7706 7707 7708 7709 7710 7711 7712 7713 7714 7715 7716
         }

         else
            es_lo = 0;

         es_hi = encoded_sample + vi->maxout;

         if (es_hi < outmax && input_sample+tmp < 1)
         {
            double high_value = input_sample+tmp;
            if (output_is_encoded)
               high_value = pow(high_value, vi->screen_inverse);
            high_value *= outmax;
            if (high_value > es_hi) es_hi = high_value;
7717 7718

            es_hi = floor(es_hi / vi->outquant + .5) * vi->outquant;
7719 7720 7721 7722 7723 7724 7725 7726
         }

         else
            es_hi = outmax;
      }

      /* The primary test is that the final encoded value returned by the
       * library should be between the two limits (inclusive) that were
7727
       * calculated above.
7728
       */
7729 7730 7731 7732 7733 7734 7735 7736 7737 7738
      if (od >= es_lo && od <= es_hi)
      {
         /* The value passes, but we may need to log the information anyway. */
         if (encoded_error < vi->outlog)
            return i;

         if (pass == 0)
            pass = "within digitization limits:\n";
      }

7739
      {
7740 7741 7742
         /* There has been an error in processing, or we need to log this
          * value.
          */
7743 7744
         double is_lo, is_hi;

7745 7746 7747 7748 7749
         /* pass is set at this point if either of the tests above would have
          * passed.  Don't do these additional tests here - just log the
          * original [es_lo..es_hi] values.
          */
         if (pass == 0 && vi->use_input_precision)
7750 7751
         {
            /* Ok, something is wrong - this actually happens in current libpng
7752 7753
             * 16-to-8 processing.  Assume that the input value (id, adjusted
             * for sbit) can be anywhere between value-.5 and value+.5 - quite a
7754 7755 7756 7757
             * large range if sbit is low.
             */
            double tmp = (isbit - .5)/sbit_max;

7758 7759
            if (tmp <= 0)
               tmp = 0;
7760

7761 7762 7763 7764 7765 7766 7767 7768 7769 7770 7771 7772
            else if (alpha >= 0 && vi->file_inverse > 0 && tmp < 1)
               tmp = pow(tmp, vi->file_inverse);

            tmp = gamma_component_compose(do_background, tmp, alpha, background,
               NULL);

            if (output_is_encoded && tmp > 0 && tmp < 1)
               tmp = pow(tmp, vi->screen_inverse);

            is_lo = ceil(outmax * tmp - vi->maxout_total);

            if (is_lo < 0)
7773 7774 7775 7776
               is_lo = 0;

            tmp = (isbit + .5)/sbit_max;

7777 7778
            if (tmp <= 0)
               tmp = 0;
7779

7780 7781 7782 7783 7784 7785 7786 7787 7788 7789 7790 7791
            else if (alpha >= 0 && vi->file_inverse > 0 && tmp < 1)
               tmp = pow(tmp, vi->file_inverse);

            tmp = gamma_component_compose(do_background, tmp, alpha, background,
               NULL);

            if (output_is_encoded && tmp > 0 && tmp < 1)
               tmp = pow(tmp, vi->screen_inverse);

            is_hi = floor(outmax * tmp + vi->maxout_total);

            if (is_hi > outmax)
7792 7793
               is_hi = outmax;

7794
            if (!(od < is_lo || od > is_hi))
7795 7796 7797 7798 7799 7800
            {
               if (encoded_error < vi->outlog)
                  return i;

               pass = "within input precision limits:\n";
            }
7801 7802 7803 7804 7805

            /* One last chance.  If this is an alpha channel and the 16to8
             * option has been used and 'inaccurate' scaling is used then the
             * bit reduction is obtained by simply using the top 8 bits of the
             * value.
7806 7807 7808
             *
             * This is only done for older libpng versions when the 'inaccurate'
             * (chop) method of scaling was used.
7809
             */
7810 7811 7812 7813 7814 7815 7816 7817 7818 7819
#           ifndef PNG_READ_16_TO_8_ACCURATE_SCALE_SUPPORTED
#              if PNG_LIBPNG_VER < 10504
                  /* This may be required for other components in the future,
                   * but at present the presence of gamma correction effectively
                   * prevents the errors in the component scaling (I don't quite
                   * understand why, but since it's better this way I care not
                   * to ask, JB 20110419.)
                   */
                  if (pass == 0 && alpha < 0 && vi->scale16 && vi->sbit > 8 &&
                     vi->sbit + vi->isbit_shift == 16)
7820
                  {
7821
                     tmp = ((id >> 8) - .5)/255;
7822

7823 7824 7825 7826 7827
                     if (tmp > 0)
                     {
                        is_lo = ceil(outmax * tmp - vi->maxout_total);
                        if (is_lo < 0) is_lo = 0;
                     }
7828

7829 7830
                     else
                        is_lo = 0;
7831

7832
                     tmp = ((id >> 8) + .5)/255;
7833

7834 7835 7836 7837 7838
                     if (tmp < 1)
                     {
                        is_hi = floor(outmax * tmp + vi->maxout_total);
                        if (is_hi > outmax) is_hi = outmax;
                     }
7839

7840 7841
                     else
                        is_hi = outmax;
7842

7843 7844 7845 7846 7847 7848 7849
                     if (!(od < is_lo || od > is_hi))
                     {
                        if (encoded_error < vi->outlog)
                           return i;

                        pass = "within 8 bit limits:\n";
                     }
7850
                  }
7851
#              endif
7852 7853 7854 7855 7856
#           endif
         }
         else /* !use_input_precision */
            is_lo = es_lo, is_hi = es_hi;

7857 7858 7859 7860
         /* Attempt to output a meaningful error/warning message: the message
          * output depends on the background/composite operation being performed
          * because this changes what parameters were actually used above.
          */
7861
         {
7862 7863 7864 7865 7866 7867
            size_t pos = 0;
            /* Need either 1/255 or 1/65535 precision here; 3 or 6 decimal
             * places.  Just use outmax to work out which.
             */
            int precision = (outmax >= 1000 ? 6 : 3);
            int use_input=1, use_background=0, do_compose=0;
7868 7869
            char msg[256];

7870 7871
            if (pass != 0)
               pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "\n\t");
7872

7873 7874 7875 7876 7877 7878 7879 7880 7881 7882 7883 7884 7885 7886 7887
            /* Set up the various flags, the output_is_encoded flag above
             * is also used below.  do_compose is just a double check.
             */
            switch (do_background)
            {
            case PNG_BACKGROUND_GAMMA_SCREEN:
            case PNG_BACKGROUND_GAMMA_FILE:
            case PNG_BACKGROUND_GAMMA_UNIQUE:
               use_background = (alpha >= 0 && alpha < 1);
               /*FALL THROUGH*/
#           ifdef PNG_READ_ALPHA_MODE_SUPPORTED
               case ALPHA_MODE_OFFSET + PNG_ALPHA_STANDARD:
               case ALPHA_MODE_OFFSET + PNG_ALPHA_BROKEN:
               case ALPHA_MODE_OFFSET + PNG_ALPHA_OPTIMIZED:
#           endif /* ALPHA_MODE_SUPPORTED */
7888
               do_compose = (alpha > 0 && alpha < 1);
7889 7890 7891 7892 7893 7894 7895 7896 7897 7898 7899 7900 7901 7902 7903 7904 7905 7906 7907 7908 7909 7910 7911 7912 7913 7914 7915 7916 7917 7918 7919 7920 7921 7922 7923 7924 7925 7926 7927 7928 7929 7930 7931 7932 7933 7934 7935 7936 7937 7938 7939 7940 7941 7942 7943 7944 7945 7946 7947 7948 7949 7950 7951 7952 7953 7954 7955 7956 7957 7958 7959 7960 7961 7962 7963 7964 7965 7966 7967 7968 7969 7970 7971 7972 7973 7974 7975 7976 7977 7978 7979 7980 7981 7982 7983 7984 7985 7986 7987 7988 7989 7990 7991 7992 7993 7994 7995 7996 7997 7998 7999 8000 8001 8002 8003 8004 8005 8006 8007 8008 8009 8010 8011 8012 8013 8014 8015 8016 8017 8018 8019 8020 8021 8022 8023 8024 8025 8026 8027 8028 8029 8030 8031 8032 8033 8034
               use_input = (alpha != 0);
               break;

            default:
               break;
            }

            /* Check the 'compose' flag */
            if (compose != do_compose)
               png_error(vi->pp, "internal error (compose)");

            /* 'name' is the component name */
            pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, name);
            pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "(");
            pos = safecatn(msg, sizeof msg, pos, id);
            if (use_input || pass != 0/*logging*/)
            {
               if (isbit != id)
               {
                  /* sBIT has reduced the precision of the input: */
                  pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, ", sbit(");
                  pos = safecatn(msg, sizeof msg, pos, vi->sbit);
                  pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "): ");
                  pos = safecatn(msg, sizeof msg, pos, isbit);
               }
               pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "/");
               /* The output is either "id/max" or "id sbit(sbit): isbit/max" */
               pos = safecatn(msg, sizeof msg, pos, vi->sbit_max);
            }
            pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, ")");

            /* A component may have been multiplied (in linear space) by the
             * alpha value, 'compose' says whether this is relevant.
             */
            if (compose || pass != 0)
            {
               /* If any form of composition is being done report our
                * calculated linear value here (the code above doesn't record
                * the input value before composition is performed, so what
                * gets reported is the value after composition.)
                */
               if (use_input || pass != 0)
               {
                  if (vi->file_inverse > 0)
                  {
                     pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "^");
                     pos = safecatd(msg, sizeof msg, pos, vi->file_inverse, 2);
                  }

                  else
                     pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "[linear]");

                  pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "*(alpha)");
                  pos = safecatd(msg, sizeof msg, pos, alpha, precision);
               }

               /* Now record the *linear* background value if it was used
                * (this function is not passed the original, non-linear,
                * value but it is contained in the test name.)
                */
               if (use_background)
               {
                  pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, use_input ? "+" : " ");
                  pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "(background)");
                  pos = safecatd(msg, sizeof msg, pos, background, precision);
                  pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "*");
                  pos = safecatd(msg, sizeof msg, pos, 1-alpha, precision);
               }
            }

            /* Report the calculated value (input_sample) and the linearized
             * libpng value (output) unless this is just a component gamma
             * correction.
             */
            if (compose || alpha < 0 || pass != 0)
            {
               pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos,
                  pass != 0 ? " =\n\t" : " = ");
               pos = safecatd(msg, sizeof msg, pos, input_sample, precision);
               pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, " (libpng: ");
               pos = safecatd(msg, sizeof msg, pos, output, precision);
               pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, ")");

               /* Finally report the output gamma encoding, if any. */
               if (output_is_encoded)
               {
                  pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, " ^");
                  pos = safecatd(msg, sizeof msg, pos, vi->screen_inverse, 2);
                  pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "(to screen) =");
               }

               else
                  pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, " [screen is linear] =");
            }

            if ((!compose && alpha >= 0) || pass != 0)
            {
               if (pass != 0) /* logging */
                  pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "\n\t[overall:");

               /* This is the non-composition case, the internal linear
                * values are irrelevant (though the log below will reveal
                * them.)  Output a much shorter warning/error message and report
                * the overall gamma correction.
                */
               if (vi->gamma_correction > 0)
               {
                  pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, " ^");
                  pos = safecatd(msg, sizeof msg, pos, vi->gamma_correction, 2);
                  pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "(gamma correction) =");
               }

               else
                  pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos,
                     " [no gamma correction] =");

               if (pass != 0)
                  pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "]");
            }

            /* This is our calculated encoded_sample which should (but does
             * not) match od:
             */
            pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, pass != 0 ? "\n\t" : " ");
            pos = safecatd(msg, sizeof msg, pos, is_lo, 1);
            pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, " < ");
            pos = safecatd(msg, sizeof msg, pos, encoded_sample, 1);
            pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, " (libpng: ");
            pos = safecatn(msg, sizeof msg, pos, od);
            pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, ")");
            pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "/");
            pos = safecatn(msg, sizeof msg, pos, outmax);
            pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, " < ");
            pos = safecatd(msg, sizeof msg, pos, is_hi, 1);

            if (pass == 0) /* The error condition */
            {
#              ifdef PNG_WARNINGS_SUPPORTED
                  png_warning(vi->pp, msg);
#              else
                  store_warning(vi->pp, msg);
#              endif
            }

            else /* logging this value */
               store_verbose(&vi->dp->pm->this, vi->pp, pass, msg);
8035 8036 8037 8038 8039 8040 8041
         }
      }
   }

   return i;
}

8042
static void
8043
gamma_image_validate(gamma_display *dp, png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
8044 8045
{
   /* Get some constants derived from the input and output file formats: */
8046
   PNG_CONST png_store* PNG_CONST ps = dp->this.ps;
8047 8048 8049 8050 8051 8052 8053 8054 8055 8056 8057
   PNG_CONST png_byte in_ct = dp->this.colour_type;
   PNG_CONST png_byte in_bd = dp->this.bit_depth;
   PNG_CONST png_uint_32 w = dp->this.w;
   PNG_CONST png_uint_32 h = dp->this.h;
   PNG_CONST size_t cbRow = dp->this.cbRow;
   PNG_CONST png_byte out_ct = png_get_color_type(pp, pi);
   PNG_CONST png_byte out_bd = png_get_bit_depth(pp, pi);

   /* There are three sources of error, firstly the quantization in the
    * file encoding, determined by sbit and/or the file depth, secondly
    * the output (screen) gamma and thirdly the output file encoding.
8058
    *
8059 8060 8061 8062 8063 8064 8065
    * Since this API receives the screen and file gamma in double
    * precision it is possible to calculate an exact answer given an input
    * pixel value.  Therefore we assume that the *input* value is exact -
    * sample/maxsample - calculate the corresponding gamma corrected
    * output to the limits of double precision arithmetic and compare with
    * what libpng returns.
    *
8066
    * Since the library must quantize the output to 8 or 16 bits there is
8067
    * a fundamental limit on the accuracy of the output of +/-.5 - this
8068
    * quantization limit is included in addition to the other limits
8069 8070 8071 8072 8073 8074
    * specified by the paramaters to the API.  (Effectively, add .5
    * everywhere.)
    *
    * The behavior of the 'sbit' paramter is defined by section 12.5
    * (sample depth scaling) of the PNG spec.  That section forces the
    * decoder to assume that the PNG values have been scaled if sBIT is
8075
    * present:
8076
    *
8077
    *     png-sample = floor( input-sample * (max-out/max-in) + .5);
8078 8079
    *
    * This means that only a subset of the possible PNG values should
8080
    * appear in the input. However, the spec allows the encoder to use a
8081 8082 8083 8084 8085 8086 8087 8088 8089 8090
    * variety of approximations to the above and doesn't require any
    * restriction of the values produced.
    *
    * Nevertheless the spec requires that the upper 'sBIT' bits of the
    * value stored in a PNG file be the original sample bits.
    * Consequently the code below simply scales the top sbit bits by
    * (1<<sbit)-1 to obtain an original sample value.
    *
    * Because there is limited precision in the input it is arguable that
    * an acceptable result is any valid result from input-.5 to input+.5.
8091 8092
    * The basic tests below do not do this, however if 'use_input_precision'
    * is set a subsequent test is performed below.
8093 8094
    */
   PNG_CONST unsigned int samples_per_pixel = (out_ct & 2U) ? 3U : 1U;
8095 8096
   int processing;
   png_uint_32 y;
8097 8098 8099 8100 8101
   PNG_CONST store_palette_entry *in_palette = dp->this.palette;
   PNG_CONST int in_is_transparent = dp->this.is_transparent;
   int out_npalette = -1;
   int out_is_transparent = 0; /* Just refers to the palette case */
   store_palette out_palette;
8102
   validate_info vi;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8103

8104 8105 8106
   /* Check for row overwrite errors */
   store_image_check(dp->this.ps, pp, 0);

8107 8108 8109 8110
   /* Supply the input and output sample depths here - 8 for an indexed image,
    * otherwise the bit depth.
    */
   init_validate_info(&vi, dp, pp, in_ct==3?8:in_bd, out_ct==3?8:out_bd);
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8111

8112
   processing = (vi.gamma_correction > 0 && !dp->threshold_test)
8113
      || in_bd != out_bd || in_ct != out_ct || vi.do_background;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8114

8115 8116 8117 8118 8119 8120 8121 8122 8123 8124 8125 8126 8127
   /* TODO: FIX THIS: MAJOR BUG!  If the transformations all happen inside
    * the palette there is no way of finding out, because libpng fails to
    * update the palette on png_read_update_info.  Indeed, libpng doesn't
    * even do the required work until much later, when it doesn't have any
    * info pointer.  Oops.  For the moment 'processing' is turned off if
    * out_ct is palette.
    */
   if (in_ct == 3 && out_ct == 3)
      processing = 0;

   if (processing && out_ct == 3)
      out_is_transparent = read_palette(out_palette, &out_npalette, pp, pi);

8128
   for (y=0; y<h; ++y)
8129
   {
8130
      png_const_bytep pRow = store_image_row(ps, pp, 0, y);
8131
      png_byte std[STANDARD_ROWMAX];
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8132

8133
      transform_row(pp, std, in_ct, in_bd, y);
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8134

8135
      if (processing)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8136
      {
8137
         unsigned int x;
8138

8139 8140 8141
         for (x=0; x<w; ++x)
         {
            double alpha = 1; /* serves as a flag value */
8142

8143 8144 8145 8146 8147 8148
            /* Record the palette index for index images. */
            PNG_CONST unsigned int in_index =
               in_ct == 3 ? sample(std, 3, in_bd, x, 0) : 256;
            PNG_CONST unsigned int out_index =
               out_ct == 3 ? sample(std, 3, out_bd, x, 0) : 256;

8149 8150
            /* Handle input alpha - png_set_background will cause the output
             * alpha to disappear so there is nothing to check.
8151
             */
8152 8153
            if ((in_ct & PNG_COLOR_MASK_ALPHA) != 0 || (in_ct == 3 &&
               in_is_transparent))
8154
            {
8155 8156
               PNG_CONST unsigned int input_alpha = in_ct == 3 ?
                  dp->this.palette[in_index].alpha :
8157
                  sample(std, in_ct, in_bd, x, samples_per_pixel);
8158

8159
               unsigned int output_alpha = 65536 /* as a flag value */;
8160

8161 8162 8163 8164 8165 8166 8167 8168 8169 8170 8171
               if (out_ct == 3)
               {
                  if (out_is_transparent)
                     output_alpha = out_palette[out_index].alpha;
               }

               else if ((out_ct & PNG_COLOR_MASK_ALPHA) != 0)
                  output_alpha = sample(pRow, out_ct, out_bd, x,
                     samples_per_pixel);

               if (output_alpha != 65536)
8172
                  alpha = gamma_component_validate("alpha", &vi, input_alpha,
8173 8174 8175
                     output_alpha, -1/*alpha*/, 0/*background*/);

               else /* no alpha in output */
8176
               {
8177 8178 8179
                  /* This is a copy of the calculation of 'i' above in order to
                   * have the alpha value to use in the background calculation.
                   */
8180 8181
                  alpha = input_alpha >> vi.isbit_shift;
                  alpha /= vi.sbit_max;
8182 8183
               }
            }
8184

8185 8186
            /* Handle grayscale or RGB components. */
            if ((in_ct & PNG_COLOR_MASK_COLOR) == 0) /* grayscale */
8187 8188 8189 8190
               (void)gamma_component_validate("gray", &vi,
                  sample(std, in_ct, in_bd, x, 0),
                  sample(pRow, out_ct, out_bd, x, 0), alpha/*component*/,
                  vi.background_red);
8191
            else /* RGB or palette */
8192
            {
8193
               (void)gamma_component_validate("red", &vi,
8194 8195 8196 8197 8198
                  in_ct == 3 ? in_palette[in_index].red :
                     sample(std, in_ct, in_bd, x, 0),
                  out_ct == 3 ? out_palette[out_index].red :
                     sample(pRow, out_ct, out_bd, x, 0),
                  alpha/*component*/, vi.background_red);
8199 8200

               (void)gamma_component_validate("green", &vi,
8201 8202 8203 8204 8205
                  in_ct == 3 ? in_palette[in_index].green :
                     sample(std, in_ct, in_bd, x, 1),
                  out_ct == 3 ? out_palette[out_index].green :
                     sample(pRow, out_ct, out_bd, x, 1),
                  alpha/*component*/, vi.background_green);
8206 8207

               (void)gamma_component_validate("blue", &vi,
8208 8209 8210 8211 8212
                  in_ct == 3 ? in_palette[in_index].blue :
                     sample(std, in_ct, in_bd, x, 2),
                  out_ct == 3 ? out_palette[out_index].blue :
                     sample(pRow, out_ct, out_bd, x, 2),
                  alpha/*component*/, vi.background_blue);
8213 8214 8215
            }
         }
      }
8216

8217
      else if (memcmp(std, pRow, cbRow) != 0)
8218 8219
      {
         char msg[64];
8220

8221 8222
         /* No transform is expected on the threshold tests. */
         sprintf(msg, "gamma: below threshold row %d changed", y);
8223

8224 8225 8226
         png_error(pp, msg);
      }
   } /* row (y) loop */
8227

8228 8229
   dp->this.ps->validated = 1;
}
8230

8231 8232 8233
static void
gamma_end(png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
{
8234
   gamma_display *dp = voidcast(gamma_display*, png_get_progressive_ptr(pp));
8235

8236 8237
   if (!dp->this.speed)
      gamma_image_validate(dp, pp, pi);
8238 8239
   else
      dp->this.ps->validated = 1;
8240
}
8241

8242 8243 8244 8245 8246 8247 8248 8249
/* A single test run checking a gamma transformation.
 *
 * maxabs: maximum absolute error as a fraction
 * maxout: maximum output error in the output units
 * maxpc:  maximum percentage error (as a percentage)
 */
static void
gamma_test(png_modifier *pmIn, PNG_CONST png_byte colour_typeIn,
8250 8251
    PNG_CONST png_byte bit_depthIn, PNG_CONST int palette_numberIn,
    PNG_CONST int interlace_typeIn,
8252 8253
    PNG_CONST double file_gammaIn, PNG_CONST double screen_gammaIn,
    PNG_CONST png_byte sbitIn, PNG_CONST int threshold_testIn,
8254
    PNG_CONST char *name,
8255
    PNG_CONST int use_input_precisionIn, PNG_CONST int scale16In,
8256 8257
    PNG_CONST int expand16In, PNG_CONST int do_backgroundIn,
    PNG_CONST png_color_16 *bkgd_colorIn, double bkgd_gammaIn)
8258 8259 8260
{
   gamma_display d;
   context(&pmIn->this, fault);
8261

8262
   gamma_display_init(&d, pmIn, FILEID(colour_typeIn, bit_depthIn,
8263 8264
      palette_numberIn, interlace_typeIn, 0, 0, 0),
      file_gammaIn, screen_gammaIn, sbitIn,
8265
      threshold_testIn, use_input_precisionIn, scale16In,
8266
      expand16In, do_backgroundIn, bkgd_colorIn, bkgd_gammaIn);
8267

8268 8269 8270 8271
   Try
   {
      png_structp pp;
      png_infop pi;
8272
      gama_modification gama_mod;
8273 8274
      srgb_modification srgb_mod;
      sbit_modification sbit_mod;
8275

8276 8277 8278 8279 8280
      /* For the moment don't use the png_modifier support here. */
      d.pm->encoding_counter = 0;
      modifier_set_encoding(d.pm); /* Just resets everything */
      d.pm->current_gamma = d.file_gamma;

8281 8282 8283 8284
      /* Make an appropriate modifier to set the PNG file gamma to the
       * given gamma value and the sBIT chunk to the given precision.
       */
      d.pm->modifications = NULL;
8285
      gama_modification_init(&gama_mod, d.pm, d.file_gamma);
8286
      srgb_modification_init(&srgb_mod, d.pm, 127 /*delete*/);
8287 8288
      if (d.sbit > 0)
         sbit_modification_init(&sbit_mod, d.pm, d.sbit);
8289

8290 8291 8292 8293
      modification_reset(d.pm->modifications);

      /* Get a png_struct for writing the image. */
      pp = set_modifier_for_read(d.pm, &pi, d.this.id, name);
8294
      standard_palette_init(&d.this);
8295

8296 8297 8298 8299 8300 8301 8302 8303 8304 8305 8306 8307 8308 8309 8310 8311 8312 8313
      /* Introduce the correct read function. */
      if (d.pm->this.progressive)
      {
         /* Share the row function with the standard implementation. */
         png_set_progressive_read_fn(pp, &d, gamma_info, progressive_row,
            gamma_end);

         /* Now feed data into the reader until we reach the end: */
         modifier_progressive_read(d.pm, pp, pi);
      }
      else
      {
         /* modifier_read expects a png_modifier* */
         png_set_read_fn(pp, d.pm, modifier_read);

         /* Check the header values: */
         png_read_info(pp, pi);

8314
         /* Process the 'info' requirements. Only one image is generated */
8315 8316
         gamma_info_imp(&d, pp, pi);

8317
         sequential_row(&d.this, pp, pi, -1, 0);
8318

8319 8320
         if (!d.this.speed)
            gamma_image_validate(&d, pp, pi);
8321 8322
         else
            d.this.ps->validated = 1;
8323 8324
      }

8325
      modifier_reset(d.pm);
8326

8327
      if (d.pm->log && !d.threshold_test && !d.this.speed)
8328
         fprintf(stderr, "%d bit %s %s: max error %f (%.2g, %2g%%)\n",
8329
            d.this.bit_depth, colour_types[d.this.colour_type], name,
8330
            d.maxerrout, d.maxerrabs, 100*d.maxerrpc);
8331 8332

      /* Log the summary values too. */
8333
      if (d.this.colour_type == 0 || d.this.colour_type == 4)
8334
      {
8335
         switch (d.this.bit_depth)
8336
         {
8337 8338 8339 8340
         case 1:
            break;

         case 2:
8341 8342
            if (d.maxerrout > d.pm->error_gray_2)
               d.pm->error_gray_2 = d.maxerrout;
8343

8344 8345 8346
            break;

         case 4:
8347 8348
            if (d.maxerrout > d.pm->error_gray_4)
               d.pm->error_gray_4 = d.maxerrout;
8349

8350 8351 8352
            break;

         case 8:
8353 8354
            if (d.maxerrout > d.pm->error_gray_8)
               d.pm->error_gray_8 = d.maxerrout;
8355

8356 8357 8358
            break;

         case 16:
8359 8360
            if (d.maxerrout > d.pm->error_gray_16)
               d.pm->error_gray_16 = d.maxerrout;
8361

8362 8363 8364 8365
            break;

         default:
            png_error(pp, "bad bit depth (internal: 1)");
8366
         }
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8367 8368
      }

8369
      else if (d.this.colour_type == 2 || d.this.colour_type == 6)
8370
      {
8371
         switch (d.this.bit_depth)
8372 8373
         {
         case 8:
8374

8375 8376
            if (d.maxerrout > d.pm->error_color_8)
               d.pm->error_color_8 = d.maxerrout;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8377

8378
            break;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8379

8380
         case 16:
8381

8382 8383
            if (d.maxerrout > d.pm->error_color_16)
               d.pm->error_color_16 = d.maxerrout;
8384 8385 8386 8387 8388 8389 8390

            break;

         default:
            png_error(pp, "bad bit depth (internal: 2)");
         }
      }
8391 8392 8393 8394 8395 8396

      else if (d.this.colour_type == 3)
      {
         if (d.maxerrout > d.pm->error_indexed)
            d.pm->error_indexed = d.maxerrout;
      }
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8397
   }
8398 8399

   Catch(fault)
8400
      modifier_reset((png_modifier*)fault);
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8401 8402 8403
}

static void gamma_threshold_test(png_modifier *pm, png_byte colour_type,
8404 8405
    png_byte bit_depth, int interlace_type, double file_gamma,
    double screen_gamma)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8406 8407 8408 8409 8410 8411 8412 8413
{
   size_t pos = 0;
   char name[64];
   pos = safecat(name, sizeof name, pos, "threshold ");
   pos = safecatd(name, sizeof name, pos, file_gamma, 3);
   pos = safecat(name, sizeof name, pos, "/");
   pos = safecatd(name, sizeof name, pos, screen_gamma, 3);

8414
   (void)gamma_test(pm, colour_type, bit_depth, 0/*palette*/, interlace_type,
8415
      file_gamma, screen_gamma, 0/*sBIT*/, 1/*threshold test*/, name,
8416
      0 /*no input precision*/,
8417
      0 /*no scale16*/, 0 /*no expand16*/, 0 /*no background*/, 0 /*hence*/,
8418
      0 /*no background gamma*/);
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8419 8420 8421 8422 8423 8424 8425
}

static void
perform_gamma_threshold_tests(png_modifier *pm)
{
   png_byte colour_type = 0;
   png_byte bit_depth = 0;
8426
   int palette_number = 0;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8427

8428 8429 8430 8431 8432 8433
   /* Don't test more than one instance of each palette - it's pointless, in
    * fact this test is somewhat excessive since libpng doesn't make this
    * decision based on colour type or bit depth!
    */
   while (next_format(&colour_type, &bit_depth, &palette_number))
      if (palette_number == 0)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8434
   {
8435 8436
      double test_gamma = 1.0;
      while (test_gamma >= .4)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8437
      {
8438 8439 8440 8441
         /* There's little point testing the interlacing vs non-interlacing,
          * but this can be set from the command line.
          */
         gamma_threshold_test(pm, colour_type, bit_depth, pm->interlace_type,
8442 8443
            test_gamma, 1/test_gamma);
         test_gamma *= .95;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8444 8445 8446
      }

      /* And a special test for sRGB */
8447 8448
      gamma_threshold_test(pm, colour_type, bit_depth, pm->interlace_type,
          .45455, 2.2);
8449 8450 8451

      if (fail(pm))
         return;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8452 8453 8454
   }
}

8455 8456
static void gamma_transform_test(png_modifier *pm,
   PNG_CONST png_byte colour_type, PNG_CONST png_byte bit_depth,
8457
   PNG_CONST int palette_number,
8458
   PNG_CONST int interlace_type, PNG_CONST double file_gamma,
8459
   PNG_CONST double screen_gamma, PNG_CONST png_byte sbit,
8460
   PNG_CONST int use_input_precision, PNG_CONST int scale16)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8461 8462 8463
{
   size_t pos = 0;
   char name[64];
8464

8465
   if (sbit != bit_depth && sbit != 0)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8466 8467 8468 8469 8470
   {
      pos = safecat(name, sizeof name, pos, "sbit(");
      pos = safecatn(name, sizeof name, pos, sbit);
      pos = safecat(name, sizeof name, pos, ") ");
   }
8471

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8472 8473
   else
      pos = safecat(name, sizeof name, pos, "gamma ");
8474

8475
   if (scale16)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8476
      pos = safecat(name, sizeof name, pos, "16to8 ");
8477

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8478 8479 8480 8481
   pos = safecatd(name, sizeof name, pos, file_gamma, 3);
   pos = safecat(name, sizeof name, pos, "->");
   pos = safecatd(name, sizeof name, pos, screen_gamma, 3);

8482 8483
   gamma_test(pm, colour_type, bit_depth, palette_number, interlace_type,
      file_gamma, screen_gamma, sbit, 0, name, use_input_precision,
8484
      scale16, pm->test_gamma_expand16, 0 , 0, 0);
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8485 8486
}

8487
static void perform_gamma_transform_tests(png_modifier *pm)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8488 8489 8490
{
   png_byte colour_type = 0;
   png_byte bit_depth = 0;
8491
   int palette_number = 0;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8492

8493
   while (next_format(&colour_type, &bit_depth, &palette_number))
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8494
   {
8495
      unsigned int i, j;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8496

8497 8498 8499 8500 8501 8502
      for (i=0; i<pm->ngamma_tests; ++i) for (j=0; j<pm->ngamma_tests; ++j)
         if (i != j)
         {
            gamma_transform_test(pm, colour_type, bit_depth, palette_number,
               pm->interlace_type, 1/pm->gammas[i], pm->gammas[j], 0/*sBIT*/,
               pm->use_input_precision, 0 /*do not scale16*/);
8503

8504 8505 8506
            if (fail(pm))
               return;
         }
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8507 8508 8509
   }
}

8510
static void perform_gamma_sbit_tests(png_modifier *pm)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8511 8512 8513 8514
{
   png_byte sbit;

   /* The only interesting cases are colour and grayscale, alpha is ignored here
8515 8516
    * for overall speed.  Only bit depths where sbit is less than the bit depth
    * are tested.
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8517
    */
8518
   for (sbit=pm->sbitlow; sbit<(1<<READ_BDHI); ++sbit)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8519
   {
8520 8521
      png_byte colour_type, bit_depth;
      int npalette;
8522

8523 8524
      colour_type = bit_depth = 0;
      npalette = 0;
8525

8526 8527 8528 8529 8530 8531
      while (next_format(&colour_type, &bit_depth, &npalette))
         if ((colour_type & PNG_COLOR_MASK_ALPHA) == 0 &&
            ((colour_type == 3 && sbit < 8) ||
            (colour_type != 3 && sbit < bit_depth)))
      {
         unsigned int i;
8532

8533
         for (i=0; i<pm->ngamma_tests; ++i)
8534 8535
         {
            unsigned int j;
8536

8537
            for (j=0; j<pm->ngamma_tests; ++j) if (i != j)
8538 8539 8540
            {
               gamma_transform_test(pm, colour_type, bit_depth, npalette,
                  pm->interlace_type, 1/pm->gammas[i], pm->gammas[j],
8541
                  sbit, pm->use_input_precision_sbit, 0 /*scale16*/);
8542 8543 8544 8545

               if (fail(pm))
                  return;
            }
8546
         }
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8547 8548 8549 8550
      }
   }
}

8551
/* Note that this requires a 16 bit source image but produces 8 bit output, so
8552 8553
 * we only need the 16bit write support, but the 16 bit images are only
 * generated if DO_16BIT is defined.
8554
 */
8555
#ifdef DO_16BIT
8556
static void perform_gamma_scale16_tests(png_modifier *pm)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8557 8558 8559 8560
{
#  ifndef PNG_MAX_GAMMA_8
#     define PNG_MAX_GAMMA_8 11
#  endif
8561
   /* Include the alpha cases here. Note that sbit matches the internal value
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8562 8563 8564
    * used by the library - otherwise we will get spurious errors from the
    * internal sbit style approximation.
    *
8565
    * The threshold test is here because otherwise the 16 to 8 conversion will
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8566 8567 8568
    * proceed *without* gamma correction, and the tests above will fail (but not
    * by much) - this could be fixed, it only appears with the -g option.
    */
8569
   unsigned int i, j;
8570
   for (i=0; i<pm->ngamma_tests; ++i)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8571
   {
8572
      for (j=0; j<pm->ngamma_tests; ++j)
8573 8574 8575 8576
      {
         if (i != j &&
             fabs(pm->gammas[j]/pm->gammas[i]-1) >= PNG_GAMMA_THRESHOLD)
         {
8577 8578
            gamma_transform_test(pm, 0, 16, 0, pm->interlace_type,
               1/pm->gammas[i], pm->gammas[j], PNG_MAX_GAMMA_8,
8579
               pm->use_input_precision_16to8, 1 /*scale16*/);
8580 8581 8582 8583

            if (fail(pm))
               return;

8584 8585
            gamma_transform_test(pm, 2, 16, 0, pm->interlace_type,
               1/pm->gammas[i], pm->gammas[j], PNG_MAX_GAMMA_8,
8586
               pm->use_input_precision_16to8, 1 /*scale16*/);
8587 8588 8589 8590

            if (fail(pm))
               return;

8591 8592
            gamma_transform_test(pm, 4, 16, 0, pm->interlace_type,
               1/pm->gammas[i], pm->gammas[j], PNG_MAX_GAMMA_8,
8593
               pm->use_input_precision_16to8, 1 /*scale16*/);
8594 8595 8596 8597

            if (fail(pm))
               return;

8598 8599
            gamma_transform_test(pm, 6, 16, 0, pm->interlace_type,
               1/pm->gammas[i], pm->gammas[j], PNG_MAX_GAMMA_8,
8600
               pm->use_input_precision_16to8, 1 /*scale16*/);
8601 8602 8603 8604 8605

            if (fail(pm))
               return;
         }
      }
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8606 8607
   }
}
8608
#endif /* 16 to 8 bit conversion */
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8609

8610 8611
#if defined PNG_READ_BACKGROUND_SUPPORTED ||\
   defined PNG_READ_ALPHA_MODE_SUPPORTED
8612 8613
static void gamma_composition_test(png_modifier *pm,
   PNG_CONST png_byte colour_type, PNG_CONST png_byte bit_depth,
8614
   PNG_CONST int palette_number,
8615
   PNG_CONST int interlace_type, PNG_CONST double file_gamma,
8616
   PNG_CONST double screen_gamma,
8617 8618 8619 8620 8621 8622 8623 8624 8625 8626 8627 8628 8629
   PNG_CONST int use_input_precision, PNG_CONST int do_background,
   PNG_CONST int expand_16)
{
   size_t pos = 0;
   png_const_charp base;
   double bg;
   char name[128];
   png_color_16 background;

   /* Make up a name and get an appropriate background gamma value. */
   switch (do_background)
   {
      default:
8630
         base = "";
8631 8632 8633
         bg = 4; /* should not be used */
         break;
      case PNG_BACKGROUND_GAMMA_SCREEN:
8634
         base = " bckg(Screen):";
8635 8636 8637
         bg = 1/screen_gamma;
         break;
      case PNG_BACKGROUND_GAMMA_FILE:
8638
         base = " bckg(File):";
8639 8640 8641
         bg = file_gamma;
         break;
      case PNG_BACKGROUND_GAMMA_UNIQUE:
8642
         base = " bckg(Unique):";
8643 8644 8645 8646 8647 8648 8649 8650
         /* This tests the handling of a unique value, the math is such that the
          * value tends to be <1, but is neither screen nor file (even if they
          * match!)
          */
         bg = (file_gamma + screen_gamma) / 3;
         break;
#ifdef PNG_READ_ALPHA_MODE_SUPPORTED
      case ALPHA_MODE_OFFSET + PNG_ALPHA_PNG:
8651
         base = " alpha(PNG)";
8652 8653 8654
         bg = 4; /* should not be used */
         break;
      case ALPHA_MODE_OFFSET + PNG_ALPHA_STANDARD:
8655
         base = " alpha(Porter-Duff)";
8656 8657 8658
         bg = 4; /* should not be used */
         break;
      case ALPHA_MODE_OFFSET + PNG_ALPHA_OPTIMIZED:
8659
         base = " alpha(Optimized)";
8660 8661 8662
         bg = 4; /* should not be used */
         break;
      case ALPHA_MODE_OFFSET + PNG_ALPHA_BROKEN:
8663
         base = " alpha(Broken)";
8664 8665 8666 8667 8668 8669 8670 8671 8672 8673 8674 8675 8676 8677 8678 8679 8680 8681 8682 8683 8684 8685 8686 8687 8688 8689 8690 8691 8692 8693 8694 8695 8696 8697 8698 8699 8700 8701
         bg = 4; /* should not be used */
         break;
#endif
   }

   /* Use random background values - the background is always presented in the
    * output space (8 or 16 bit components).
    */
   if (expand_16 || bit_depth == 16)
   {
      png_uint_32 r = random_32();

      background.red = (png_uint_16)r;
      background.green = (png_uint_16)(r >> 16);
      r = random_32();
      background.blue = (png_uint_16)r;
      background.gray = (png_uint_16)(r >> 16);
   }

   else /* 8 bit colors */
   {
      png_uint_32 r = random_32();

      background.red = (png_byte)r;
      background.green = (png_byte)(r >> 8);
      background.blue = (png_byte)(r >> 16);
      background.gray = (png_byte)(r >> 24);
   }

   background.index = 193; /* rgb(193,193,193) to detect errors */
   if (!(colour_type & PNG_COLOR_MASK_COLOR))
   {
      /* Grayscale input, we do not convert to RGB (TBD), so we must set the
       * background to gray - else libpng seems to fail.
       */
      background.red = background.green = background.blue = background.gray;
   }

8702
   pos = safecat(name, sizeof name, pos, "gamma ");
8703
   pos = safecatd(name, sizeof name, pos, file_gamma, 3);
8704 8705 8706 8707
   pos = safecat(name, sizeof name, pos, "->");
   pos = safecatd(name, sizeof name, pos, screen_gamma, 3);

   pos = safecat(name, sizeof name, pos, base);
8708 8709 8710
   if (do_background < ALPHA_MODE_OFFSET)
   {
      /* Include the background color and gamma in the name: */
8711
      pos = safecat(name, sizeof name, pos, "(");
8712 8713 8714 8715 8716 8717
      /* This assumes no expand gray->rgb - the current code won't handle that!
       */
      if (colour_type & PNG_COLOR_MASK_COLOR)
      {
         pos = safecatn(name, sizeof name, pos, background.red);
         pos = safecat(name, sizeof name, pos, ",");
8718
         pos = safecatn(name, sizeof name, pos, background.green);
8719 8720 8721 8722 8723 8724 8725 8726 8727
         pos = safecat(name, sizeof name, pos, ",");
         pos = safecatn(name, sizeof name, pos, background.blue);
      }
      else
         pos = safecatn(name, sizeof name, pos, background.gray);
      pos = safecat(name, sizeof name, pos, ")^");
      pos = safecatd(name, sizeof name, pos, bg, 3);
   }

8728
   gamma_test(pm, colour_type, bit_depth, palette_number, interlace_type,
8729
      file_gamma, screen_gamma, 0/*sBIT*/, 0, name, use_input_precision,
8730 8731 8732 8733 8734
      0/*strip 16*/, expand_16, do_background, &background, bg);
}


static void
8735
perform_gamma_composition_tests(png_modifier *pm, int do_background,
8736 8737 8738 8739
   int expand_16)
{
   png_byte colour_type = 0;
   png_byte bit_depth = 0;
8740
   int palette_number = 0;
8741

8742 8743
   /* Skip the non-alpha cases - there is no setting of a transparency colour at
    * present.
8744
    */
8745 8746
   while (next_format(&colour_type, &bit_depth, &palette_number))
      if ((colour_type & PNG_COLOR_MASK_ALPHA) != 0)
8747 8748 8749 8750
   {
      unsigned int i, j;

      /* Don't skip the i==j case here - it's relevant. */
8751
      for (i=0; i<pm->ngamma_tests; ++i) for (j=0; j<pm->ngamma_tests; ++j)
8752
      {
8753 8754
         gamma_composition_test(pm, colour_type, bit_depth, palette_number,
            pm->interlace_type, 1/pm->gammas[i], pm->gammas[j],
8755
            pm->use_input_precision, do_background, expand_16);
8756 8757 8758 8759 8760 8761 8762 8763 8764 8765 8766

         if (fail(pm))
            return;
      }
   }
}
#endif /* READ_BACKGROUND || READ_ALPHA_MODE */

static void
init_gamma_errors(png_modifier *pm)
{
8767 8768 8769
   pm->error_gray_2 = pm->error_gray_4 = pm->error_gray_8 = 0;
   pm->error_color_8 = 0;
   pm->error_indexed = 0;
8770 8771 8772 8773 8774 8775 8776 8777 8778 8779 8780 8781 8782 8783 8784
   pm->error_gray_16 = pm->error_color_16 = 0;
}

static void
summarize_gamma_errors(png_modifier *pm, png_const_charp who, int low_bit_depth)
{
   if (who)
      printf("Gamma correction with %s:\n", who);

   if (low_bit_depth)
   {
      printf("  2 bit gray:  %.5f\n", pm->error_gray_2);
      printf("  4 bit gray:  %.5f\n", pm->error_gray_4);
      printf("  8 bit gray:  %.5f\n", pm->error_gray_8);
      printf("  8 bit color: %.5f\n", pm->error_color_8);
8785
      printf("  indexed:     %.5f\n", pm->error_indexed);
8786 8787 8788 8789 8790 8791 8792 8793
   }

#ifdef DO_16BIT
   printf(" 16 bit gray:  %.5f\n", pm->error_gray_16);
   printf(" 16 bit color: %.5f\n", pm->error_color_16);
#endif
}

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8794
static void
8795
perform_gamma_test(png_modifier *pm, int summary)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8796
{
8797 8798 8799 8800 8801 8802
   /*TODO: remove this*/
   /* Save certain values for the temporary overrides below. */
   unsigned int calculations_use_input_precision =
      pm->calculations_use_input_precision;
   double maxout8 = pm->maxout8;

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8803
   /* First some arbitrary no-transform tests: */
8804
   if (!pm->this.speed && pm->test_gamma_threshold)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8805 8806
   {
      perform_gamma_threshold_tests(pm);
8807 8808 8809

      if (fail(pm))
         return;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8810 8811 8812
   }

   /* Now some real transforms. */
8813
   if (pm->test_gamma_transform)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8814
   {
8815
      init_gamma_errors(pm);
8816
      /*TODO: remove this.  Necessary because the current libpng
8817 8818 8819 8820
       * implementation works in 8 bits:
       */
      if (pm->test_gamma_expand16)
         pm->calculations_use_input_precision = 1;
8821
      perform_gamma_transform_tests(pm);
8822 8823
      if (!calculations_use_input_precision)
         pm->calculations_use_input_precision = 0;
8824

8825
      if (summary)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8826
      {
8827 8828 8829 8830 8831 8832 8833 8834 8835 8836 8837 8838 8839
         printf("Gamma correction error summary\n\n");
         printf("The printed value is the maximum error in the pixel values\n");
         printf("calculated by the libpng gamma correction code.  The error\n");
         printf("is calculated as the difference between the output pixel\n");
         printf("value (always an integer) and the ideal value from the\n");
         printf("libpng specification (typically not an integer).\n\n");

         printf("Expect this value to be less than .5 for 8 bit formats,\n");
         printf("less than 1 for formats with fewer than 8 bits and a small\n");
         printf("number (typically less than 5) for the 16 bit formats.\n");
         printf("For performance reasons the value for 16 bit formats\n");
         printf("increases when the image file includes an sBIT chunk.\n\n");

8840
         summarize_gamma_errors(pm, 0/*who*/, 1);
8841
      }
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8842 8843
   }

8844
   /* The sbit tests produce much larger errors: */
8845
   if (pm->test_gamma_sbit)
8846
   {
8847
      init_gamma_errors(pm);
8848
      perform_gamma_sbit_tests(pm);
8849

8850
      if (summary)
8851
         summarize_gamma_errors(pm, "sBIT", pm->sbitlow < 8U);
8852 8853
   }

8854
#ifdef DO_16BIT /* Should be READ_16BIT_SUPPORTED */
8855
   if (pm->test_gamma_scale16)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8856
   {
8857
      /* The 16 to 8 bit strip operations: */
8858
      init_gamma_errors(pm);
8859
      perform_gamma_scale16_tests(pm);
8860 8861 8862 8863 8864 8865 8866

      if (summary)
      {
         printf("Gamma correction with 16 to 8 bit reduction:\n");
         printf(" 16 bit gray:  %.5f\n", pm->error_gray_16);
         printf(" 16 bit color: %.5f\n", pm->error_color_16);
      }
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8867
   }
8868
#endif
8869 8870 8871 8872 8873 8874

#ifdef PNG_READ_BACKGROUND_SUPPORTED
   if (pm->test_gamma_background)
   {
      init_gamma_errors(pm);

8875
      /*TODO: remove this.  Necessary because the current libpng
8876 8877 8878 8879 8880 8881 8882
       * implementation works in 8 bits:
       */
      if (pm->test_gamma_expand16)
      {
         pm->calculations_use_input_precision = 1;
         pm->maxout8 = .499; /* because the 16 bit background is smashed */
      }
8883
      perform_gamma_composition_tests(pm, PNG_BACKGROUND_GAMMA_UNIQUE,
8884
         pm->test_gamma_expand16);
8885 8886 8887
      if (!calculations_use_input_precision)
         pm->calculations_use_input_precision = 0;
      pm->maxout8 = maxout8;
8888 8889 8890 8891 8892 8893 8894 8895 8896 8897 8898 8899 8900

      if (summary)
         summarize_gamma_errors(pm, "background", 1);
   }
#endif

#ifdef PNG_READ_ALPHA_MODE_SUPPORTED
   if (pm->test_gamma_alpha_mode)
   {
      int do_background;

      init_gamma_errors(pm);

8901
      /*TODO: remove this.  Necessary because the current libpng
8902 8903 8904 8905
       * implementation works in 8 bits:
       */
      if (pm->test_gamma_expand16)
         pm->calculations_use_input_precision = 1;
8906 8907 8908
      for (do_background = ALPHA_MODE_OFFSET + PNG_ALPHA_STANDARD;
         do_background <= ALPHA_MODE_OFFSET + PNG_ALPHA_BROKEN && !fail(pm);
         ++do_background)
8909
         perform_gamma_composition_tests(pm, do_background,
8910
            pm->test_gamma_expand16);
8911 8912
      if (!calculations_use_input_precision)
         pm->calculations_use_input_precision = 0;
8913 8914 8915 8916 8917

      if (summary)
         summarize_gamma_errors(pm, "alpha mode", 1);
   }
#endif
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8918
}
8919
#endif /* PNG_READ_GAMMA_SUPPORTED */
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
8920

8921 8922 8923 8924 8925 8926 8927 8928 8929 8930 8931 8932 8933 8934 8935 8936 8937 8938 8939 8940 8941 8942 8943 8944 8945 8946 8947 8948 8949 8950 8951 8952 8953 8954 8955 8956 8957 8958 8959 8960 8961 8962 8963 8964 8965 8966 8967 8968 8969 8970 8971 8972 8973 8974 8975 8976 8977 8978 8979 8980 8981 8982 8983 8984 8985 8986 8987 8988 8989 8990 8991 8992 8993 8994 8995 8996 8997 8998 8999 9000 9001 9002 9003 9004 9005 9006 9007 9008 9009 9010 9011 9012 9013 9014 9015 9016 9017 9018 9019 9020 9021 9022 9023 9024 9025 9026 9027 9028 9029 9030 9031 9032 9033 9034 9035 9036 9037 9038 9039 9040 9041 9042 9043 9044 9045 9046 9047 9048 9049 9050 9051 9052 9053 9054 9055 9056 9057 9058 9059 9060 9061 9062 9063 9064 9065 9066 9067 9068 9069 9070 9071 9072 9073 9074 9075 9076 9077 9078 9079 9080 9081 9082 9083 9084 9085 9086 9087 9088 9089 9090 9091 9092 9093 9094 9095 9096 9097 9098 9099 9100 9101 9102 9103 9104 9105 9106 9107 9108 9109 9110 9111 9112 9113 9114 9115 9116 9117 9118 9119 9120 9121 9122 9123 9124 9125 9126 9127 9128 9129 9130 9131 9132 9133 9134 9135 9136 9137 9138 9139 9140 9141 9142 9143 9144 9145 9146 9147 9148 9149 9150 9151 9152 9153 9154 9155 9156 9157 9158 9159 9160 9161 9162 9163 9164 9165 9166 9167 9168 9169 9170 9171 9172 9173 9174 9175 9176 9177 9178 9179 9180 9181 9182 9183 9184 9185 9186 9187 9188 9189 9190 9191 9192 9193 9194 9195 9196 9197 9198 9199 9200 9201 9202 9203 9204 9205 9206 9207 9208 9209 9210 9211 9212 9213 9214 9215 9216 9217 9218 9219 9220 9221 9222 9223 9224 9225 9226 9227 9228 9229 9230 9231 9232 9233 9234 9235 9236 9237 9238 9239 9240 9241 9242 9243 9244 9245 9246 9247 9248 9249 9250 9251 9252 9253 9254 9255 9256 9257 9258 9259 9260 9261 9262 9263 9264 9265 9266
/* INTERLACE MACRO VALIDATION */
/* This is copied verbatim from the specification, it is simply the pass
 * number in which each pixel in each 8x8 tile appears.  The array must
 * be indexed adam7[y][x] and notice that the pass numbers are based at
 * 1, not 0 - the base libpng uses.
 */
static PNG_CONST
png_byte adam7[8][8] =
{
   { 1,6,4,6,2,6,4,6 },
   { 7,7,7,7,7,7,7,7 },
   { 5,6,5,6,5,6,5,6 },
   { 7,7,7,7,7,7,7,7 },
   { 3,6,4,6,3,6,4,6 },
   { 7,7,7,7,7,7,7,7 },
   { 5,6,5,6,5,6,5,6 },
   { 7,7,7,7,7,7,7,7 }
};

/* This routine validates all the interlace support macros in png.h for
 * a variety of valid PNG widths and heights.  It uses a number of similarly
 * named internal routines that feed off the above array.
 */
static png_uint_32
png_pass_start_row(int pass)
{
   int x, y;
   ++pass;
   for (y=0; y<8; ++y) for (x=0; x<8; ++x) if (adam7[y][x] == pass)
      return y;
   return 0xf;
}

static png_uint_32
png_pass_start_col(int pass)
{
   int x, y;
   ++pass;
   for (x=0; x<8; ++x) for (y=0; y<8; ++y) if (adam7[y][x] == pass)
      return x;
   return 0xf;
}

static int
png_pass_row_shift(int pass)
{
   int x, y, base=(-1), inc=8;
   ++pass;
   for (y=0; y<8; ++y) for (x=0; x<8; ++x) if (adam7[y][x] == pass)
   {
      if (base == (-1))
         base = y;
      else if (base == y)
         {}
      else if (inc == y-base)
         base=y;
      else if (inc == 8)
         inc = y-base, base=y;
      else if (inc != y-base)
         return 0xff; /* error - more than one 'inc' value! */
   }

   if (base == (-1)) return 0xfe; /* error - no row in pass! */

   /* The shift is always 1, 2 or 3 - no pass has all the rows! */
   switch (inc)
   {
case 2: return 1;
case 4: return 2;
case 8: return 3;
default: break;
   }

   /* error - unrecognized 'inc' */
   return (inc << 8) + 0xfd;
}

static int
png_pass_col_shift(int pass)
{
   int x, y, base=(-1), inc=8;
   ++pass;
   for (x=0; x<8; ++x) for (y=0; y<8; ++y) if (adam7[y][x] == pass)
   {
      if (base == (-1))
         base = x;
      else if (base == x)
         {}
      else if (inc == x-base)
         base=x;
      else if (inc == 8)
         inc = x-base, base=x;
      else if (inc != x-base)
         return 0xff; /* error - more than one 'inc' value! */
   }

   if (base == (-1)) return 0xfe; /* error - no row in pass! */

   /* The shift is always 1, 2 or 3 - no pass has all the rows! */
   switch (inc)
   {
case 1: return 0; /* pass 7 has all the columns */
case 2: return 1;
case 4: return 2;
case 8: return 3;
default: break;
   }

   /* error - unrecognized 'inc' */
   return (inc << 8) + 0xfd;
}

static png_uint_32
png_row_from_pass_row(png_uint_32 yIn, int pass)
{
   /* By examination of the array: */
   switch (pass)
   {
case 0: return yIn * 8;
case 1: return yIn * 8;
case 2: return yIn * 8 + 4;
case 3: return yIn * 4;
case 4: return yIn * 4 + 2;
case 5: return yIn * 2;
case 6: return yIn * 2 + 1;
default: break;
   }

   return 0xff; /* bad pass number */
}

static png_uint_32
png_col_from_pass_col(png_uint_32 xIn, int pass)
{
   /* By examination of the array: */
   switch (pass)
   {
case 0: return xIn * 8;
case 1: return xIn * 8 + 4;
case 2: return xIn * 4;
case 3: return xIn * 4 + 2;
case 4: return xIn * 2;
case 5: return xIn * 2 + 1;
case 6: return xIn;
default: break;
   }

   return 0xff; /* bad pass number */
}

static int
png_row_in_interlace_pass(png_uint_32 y, int pass)
{
   /* Is row 'y' in pass 'pass'? */
   int x;
   y &= 7;
   ++pass;
   for (x=0; x<8; ++x) if (adam7[y][x] == pass)
      return 1;

   return 0;
}

static int
png_col_in_interlace_pass(png_uint_32 x, int pass)
{
   /* Is column 'x' in pass 'pass'? */
   int y;
   x &= 7;
   ++pass;
   for (y=0; y<8; ++y) if (adam7[y][x] == pass)
      return 1;

   return 0;
}

static png_uint_32
png_pass_rows(png_uint_32 height, int pass)
{
   png_uint_32 tiles = height>>3;
   png_uint_32 rows = 0;
   unsigned int x, y;

   height &= 7;
   ++pass;
   for (y=0; y<8; ++y) for (x=0; x<8; ++x) if (adam7[y][x] == pass)
   {
      rows += tiles;
      if (y < height) ++rows;
      break; /* i.e. break the 'x', column, loop. */
   }

   return rows;
}

static png_uint_32
png_pass_cols(png_uint_32 width, int pass)
{
   png_uint_32 tiles = width>>3;
   png_uint_32 cols = 0;
   unsigned int x, y;

   width &= 7;
   ++pass;
   for (x=0; x<8; ++x) for (y=0; y<8; ++y) if (adam7[y][x] == pass)
   {
      cols += tiles;
      if (x < width) ++cols;
      break; /* i.e. break the 'y', row, loop. */
   }

   return cols;
}

static void
perform_interlace_macro_validation(void)
{
   /* The macros to validate, first those that depend only on pass:
    *
    * PNG_PASS_START_ROW(pass)
    * PNG_PASS_START_COL(pass)
    * PNG_PASS_ROW_SHIFT(pass)
    * PNG_PASS_COL_SHIFT(pass)
    */
   int pass;

   for (pass=0; pass<7; ++pass)
   {
      png_uint_32 m, f, v;

      m = PNG_PASS_START_ROW(pass);
      f = png_pass_start_row(pass);
      if (m != f)
      {
         fprintf(stderr, "PNG_PASS_START_ROW(%d) = %u != %x\n", pass, m, f);
         exit(1);
      }

      m = PNG_PASS_START_COL(pass);
      f = png_pass_start_col(pass);
      if (m != f)
      {
         fprintf(stderr, "PNG_PASS_START_COL(%d) = %u != %x\n", pass, m, f);
         exit(1);
      }

      m = PNG_PASS_ROW_SHIFT(pass);
      f = png_pass_row_shift(pass);
      if (m != f)
      {
         fprintf(stderr, "PNG_PASS_ROW_SHIFT(%d) = %u != %x\n", pass, m, f);
         exit(1);
      }

      m = PNG_PASS_COL_SHIFT(pass);
      f = png_pass_col_shift(pass);
      if (m != f)
      {
         fprintf(stderr, "PNG_PASS_COL_SHIFT(%d) = %u != %x\n", pass, m, f);
         exit(1);
      }

      /* Macros that depend on the image or sub-image height too:
       *
       * PNG_PASS_ROWS(height, pass)
       * PNG_PASS_COLS(width, pass)
       * PNG_ROW_FROM_PASS_ROW(yIn, pass)
       * PNG_COL_FROM_PASS_COL(xIn, pass)
       * PNG_ROW_IN_INTERLACE_PASS(y, pass)
       * PNG_COL_IN_INTERLACE_PASS(x, pass)
       */
      for (v=0;;)
      {
         /* First the base 0 stuff: */
         m = PNG_ROW_FROM_PASS_ROW(v, pass);
         f = png_row_from_pass_row(v, pass);
         if (m != f)
         {
            fprintf(stderr, "PNG_ROW_FROM_PASS_ROW(%u, %d) = %u != %x\n",
               v, pass, m, f);
            exit(1);
         }

         m = PNG_COL_FROM_PASS_COL(v, pass);
         f = png_col_from_pass_col(v, pass);
         if (m != f)
         {
            fprintf(stderr, "PNG_COL_FROM_PASS_COL(%u, %d) = %u != %x\n",
               v, pass, m, f);
            exit(1);
         }

         m = PNG_ROW_IN_INTERLACE_PASS(v, pass);
         f = png_row_in_interlace_pass(v, pass);
         if (m != f)
         {
            fprintf(stderr, "PNG_ROW_IN_INTERLACE_PASS(%u, %d) = %u != %x\n",
               v, pass, m, f);
            exit(1);
         }

         m = PNG_COL_IN_INTERLACE_PASS(v, pass);
         f = png_col_in_interlace_pass(v, pass);
         if (m != f)
         {
            fprintf(stderr, "PNG_COL_IN_INTERLACE_PASS(%u, %d) = %u != %x\n",
               v, pass, m, f);
            exit(1);
         }

         /* Then the base 1 stuff: */
         ++v;
         m = PNG_PASS_ROWS(v, pass);
         f = png_pass_rows(v, pass);
         if (m != f)
         {
            fprintf(stderr, "PNG_PASS_ROWS(%u, %d) = %u != %x\n",
               v, pass, m, f);
            exit(1);
         }

         m = PNG_PASS_COLS(v, pass);
         f = png_pass_cols(v, pass);
         if (m != f)
         {
            fprintf(stderr, "PNG_PASS_COLS(%u, %d) = %u != %x\n",
               v, pass, m, f);
            exit(1);
         }

         /* Move to the next v - the stepping algorithm starts skipping
          * values above 1024.
          */
         if (v > 1024)
         {
            if (v == PNG_UINT_31_MAX)
               break;

            v = (v << 1) ^ v;
            if (v >= PNG_UINT_31_MAX)
               v = PNG_UINT_31_MAX-1;
         }
      }
   }
}

9267 9268 9269 9270 9271 9272 9273 9274 9275 9276 9277 9278 9279 9280 9281 9282 9283 9284 9285 9286 9287 9288 9289 9290 9291 9292 9293 9294 9295 9296 9297 9298 9299 9300 9301
/* Test color encodings. These values are back-calculated from the published
 * chromaticities.  The values are accurate to about 14 decimal places; 15 are
 * given.  These values are much more accurate than the ones given in the spec,
 * which typically don't exceed 4 decimal places.  This allows testing of the
 * libpng code to its theoretical accuracy of 4 decimal places.  (If pngvalid
 * used the published errors the 'slack' permitted would have to be +/-.5E-4 or
 * more.)
 *
 * The png_modifier code assumes that encodings[0] is sRGB and treats it
 * specially: do not change the first entry in this list!
 */
static PNG_CONST color_encoding test_encodings[] =
{
/* sRGB: must be first in this list! */
/*gamma:*/ { 1/2.2,
/*red:  */ { 0.412390799265959, 0.212639005871510, 0.019330818715592 },
/*green:*/ { 0.357584339383878, 0.715168678767756, 0.119194779794626 },
/*blue: */ { 0.180480788401834, 0.072192315360734, 0.950532152249660} },
/* Kodak ProPhoto (wide gamut) */
/*gamma:*/ { 1/1.6 /*approximate: uses 1.8 power law compared to sRGB 2.4*/,
/*red:  */ { 0.797760489672303, 0.288071128229293, 0.000000000000000 },
/*green:*/ { 0.135185837175740, 0.711843217810102, 0.000000000000000 },
/*blue: */ { 0.031349349581525, 0.000085653960605, 0.825104602510460} },
/* Adobe RGB (1998) */
/*gamma:*/ { 1/(2+51./256),
/*red:  */ { 0.576669042910131, 0.297344975250536, 0.027031361386412 },
/*green:*/ { 0.185558237906546, 0.627363566255466, 0.070688852535827 },
/*blue: */ { 0.188228646234995, 0.075291458493998, 0.991337536837639} },
/* Adobe Wide Gamut RGB */
/*gamma:*/ { 1/(2+51./256),
/*red:  */ { 0.716500716779386, 0.258728243040113, 0.000000000000000 },
/*green:*/ { 0.101020574397477, 0.724682314948566, 0.051211818965388 },
/*blue: */ { 0.146774385252705, 0.016589442011321, 0.773892783545073} },
};

9302 9303 9304 9305 9306 9307 9308 9309 9310 9311 9312 9313 9314 9315 9316 9317 9318 9319 9320 9321 9322 9323 9324 9325 9326 9327 9328 9329 9330 9331 9332 9333 9334 9335 9336 9337 9338 9339 9340 9341 9342 9343 9344 9345 9346 9347 9348 9349 9350 9351 9352 9353 9354 9355 9356 9357 9358 9359 9360 9361 9362 9363 9364 9365 9366 9367
/* signal handler
 *
 * This attempts to trap signals and escape without crashing.  It needs a
 * context pointer so that it can throw an exception (call longjmp) to recover
 * from the condition; this is handled by making the png_modifier used by 'main'
 * into a global variable.
 */
static png_modifier pm;

static void signal_handler(int signum)
{

   size_t pos = 0;
   char msg[64];

   pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "caught signal: ");

   switch (signum)
   {
      case SIGABRT:
         pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "abort");
         break;

      case SIGFPE:
         pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "floating point exception");
         break;

      case SIGILL:
         pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "illegal instruction");
         break;

      case SIGINT:
         pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "interrupt");
         break;

      case SIGSEGV:
         pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "invalid memory access");
         break;

      case SIGTERM:
         pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "termination request");
         break;

      default:
         pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "unknown ");
         pos = safecatn(msg, sizeof msg, pos, signum);
         break;
   }

   store_log(&pm.this, NULL/*png_structp*/, msg, 1/*error*/);

   /* And finally throw an exception so we can keep going, unless this is
    * SIGTERM in which case stop now.
    */
   if (signum != SIGTERM)
   {
      struct exception_context *the_exception_context =
         &pm.this.exception_context;

      Throw &pm.this;
   }

   else
      exit(1);
}

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
9368
/* main program */
9369
int main(int argc, PNG_CONST char **argv)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
9370
{
9371
   volatile int summary = 1;  /* Print the error summary at the end */
9372
   volatile int memstats = 0; /* Print memory statistics at the end */
9373 9374 9375

   /* Create the given output file on success: */
   PNG_CONST char *volatile touch = NULL;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
9376 9377 9378 9379 9380 9381

   /* This is an array of standard gamma values (believe it or not I've seen
    * every one of these mentioned somewhere.)
    *
    * In the following list the most useful values are first!
    */
9382 9383
   static double
      gammas[]={2.2, 1.0, 2.2/1.45, 1.8, 1.5, 2.4, 2.5, 2.62, 2.9};
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
9384

9385 9386 9387 9388
   /* This records the command and arguments: */
   size_t cp = 0;
   char command[1024];

9389
   anon_context(&pm.this);
9390

9391 9392 9393 9394 9395 9396 9397 9398 9399 9400 9401 9402 9403 9404 9405 9406
   /* Add appropriate signal handlers, just the ANSI specified ones: */
   signal(SIGABRT, signal_handler);
   signal(SIGFPE, signal_handler);
   signal(SIGILL, signal_handler);
   signal(SIGINT, signal_handler);
   signal(SIGSEGV, signal_handler);
   signal(SIGTERM, signal_handler);

#ifdef HAVE_FEENABLEEXCEPT
   /* Only required to enable FP exceptions on platforms where they start off
    * disabled; this is not necessary but if it is not done pngvalid will likely
    * end up ignoring FP conditions that other platforms fault.
    */
   feenableexcept(FE_DIVBYZERO | FE_INVALID | FE_OVERFLOW);
#endif

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
9407 9408
   modifier_init(&pm);

9409
   /* Preallocate the image buffer, because we know how big it needs to be,
9410 9411 9412
    * note that, for testing purposes, it is deliberately mis-aligned by tag
    * bytes either side.  All rows have an additional five bytes of padding for
    * overwrite checking.
9413
    */
9414
   store_ensure_image(&pm.this, NULL, 2, TRANSFORM_ROWMAX, TRANSFORM_HEIGHTMAX);
9415

9416 9417 9418
   /* Don't give argv[0], it's normally some horrible libtool string: */
   cp = safecat(command, sizeof command, cp, "pngvalid");

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
9419 9420 9421 9422 9423
   /* Default to error on warning: */
   pm.this.treat_warnings_as_errors = 1;

   /* Store the test gammas */
   pm.gammas = gammas;
9424 9425 9426 9427 9428 9429 9430
   pm.ngammas = (sizeof gammas) / (sizeof gammas[0]);
   pm.ngamma_tests = 0; /* default to off */

   /* And the test encodings */
   pm.encodings = test_encodings;
   pm.nencodings = (sizeof test_encodings) / (sizeof test_encodings[0]);

9431
   pm.sbitlow = 8U; /* because libpng doesn't do sBIT below 8! */
9432 9433 9434 9435 9436 9437 9438
   /* The following allows results to pass if they correspond to anything in the
    * transformed range [input-.5,input+.5]; this is is required because of the
    * way libpng treates the 16_TO_8 flag when building the gamma tables.
    *
    * TODO: review this
    */
   pm.use_input_precision_16to8 = 1U;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
9439

9440 9441 9442 9443 9444
   /* Some default values (set the behavior for 'make check' here).
    * These values simply control the maximum error permitted in the gamma
    * transformations.  The practial limits for human perception are described
    * below (the setting for maxpc16), however for 8 bit encodings it isn't
    * possible to meet the accepted capabilities of human vision - i.e. 8 bit
9445
    * images can never be good enough, regardless of encoding.
9446
    */
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
9447 9448
   pm.maxout8 = .1;     /* Arithmetic error in *encoded* value */
   pm.maxabs8 = .00005; /* 1/20000 */
9449
   pm.maxcalc8 = .004;  /* +/-1 in 8 bits for compose errors */
9450
   pm.maxpc8 = .499;    /* I.e., .499% fractional error */
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
9451 9452
   pm.maxout16 = .499;  /* Error in *encoded* value */
   pm.maxabs16 = .00005;/* 1/20000 */
9453
   pm.maxcalc16 =.000015;/* +/-1 in 16 bits for compose errors */
9454 9455

   /* NOTE: this is a reasonable perceptual limit. We assume that humans can
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
9456
    * perceive light level differences of 1% over a 100:1 range, so we need to
9457
    * maintain 1 in 10000 accuracy (in linear light space), which is what the
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
9458 9459 9460 9461 9462
    * following guarantees.  It also allows significantly higher errors at
    * higher 16 bit values, which is important for performance.  The actual
    * maximum 16 bit error is about +/-1.9 in the fixed point implementation but
    * this is only allowed for values >38149 by the following:
    */
9463
   pm.maxpc16 = .005;   /* I.e., 1/200% - 1/20000 */
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
9464 9465 9466

   /* Now parse the command line options. */
   while (--argc >= 1)
9467
   {
9468 9469
      int catmore = 0; /* Set if the argument has an argument. */

9470 9471 9472 9473 9474
      /* Record each argument for posterity: */
      cp = safecat(command, sizeof command, cp, " ");
      cp = safecat(command, sizeof command, cp, *++argv);

      if (strcmp(*argv, "-v") == 0)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
9475
         pm.this.verbose = 1;
9476

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
9477 9478
      else if (strcmp(*argv, "-l") == 0)
         pm.log = 1;
9479

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
9480
      else if (strcmp(*argv, "-q") == 0)
9481
         summary = pm.this.verbose = pm.log = 0;
9482

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
9483 9484
      else if (strcmp(*argv, "-w") == 0)
         pm.this.treat_warnings_as_errors = 0;
9485

9486
      else if (strcmp(*argv, "--speed") == 0)
9487 9488
         pm.this.speed = 1, pm.ngamma_tests = pm.ngammas, pm.test_standard = 0,
            summary = 0;
9489 9490 9491

      else if (strcmp(*argv, "--memory") == 0)
         memstats = 1;
9492

9493 9494 9495
      else if (strcmp(*argv, "--size") == 0)
         pm.test_size = 1;

9496 9497 9498 9499 9500 9501
      else if (strcmp(*argv, "--nosize") == 0)
         pm.test_size = 0;

      else if (strcmp(*argv, "--standard") == 0)
         pm.test_standard = 1;

9502 9503
      else if (strcmp(*argv, "--nostandard") == 0)
         pm.test_standard = 0;
9504

9505 9506 9507
      else if (strcmp(*argv, "--transform") == 0)
         pm.test_transform = 1;

9508 9509 9510
      else if (strcmp(*argv, "--notransform") == 0)
         pm.test_transform = 0;

9511
#ifdef PNG_READ_TRANSFORMS_SUPPORTED
9512 9513 9514 9515 9516 9517 9518 9519 9520 9521 9522 9523 9524
      else if (strncmp(*argv, "--transform-disable=",
         sizeof "--transform-disable") == 0)
         {
         pm.test_transform = 1;
         transform_disable(*argv + sizeof "--transform-disable");
         }

      else if (strncmp(*argv, "--transform-enable=",
         sizeof "--transform-enable") == 0)
         {
         pm.test_transform = 1;
         transform_enable(*argv + sizeof "--transform-enable");
         }
9525
#endif /* PNG_READ_TRANSFORMS_SUPPORTED */
9526 9527 9528 9529

      else if (strcmp(*argv, "--gamma") == 0)
         {
         /* Just do two gamma tests here (2.2 and linear) for speed: */
9530
         pm.ngamma_tests = 2U;
9531 9532 9533
         pm.test_gamma_threshold = 1;
         pm.test_gamma_transform = 1;
         pm.test_gamma_sbit = 1;
9534
         pm.test_gamma_scale16 = 1;
9535 9536
         pm.test_gamma_background = 1;
         pm.test_gamma_alpha_mode = 1;
9537 9538
         }

9539
      else if (strcmp(*argv, "--nogamma") == 0)
9540
         pm.ngamma_tests = 0;
9541

9542
      else if (strcmp(*argv, "--gamma-threshold") == 0)
9543
         pm.ngamma_tests = 2U, pm.test_gamma_threshold = 1;
9544

9545
      else if (strcmp(*argv, "--nogamma-threshold") == 0)
9546
         pm.test_gamma_threshold = 0;
9547

9548
      else if (strcmp(*argv, "--gamma-transform") == 0)
9549
         pm.ngamma_tests = 2U, pm.test_gamma_transform = 1;
9550

9551
      else if (strcmp(*argv, "--nogamma-transform") == 0)
9552
         pm.test_gamma_transform = 0;
9553

9554
      else if (strcmp(*argv, "--gamma-sbit") == 0)
9555
         pm.ngamma_tests = 2U, pm.test_gamma_sbit = 1;
9556

9557
      else if (strcmp(*argv, "--nogamma-sbit") == 0)
9558
         pm.test_gamma_sbit = 0;
9559

9560
      else if (strcmp(*argv, "--gamma-16-to-8") == 0)
9561
         pm.ngamma_tests = 2U, pm.test_gamma_scale16 = 1;
9562

9563
      else if (strcmp(*argv, "--nogamma-16-to-8") == 0)
9564
         pm.test_gamma_scale16 = 0;
9565

9566
      else if (strcmp(*argv, "--gamma-background") == 0)
9567
         pm.ngamma_tests = 2U, pm.test_gamma_background = 1;
9568 9569 9570 9571 9572

      else if (strcmp(*argv, "--nogamma-background") == 0)
         pm.test_gamma_background = 0;

      else if (strcmp(*argv, "--gamma-alpha-mode") == 0)
9573
         pm.ngamma_tests = 2U, pm.test_gamma_alpha_mode = 1;
9574 9575 9576 9577 9578 9579 9580 9581 9582 9583 9584

      else if (strcmp(*argv, "--nogamma-alpha-mode") == 0)
         pm.test_gamma_alpha_mode = 0;

      else if (strcmp(*argv, "--expand16") == 0)
         pm.test_gamma_expand16 = 1;

      else if (strcmp(*argv, "--noexpand16") == 0)
         pm.test_gamma_expand16 = 0;

      else if (strcmp(*argv, "--more-gammas") == 0)
9585
         pm.ngamma_tests = 3U;
9586

9587
      else if (strcmp(*argv, "--all-gammas") == 0)
9588
         pm.ngamma_tests = pm.ngammas;
9589

9590 9591 9592
      else if (strcmp(*argv, "--progressive-read") == 0)
         pm.this.progressive = 1;

9593 9594 9595
      else if (strcmp(*argv, "--use-update-info") == 0)
         ++pm.use_update_info; /* Can call multiple times */

9596 9597 9598
      else if (strcmp(*argv, "--interlace") == 0)
         pm.interlace_type = PNG_INTERLACE_ADAM7;

9599 9600 9601
      else if (strcmp(*argv, "--use-input-precision") == 0)
         pm.use_input_precision = 1;

9602 9603 9604 9605 9606
      else if (strcmp(*argv, "--calculations-use-input-precision") == 0)
         pm.calculations_use_input_precision = 1;

      else if (strcmp(*argv, "--assume-16-bit-calculations") == 0)
         pm.assume_16_bit_calculations = 1;
9607

9608 9609 9610
      else if (strcmp(*argv, "--calculations-follow-bit-depth") == 0)
         pm.calculations_use_input_precision =
            pm.assume_16_bit_calculations = 0;
9611

9612 9613 9614
      else if (strcmp(*argv, "--exhaustive") == 0)
         pm.test_exhaustive = 1;

9615 9616
      else if (argc > 1 && strcmp(*argv, "--sbitlow") == 0)
         --argc, pm.sbitlow = (png_byte)atoi(*++argv), catmore = 1;
9617

9618 9619 9620 9621
      else if (argc > 1 && strcmp(*argv, "--touch") == 0)
         --argc, touch = *++argv, catmore = 1;

      else if (argc > 1 && strncmp(*argv, "--max", 5) == 0)
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
9622 9623
      {
         --argc;
9624

9625
         if (strcmp(5+*argv, "abs8") == 0)
9626
            pm.maxabs8 = atof(*++argv);
9627

9628
         else if (strcmp(5+*argv, "abs16") == 0)
9629
            pm.maxabs16 = atof(*++argv);
9630

9631 9632 9633 9634 9635 9636 9637
         else if (strcmp(5+*argv, "calc8") == 0)
            pm.maxcalc8 = atof(*++argv);

         else if (strcmp(5+*argv, "calc16") == 0)
            pm.maxcalc16 = atof(*++argv);

         else if (strcmp(5+*argv, "out8") == 0)
9638
            pm.maxout8 = atof(*++argv);
9639

9640
         else if (strcmp(5+*argv, "out16") == 0)
9641
            pm.maxout16 = atof(*++argv);
9642

9643
         else if (strcmp(5+*argv, "pc8") == 0)
9644
            pm.maxpc8 = atof(*++argv);
9645

9646
         else if (strcmp(5+*argv, "pc16") == 0)
9647
            pm.maxpc16 = atof(*++argv);
9648

9649 9650 9651 9652 9653
         else
         {
            fprintf(stderr, "pngvalid: %s: unknown 'max' option\n", *argv);
            exit(1);
         }
9654 9655

         catmore = 1;
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
9656
      }
9657

9658 9659 9660 9661 9662 9663
      else if (strcmp(*argv, "--log8") == 0)
         --argc, pm.log8 = atof(*++argv), catmore = 1;

      else if (strcmp(*argv, "--log16") == 0)
         --argc, pm.log16 = atof(*++argv), catmore = 1;

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
9664 9665 9666
      else
      {
         fprintf(stderr, "pngvalid: %s: unknown argument\n", *argv);
9667
         exit(1);
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
9668
      }
9669 9670 9671 9672 9673 9674

      if (catmore) /* consumed an extra *argv */
      {
         cp = safecat(command, sizeof command, cp, " ");
         cp = safecat(command, sizeof command, cp, *argv);
      }
9675
   }
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
9676

9677 9678 9679 9680
   /* If pngvalid is run with no arguments default to a reasonable set of the
    * tests.
    */
   if (pm.test_standard == 0 && pm.test_size == 0 && pm.test_transform == 0 &&
9681
      pm.ngamma_tests == 0)
9682
   {
9683 9684 9685 9686 9687
      /* Make this do all the tests done in the test shell scripts with the same
       * parameters, where possible.  The limitation is that all the progressive
       * read and interlace stuff has to be done in separate runs, so only the
       * basic 'standard' and 'size' tests are done.
       */
9688 9689 9690
      pm.test_standard = 1;
      pm.test_size = 1;
      pm.test_transform = 1;
9691
      pm.ngamma_tests = 2U;
9692 9693
   }

9694
   if (pm.ngamma_tests > 0 &&
9695
      pm.test_gamma_threshold == 0 && pm.test_gamma_transform == 0 &&
9696
      pm.test_gamma_sbit == 0 && pm.test_gamma_scale16 == 0 &&
9697
      pm.test_gamma_background == 0 && pm.test_gamma_alpha_mode == 0)
9698 9699 9700 9701
   {
      pm.test_gamma_threshold = 1;
      pm.test_gamma_transform = 1;
      pm.test_gamma_sbit = 1;
9702
      pm.test_gamma_scale16 = 1;
9703 9704
      pm.test_gamma_background = 1;
      pm.test_gamma_alpha_mode = 1;
9705
   }
9706

9707
   else if (pm.ngamma_tests == 0)
9708 9709 9710 9711 9712
   {
      /* Nothing to test so turn everything off: */
      pm.test_gamma_threshold = 0;
      pm.test_gamma_transform = 0;
      pm.test_gamma_sbit = 0;
9713
      pm.test_gamma_scale16 = 0;
9714 9715
      pm.test_gamma_background = 0;
      pm.test_gamma_alpha_mode = 0;
9716 9717
   }

9718 9719 9720
   Try
   {
      /* Make useful base images */
9721
      make_transform_images(&pm.this);
9722 9723

      /* Perform the standard and gamma tests. */
9724
      if (pm.test_standard)
9725
      {
9726
         perform_interlace_macro_validation();
9727
         perform_formatting_test(&pm.this);
9728 9729 9730 9731
         perform_standard_test(&pm);
         perform_error_test(&pm);
      }

9732 9733 9734 9735 9736 9737 9738
      /* Various oddly sized images: */
      if (pm.test_size)
      {
         make_size_images(&pm.this);
         perform_size_test(&pm);
      }

9739
#ifdef PNG_READ_TRANSFORMS_SUPPORTED
9740 9741 9742
      /* Combinatorial transforms: */
      if (pm.test_transform)
         perform_transform_test(&pm);
9743
#endif /* PNG_READ_TRANSFORMS_SUPPORTED */
9744

9745
#ifdef PNG_READ_GAMMA_SUPPORTED
9746
      if (pm.ngamma_tests > 0)
9747
         perform_gamma_test(&pm, summary);
9748
#endif
9749 9750
   }

9751
   Catch_anonymous
9752
   {
9753
      fprintf(stderr, "pngvalid: test aborted (probably failed in cleanup)\n");
9754 9755 9756 9757
      if (!pm.this.verbose)
      {
         if (pm.this.error[0] != 0)
            fprintf(stderr, "pngvalid: first error: %s\n", pm.this.error);
9758

9759 9760
         fprintf(stderr, "pngvalid: run with -v to see what happened\n");
      }
9761 9762
      exit(1);
   }
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
9763

9764
   if (summary)
9765
   {
9766
      printf("%s: %s (%s point arithmetic)\n",
9767 9768 9769
         (pm.this.nerrors || (pm.this.treat_warnings_as_errors &&
            pm.this.nwarnings)) ? "FAIL" : "PASS",
         command,
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
9770
#if defined(PNG_FLOATING_ARITHMETIC_SUPPORTED) || PNG_LIBPNG_VER < 10500
9771
         "floating"
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
9772
#else
9773
         "fixed"
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
9774
#endif
9775
         );
9776 9777 9778 9779
   }

   if (memstats)
   {
9780
      printf("Allocated memory statistics (in bytes):\n"
9781 9782 9783 9784 9785 9786 9787 9788
         "\tread  %lu maximum single, %lu peak, %lu total\n"
         "\twrite %lu maximum single, %lu peak, %lu total\n",
         (unsigned long)pm.this.read_memory_pool.max_max,
         (unsigned long)pm.this.read_memory_pool.max_limit,
         (unsigned long)pm.this.read_memory_pool.max_total,
         (unsigned long)pm.this.write_memory_pool.max_max,
         (unsigned long)pm.this.write_memory_pool.max_limit,
         (unsigned long)pm.this.write_memory_pool.max_total);
9789 9790 9791 9792 9793 9794
   }

   /* Do this here to provoke memory corruption errors in memory not directly
    * allocated by libpng - not a complete test, but better than nothing.
    */
   store_delete(&pm.this);
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
9795 9796 9797 9798

   /* Error exit if there are any errors, and maybe if there are any
    * warnings.
    */
9799 9800
   if (pm.this.nerrors || (pm.this.treat_warnings_as_errors &&
       pm.this.nwarnings))
G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
9801 9802 9803
   {
      if (!pm.this.verbose)
         fprintf(stderr, "pngvalid: %s\n", pm.this.error);
9804

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
9805
      fprintf(stderr, "pngvalid: %d errors, %d warnings\n", pm.this.nerrors,
9806 9807
          pm.this.nwarnings);

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
9808 9809 9810
      exit(1);
   }

9811 9812 9813 9814
   /* Success case. */
   if (touch != NULL)
   {
      FILE *fsuccess = fopen(touch, "wt");
9815

9816 9817 9818 9819 9820 9821
      if (fsuccess != NULL)
      {
         int error = 0;
         fprintf(fsuccess, "PNG validation succeeded\n");
         fflush(fsuccess);
         error = ferror(fsuccess);
9822

9823 9824 9825 9826 9827 9828 9829 9830
         if (fclose(fsuccess) || error)
         {
            fprintf(stderr, "%s: write failed\n", touch);
            exit(1);
         }
      }
   }

G
[devel]  
Glenn Randers-Pehrson 已提交
9831 9832
   return 0;
}